]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
(Rmail Display): Document rmail-redecode-body.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- -*- coding: iso-latin-1 -*-
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @synindex fn cp
6 @synindex vr cp
7 @synindex pg cp
8 @dircategory Emacs
9 @direntry
10 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
11 @end direntry
12 @iftex
13 @finalout
14 @end iftex
15 @setchapternewpage odd
16
17 @iftex
18 @iflatex
19 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
20 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
21 \usepackage{pagestyle}
22 \usepackage{epsfig}
23 \usepackage{bembo}
24 \usepackage{pixidx}
25
26 \makeindex
27 \begin{document}
28
29 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
30 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
31
32 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
33
34 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
35 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
36
37 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
38 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
39
40 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}}
41 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
42 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}''}
43 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
44 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
45 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
46 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
47 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
48 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
49 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
50 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
51 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
52 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
53 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
54 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
57 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
58 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
59 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
60 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
61 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
62 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
64 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
67 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
69
70 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head.eps,height=1cm}}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
72 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
73 }
74
75 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
76
77 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
78 {\mbox{}}
79 }
80
81 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
82 \gnusdimen 0pt
83
84 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
85 \gnuscleardoublepage
86 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
87 \chapter{#2}
88 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
89 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
90 \thispagestyle{empty}
91 \hspace*{-2cm}
92 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
93 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
94 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
95 \end{picture}
96 \clearpage
97 }
98
99 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
100 \begin{figure}
101 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
102 #3
103 \end{picture}
104 \caption{#1}
105 \end{figure}
106 }
107
108 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1cm}}}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
113 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
114 }
115
116 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
117 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
118 }
119
120 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
121 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
122 }
123
124 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
125
126 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
128 \section{#1}
129 }
130
131 \newenvironment{codelist}%
132 {\begin{list}{}{
133 }
134 }{\end{list}}
135
136 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
137 {\begin{list}{}{
138 \labelwidth=0cm
139 }
140 }{\end{list}}
141
142 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
143 {\begin{list}{}{
144 }
145 }{\end{list}}
146
147 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
148 {\begin{list}{}{
149 }
150 }{\end{list}}
151
152 \newenvironment{samplist}%
153 {\begin{list}{}{
154 }
155 }{\end{list}}
156
157 \newenvironment{varlist}%
158 {\begin{list}{}{
159 }
160 }{\end{list}}
161
162 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
163 {\begin{list}{}{
164 }
165 }{\end{list}}
166
167 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
168 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
169 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
170
171 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
172 {
173 {
174 \ifodd\count0
175 {
176 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
177 }
178 \else
179 {
180 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
181 }
182 }
183 \fi
184 }
185 }
186 {
187 \ifodd\count0
188 \mbox{} \hfill
189 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
190 \else
191 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
192 \hfill \mbox{}
193 \fi
194 }
195
196 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
197 {
198 {
199 \ifodd\count0
200 {
201 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
202 }
203 \else
204 {
205 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
206 }
207 \fi
208 }
209 }
210 {
211 \ifodd\count0
212 \mbox{} \hfill
213 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
214 \else
215 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
216 \hfill \mbox{}
217 \fi
218 }
219
220 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
221 {
222 {
223 \ifodd\count0
224 {
225 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
226 }
227 \else
228 {
229 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
230 }
231 \fi
232 }
233 }
234 {
235 \ifodd\count0
236 \mbox{} \hfill
237 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
238 \else
239 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
240 \hfill \mbox{}
241 \fi
242 }
243
244 \pagenumbering{roman}
245 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
246
247 @end iflatex
248 @end iftex
249
250 @iftex
251 @iflatex
252 \begin{titlepage}
253 {
254
255 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
256 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
257 \parindent=0cm
258 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
259
260 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\\
261 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
262 \vfill
263 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=15cm}
264 \vfill
265 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
266 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
267 \newpage
268 }
269
270 \mbox{}
271 \vfill
272
273 \thispagestyle{empty}
274
275 Copyright \copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
276
277
278 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
279 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
280 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
281 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
282 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
283 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
284 License'' in the Emacs manual.
285
286 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
287 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
288 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
289
290 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
291 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
292 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
293 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
294 \newpage
295 \end{titlepage}
296 @end iflatex
297 @end iftex
298
299 @ifnottex
300
301 This file documents Gnus, the GNU Emacs newsreader.
302
303 Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
304
305 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
306 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
307 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
308 Invariant Sections being none, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
309 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
310 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
311 License'' in the Emacs manual.
312
313 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
314 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
315 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
316
317 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
318 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
319 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
320 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
321 @end ifnottex
322
323 @tex
324
325 @titlepage
326 @title Gnus Manual
327
328 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
329 @page
330
331 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
332 Copyright @copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
333
334 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
335 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
336 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
337 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
338 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
339 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
340 License'' in the Emacs manual.
341
342 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
343 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
344 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
345
346 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
347 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
348 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
349 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
350
351 @end titlepage
352 @page
353
354 @end tex
355
356
357 @node Top
358 @top The Gnus Newsreader
359
360 @ifinfo
361
362 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
363 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@sc{nntp}, local
364 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
365 luck.
366
367 This manual corresponds to Gnus 5.9.0.
368
369 @end ifinfo
370
371 @iftex
372
373 @iflatex
374 \tableofcontents
375 \gnuscleardoublepage
376 @end iflatex
377
378 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
379 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
380
381 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
382 being accused of plagiarism:
383
384 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
385 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
386 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
387 can even read news with it!
388
389 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
390 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
391 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
392 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
393 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
394 the program.
395
396 @end iftex
397
398 @menu
399 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
400 * The Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
401 * The Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
402 * The Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
403 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
404 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
405 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
406 * Various:: General purpose settings.
407 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
408 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, FAQ, History, Internals.
409 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
410 * Key Index:: Key Index.
411
412 @detailmenu
413 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
414
415 Starting Gnus
416
417 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
418 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
419 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
420 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
421 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
422 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
423 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
424 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
425 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
428
429 New Groups
430
431 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
432 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
433 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
434
435 The Group Buffer
436
437 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
438 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
439 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
440 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
443 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
444 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
445 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
446 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
447 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
448 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
449 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
450 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
451 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
452 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
453 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
454
455 Group Buffer Format
456
457 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
458 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
459 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
460
461 Group Topics
462
463 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
466 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
467 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
468
469 Misc Group Stuff
470
471 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
472 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
473 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
474 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
475
476 The Summary Buffer
477
478 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
479 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
480 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
481 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
482 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
483 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
484 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
485 * Threading:: How threads are made.
486 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
487 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
488 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
489 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
490 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
491 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
492 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
493 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
494 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
495 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
496 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
497 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
498 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
499 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
500 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
501 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
502 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
503 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
504 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
505 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
506
507 Summary Buffer Format
508
509 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
510 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
511 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
512 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
513
514 Choosing Articles
515
516 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
517 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
518
519 Reply, Followup and Post
520
521 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
522 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
523 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
524 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
525
526 Marking Articles
527
528 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
529 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
530 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
531 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
532 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
533 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
534
535 Threading
536
537 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
538 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
539
540 Customizing Threading
541
542 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
543 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
544 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
545 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
546
547 Decoding Articles
548
549 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
550 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
551 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
552 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
553 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
554 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
555
556 Decoding Variables
557
558 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
559 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
560 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
561
562 Article Treatment
563
564 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
565 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
566 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
567 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
568 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
569 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
570 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
571 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
572
573 Alternative Approaches
574
575 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
576 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
577
578 Various Summary Stuff
579
580 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
581 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
582 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
583 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
584
585 The Article Buffer
586
587 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
588 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
589 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
590 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
591 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
592
593 Composing Messages
594
595 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
596 * Post:: Posting and following up.
597 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
598 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
599 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
600 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
601 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
602 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
603
604 Select Methods
605
606 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
607 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
608 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
609 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
610 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
611 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
612 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
613
614 The Server Buffer
615
616 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
617 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
618 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
619 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
620 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
621 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
622 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
623
624 Getting News
625
626 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
627 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
628
629 Getting Mail
630
631 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
632 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
633 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
634 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
635 * Mail Backend Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
636 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
637 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
638 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
639 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
640 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
641 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
642 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail backends for reading other files.
643 * Choosing a Mail Backend:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
644
645 Mail Sources
646
647 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
648 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
649 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
650
651 Choosing a Mail Backend
652
653 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
654 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
655 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
656 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like backend.
657 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
658 * Comparing Mail Backends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
659
660 Browsing the Web
661
662 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
663 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
664 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
665 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
666
667 Other Sources
668
669 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
670 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
671 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
672 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
673 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
674 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
675
676 Document Groups
677
678 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
679
680 SOUP
681
682 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
683 * SOUP Groups:: A backend for reading @sc{soup} packets.
684 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
685
686 @sc{imap}
687
688 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
689 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
690 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
691
692 Combined Groups
693
694 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
695 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
696
697 Gnus Unplugged
698
699 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
700 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
701 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
702 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
703 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
704 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
705 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
706 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
707 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
708 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
709
710 Agent Categories
711
712 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
713 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
714 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
715
716 Agent Commands
717
718 * Group Agent Commands::
719 * Summary Agent Commands::
720 * Server Agent Commands::
721
722 Scoring
723
724 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
725 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
726 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
727 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
728 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
729 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
730 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
731 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
732 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
733 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
734 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
735 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
736 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
737 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
738 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
739 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
740
741 GroupLens
742
743 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
744 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
745 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
746 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
747
748 Advanced Scoring
749
750 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
751 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
752 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
753
754 Various
755
756 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
757 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
758 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
759 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
760 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
761 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
762 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
763 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
764 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
765 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
766 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
767 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
768 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
769 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
770 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
771 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
772 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
773 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
774
775 Formatting Variables
776
777 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
778 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
779 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
780 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
781 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
782
783 XEmacs Enhancements
784
785 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
786 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
787 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
788 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
789
790 Picons
791
792 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
793 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
794 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
795 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
796 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
797
798 Appendices
799
800 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
801 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
802 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
803 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
804 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
805 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
806 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
807 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
808
809 History
810
811 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
812 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
813 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
814 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
815 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
816 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
817 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
818 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
819 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
820 * Newest Features:: Features so new that they haven't been written yet.
821
822 New Features
823
824 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
825 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.3/5.3.
826 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
827 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
828
829 Customization
830
831 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
832 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
833 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
834 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
835
836 Gnus Reference Guide
837
838 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
839 * Backend Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
840 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
841 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
842 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
843 * Group Info:: The group info format.
844 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
845 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
846 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
847
848 Backend Interface
849
850 * Required Backend Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
851 * Optional Backend Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
852 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
853 * Writing New Backends:: Extending old backends.
854 * Hooking New Backends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
855 * Mail-like Backends:: Some tips on mail backends.
856
857 Various File Formats
858
859 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
860 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
861
862 Emacs for Heathens
863
864 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
865 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
866
867 @end detailmenu
868 @end menu
869
870 @node Starting Up
871 @chapter Starting Gnus
872 @cindex starting up
873
874 @kindex M-x gnus
875 @findex gnus
876 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
877 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
878 your Emacs.
879
880 @findex gnus-other-frame
881 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
882 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
883 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
884
885 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
886 variables in your @file{~/.gnus} file. This file is similar to
887 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when gnus starts.
888
889 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
890 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
891
892 @menu
893 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
894 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
895 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
896 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
897 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
898 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
899 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
900 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
901 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
902 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
903 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
904 @end menu
905
906
907 @node Finding the News
908 @section Finding the News
909 @cindex finding news
910
911 @vindex gnus-select-method
912 @c @head
913 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
914 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
915 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
916 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
917 foreign groups.
918
919 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @sc{nntp} server is where
920 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
921
922 @lisp
923 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
924 @end lisp
925
926 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
927
928 @lisp
929 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
930 @end lisp
931
932 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
933 certainly be much faster.
934
935 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
936 @cindex NNTPSERVER
937 @cindex @sc{nntp} server
938 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
939 @code{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
940 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
941 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter. If
942 that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs as an @sc{nntp} server. That's a long shot, though.
943
944 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
945 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
946 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
947 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
948
949 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
950 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
951 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
952 @sc{nntp} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
953 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
954 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
955 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
956 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
957 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
958 server.)
959
960 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
961 @kindex B (Group)
962 However, if you use one @sc{nntp} server regularly and are just
963 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
964 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
965 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
966 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
967 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
968
969 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
970 @c @head
971 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
972 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
973 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
974 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
975 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
976 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
977 groups are.
978
979 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} backend to read your mail, you
980 would typically set this variable to
981
982 @lisp
983 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
984 @end lisp
985
986
987 @node The First Time
988 @section The First Time
989 @cindex first time usage
990
991 If no startup files exist, Gnus will try to determine what groups should
992 be subscribed by default.
993
994 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
995 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
996 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
997 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
998 something useful.
999
1000 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1001 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1002 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1003
1004 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1005 help you with most common problems.
1006
1007 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1008 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1009 special.
1010
1011
1012 @node The Server is Down
1013 @section The Server is Down
1014 @cindex server errors
1015
1016 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1017 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1018 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1019
1020 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1021 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1022 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1023 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1024 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1025 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1026 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1027
1028 @findex gnus-no-server
1029 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1030 @c @head
1031 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1032 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1033 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1034 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1035 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1036 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1037 levels.)
1038
1039
1040 @node Slave Gnusae
1041 @section Slave Gnusae
1042 @cindex slave
1043
1044 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1045 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1046 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1047 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1048
1049 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1050 @code{.newsrc} file.
1051
1052 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1053 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1054 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1055 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1056 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1057 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1058 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1059
1060 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1061 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1062 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1063 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1064 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1065 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1066 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1067 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1068
1069 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1070 information in the normal (i.e., master) @code{.newsrc} file.
1071
1072
1073 @node Fetching a Group
1074 @section Fetching a Group
1075 @cindex fetching a group
1076
1077 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1078 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1079 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
1080 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1081 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1082 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1083
1084
1085 @node New Groups
1086 @section New Groups
1087 @cindex new groups
1088 @cindex subscription
1089
1090 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1091 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1092 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1093 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1094 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1095 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1096 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1097 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the backends for new groups even
1098 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1099
1100 @menu
1101 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1102 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1103 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1104 @end menu
1105
1106
1107 @node Checking New Groups
1108 @subsection Checking New Groups
1109
1110 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1111 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1112 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1113 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1114 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1115 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1116 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1117 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1118 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1119 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1120
1121 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1122 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1123 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1124 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1125 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1126 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1127 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1128 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1129 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1130 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1131 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1132
1133 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1134 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1135 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1136 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1137 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1138 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1139
1140
1141 @node Subscription Methods
1142 @subsection Subscription Methods
1143
1144 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1145 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1146 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1147
1148 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1149 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1150
1151 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1152
1153 @table @code
1154
1155 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1156 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1157 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1158 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1159 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1160
1161 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1162 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1163 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1164 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1165
1166 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1167 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1168 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1169
1170 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1171 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1172 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1173 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1174 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1175 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1176 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1177 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1178 up. Or something like that.
1179
1180 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1181 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1182 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1183 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1184 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1185
1186 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1187 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1188 Kill all new groups.
1189
1190 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1191 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1192 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1193 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1194 topic parameter that looks like
1195
1196 @example
1197 "nnslashdot"
1198 @end example
1199
1200 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1201 that topic.
1202
1203 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1204 top-level topic.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1209 A closely related variable is
1210 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1211 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1212 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1213 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1214 hierarchy or not.
1215
1216 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1217 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1218 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1219 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1220
1221
1222 @node Filtering New Groups
1223 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1224
1225 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1226 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1227 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1228
1229 @example
1230 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1231 @end example
1232
1233 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1234 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1235 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1236 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1237 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1238 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1239 subscribing these groups.
1240 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1241 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1242
1243 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1244 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1245 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1246 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1247 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1248 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1249 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1250 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1251
1252 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1253 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1254 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1255 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous, but I
1256 thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is more
1257 meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is used
1258 more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new groups
1259 that come from mail backends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1260 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, and @code{nnmh}) subscribed. If you
1261 don't like that, just set this variable to @code{nil}.
1262
1263 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1264 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1265
1266
1267 @node Changing Servers
1268 @section Changing Servers
1269 @cindex changing servers
1270
1271 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @sc{nntp} server to another.
1272 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1273 very flaky and you want to use another.
1274
1275 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1276 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1277
1278 @emph{Wrong!}
1279
1280 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1281 @sc{nntp} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1282 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1283 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1284 worthless.
1285
1286 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1287 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1288 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1289 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1290
1291 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1292 @findex gnus-change-server
1293 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1294 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1295 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1296 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1297 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1298
1299 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1300 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1301 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1302 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1303 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1304
1305 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1306 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1307 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1308 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1309 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1310 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1311
1312 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1313 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1314 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1315
1316
1317 @node Startup Files
1318 @section Startup Files
1319 @cindex startup files
1320 @cindex .newsrc
1321 @cindex .newsrc.el
1322 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1323
1324 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1325 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1326
1327 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1328 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1329 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1330 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1331 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1332 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1333 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1334
1335 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1336 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1337 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1338 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1339 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1340 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1341
1342 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1343 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1344 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1345 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1346 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1347 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1348 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1349 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1350 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1351 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1352
1353 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1354 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1355 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1356 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1357 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1358 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1359 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1360 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1361 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1362 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1363 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1364 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1365
1366 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1367 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1368 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1369 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1370
1371 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1372 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1373 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1374 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1375 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1376 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1377 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1378 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1379 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1380 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1381
1382 @lisp
1383 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1384 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1385
1386 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1387 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1388 @end lisp
1389
1390 @vindex gnus-init-file
1391 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1392 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1393 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1394 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1395 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1396 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1397 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1398 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1399 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1400
1401
1402
1403 @node Auto Save
1404 @section Auto Save
1405 @cindex dribble file
1406 @cindex auto-save
1407
1408 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1409 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1410 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1411 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1412 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1413 this file.
1414
1415 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1416 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1417 saved.
1418
1419 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1420 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1421 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1422
1423 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1424 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1425 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1426 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1427 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1428 file permissions as the @code{.newsrc} file.
1429
1430 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1431 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1432 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1433
1434
1435 @node The Active File
1436 @section The Active File
1437 @cindex active file
1438 @cindex ignored groups
1439
1440 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1441 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1442 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1443
1444 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1445 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1446 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1447 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1448 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1449 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1450 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1451
1452 @c This variable is
1453 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1454 @c if you set it to anything else.
1455
1456 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1457 @c @head
1458 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1459 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1460 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1461
1462 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1463 you actually subscribe to.
1464
1465 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1466 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1467 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1468 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1469
1470 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1471 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1472 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1473 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1474 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1475 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1476
1477 Some news servers (Leafnode and old versions of INN, for instance) do
1478 not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these servers, @code{nil}
1479 is probably the most efficient value for this variable.
1480
1481 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1482 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1483 @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1484 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1485 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1486 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1487
1488 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1489 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1490
1491 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1492 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1493
1494 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1495 secondary select methods.
1496
1497
1498 @node Startup Variables
1499 @section Startup Variables
1500
1501 @table @code
1502
1503 @item gnus-load-hook
1504 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1505 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1506 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1507 times you start Gnus.
1508
1509 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1510 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1511 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1512
1513 @item gnus-startup-hook
1514 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1515 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1516
1517 @item gnus-started-hook
1518 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1519 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1520 successfully.
1521
1522 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1523 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1524 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1525 generating the group buffer.
1526
1527 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1528 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1529 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1530 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1531 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1532 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1533 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1534 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1535
1536 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1537 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1538 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1539 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1540 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1541 @file{.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @code{.emacs} instead.
1542
1543 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1544 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1545 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1546
1547 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1548 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1549 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1550
1551 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1552 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1553 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1554 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1555
1556 @end table
1557
1558
1559 @node The Group Buffer
1560 @chapter The Group Buffer
1561 @cindex group buffer
1562
1563 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1564 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1565 long as Gnus is active.
1566
1567 @iftex
1568 @iflatex
1569 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1570 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group.ps,height=9cm}}
1571 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1572 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1573 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1574 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1575 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1576 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1577 }
1578 @end iflatex
1579 @end iftex
1580
1581 @menu
1582 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1583 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1584 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1585 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1586 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1587 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1588 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1589 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1590 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1591 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1592 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1593 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1594 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1595 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1596 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1597 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1598 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1599 @end menu
1600
1601
1602 @node Group Buffer Format
1603 @section Group Buffer Format
1604
1605 @menu
1606 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1607 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
1608 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1609 @end menu
1610
1611
1612 @node Group Line Specification
1613 @subsection Group Line Specification
1614 @cindex group buffer format
1615
1616 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1617 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1618
1619 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1620
1621 @example
1622 25: news.announce.newusers
1623 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1624 @end example
1625
1626 Quite simple, huh?
1627
1628 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1629 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1630 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1631 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1632
1633 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1634 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1635 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1636 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1637 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1638 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1639
1640 @samp{%M%S%5y: %(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1641
1642 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1643 the colon after performing an operation. Nothing else is required---not
1644 even the group name. All displayed text is just window dressing, and is
1645 never examined by Gnus. Gnus stores all real information it needs using
1646 text properties.
1647
1648 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1649 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1650 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1651
1652 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1653
1654 @table @samp
1655
1656 @item M
1657 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1658
1659 @item S
1660 Whether the group is subscribed.
1661
1662 @item L
1663 Level of subscribedness.
1664
1665 @item N
1666 Number of unread articles.
1667
1668 @item I
1669 Number of dormant articles.
1670
1671 @item T
1672 Number of ticked articles.
1673
1674 @item R
1675 Number of read articles.
1676
1677 @item t
1678 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1679 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1680
1681 @item y
1682 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1683
1684 @item i
1685 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1686
1687 @item g
1688 Full group name.
1689
1690 @item G
1691 Group name.
1692
1693 @item D
1694 Newsgroup description.
1695
1696 @item o
1697 @samp{m} if moderated.
1698
1699 @item O
1700 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1701
1702 @item s
1703 Select method.
1704
1705 @item n
1706 Select from where.
1707
1708 @item z
1709 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1710 used.
1711
1712 @item P
1713 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1714
1715 @item c
1716 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1717 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1718 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1719 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1720 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1721
1722 @item m
1723 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1724 @cindex %
1725 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1726 the group lately.
1727
1728 @item d
1729 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1730 Timestamp}).
1731
1732 @item u
1733 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1734 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1735 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1736 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1737 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1738 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1739 specifier.
1740 @end table
1741
1742 @cindex *
1743 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1744 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1745 group, or a bogus native group.
1746
1747
1748 @node Group Modeline Specification
1749 @subsection Group Modeline Specification
1750 @cindex group modeline
1751
1752 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1753 The mode line can be changed by setting
1754 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1755 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1756
1757 @table @samp
1758 @item S
1759 The native news server.
1760 @item M
1761 The native select method.
1762 @end table
1763
1764
1765 @node Group Highlighting
1766 @subsection Group Highlighting
1767 @cindex highlighting
1768 @cindex group highlighting
1769
1770 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1771 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1772 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1773 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1774 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1775
1776 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1777 background is dark:
1778
1779 @lisp
1780 (cond (window-system
1781 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1782 (defface my-group-face-1
1783 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1784 (defface my-group-face-2
1785 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t))) "Second group face")
1786 (defface my-group-face-3
1787 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1788 (defface my-group-face-4
1789 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1790 (defface my-group-face-5
1791 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1792
1793 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1794 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1795 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1796 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1797 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1798 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1799 @end lisp
1800
1801 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1802
1803 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1804 include:
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @item group
1808 The group name.
1809 @item unread
1810 The number of unread articles in the group.
1811 @item method
1812 The select method.
1813 @item mailp
1814 Whether the group is a mail group.
1815 @item level
1816 The level of the group.
1817 @item score
1818 The score of the group.
1819 @item ticked
1820 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1821 @item total
1822 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather, MAX-NUMBER minus
1823 MIN-NUMBER plus one.
1824 @item topic
1825 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1826 topic being inserted.
1827 @end table
1828
1829 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1830 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1831 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1832
1833 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1834 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1835 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1836 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1837 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1838
1839
1840 @node Group Maneuvering
1841 @section Group Maneuvering
1842 @cindex group movement
1843
1844 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1845 expected, hopefully.
1846
1847 @table @kbd
1848
1849 @item n
1850 @kindex n (Group)
1851 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1852 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1853 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1854
1855 @item p
1856 @itemx DEL
1857 @kindex DEL (Group)
1858 @kindex p (Group)
1859 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1860 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1861 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1862
1863 @item N
1864 @kindex N (Group)
1865 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1866 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1867
1868 @item P
1869 @kindex P (Group)
1870 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1871 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1872
1873 @item M-n
1874 @kindex M-n (Group)
1875 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
1876 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
1877 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
1878
1879 @item M-p
1880 @kindex M-p (Group)
1881 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
1882 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
1883 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
1884 @end table
1885
1886 Three commands for jumping to groups:
1887
1888 @table @kbd
1889
1890 @item j
1891 @kindex j (Group)
1892 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
1893 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
1894 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
1895 like living groups.
1896
1897 @item ,
1898 @kindex , (Group)
1899 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
1900 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
1901 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
1902
1903 @item .
1904 @kindex . (Group)
1905 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
1906 Jump to the first group with unread articles
1907 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
1908 @end table
1909
1910 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
1911 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
1912 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
1913 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
1914 is @code{t}.
1915
1916
1917 @node Selecting a Group
1918 @section Selecting a Group
1919 @cindex group selection
1920
1921 @table @kbd
1922
1923 @item SPACE
1924 @kindex SPACE (Group)
1925 @findex gnus-group-read-group
1926 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
1927 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
1928 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
1929 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
1930 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{N}, @var{N}
1931 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{N} is
1932 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{N} newest articles, if @var{N} is
1933 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{N})} oldest articles.
1934
1935 @item RET
1936 @kindex RET (Group)
1937 @findex gnus-group-select-group
1938 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
1939 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
1940 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
1941 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
1942 entry.
1943
1944 @item M-RET
1945 @kindex M-RET (Group)
1946 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
1947 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
1948 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
1949 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
1950 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
1951 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
1952 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
1953 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
1954 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
1955
1956 @item M-SPACE
1957 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
1958 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
1959 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
1960 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
1961 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
1962
1963 @item M-C-RET
1964 @kindex M-C-RET (Group)
1965 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
1966 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
1967 doing any processing of its contents
1968 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
1969 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
1970 manner will have no permanent effects.
1971
1972 @end table
1973
1974 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
1975 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should consider
1976 to be a big group. This is 200 by default. If the group has more
1977 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
1978 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many articles
1979 should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a negative
1980 number (@code{-n}), the @code{n} oldest articles will be fetched. If it
1981 is positive, the @code{n} articles that have arrived most recently will
1982 be fetched.
1983
1984 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
1985 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
1986 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} control whether any articles are selected
1987 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
1988
1989 @table @code
1990
1991 @item nil
1992 Don't select any articles when entering the group. Just display the
1993 full summary buffer.
1994
1995 @item t
1996 Select the first unread article when entering the group.
1997
1998 @item best
1999 Select the highest scored article in the group when entering the
2000 group.
2001
2002 @end table
2003
2004 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2005 be called to place point on a subject line, and/or select some article.
2006 Useful functions include:
2007
2008 @table @code
2009 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-subject
2010 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article, but
2011 don't select the article.
2012
2013 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-article
2014 Select the first unread article.
2015
2016 @item gnus-summary-best-unread-article
2017 Select the highest-scored unread article.
2018 @end table
2019
2020
2021 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2022 binary group with Huge articles) you can set this variable to @code{nil}
2023 in @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2024 selected.
2025
2026
2027 @node Subscription Commands
2028 @section Subscription Commands
2029 @cindex subscription
2030
2031 @table @kbd
2032
2033 @item S t
2034 @itemx u
2035 @kindex S t (Group)
2036 @kindex u (Group)
2037 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2038 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2039 Toggle subscription to the current group
2040 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2041
2042 @item S s
2043 @itemx U
2044 @kindex S s (Group)
2045 @kindex U (Group)
2046 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2047 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2048 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2049 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2050
2051 @item S k
2052 @itemx C-k
2053 @kindex S k (Group)
2054 @kindex C-k (Group)
2055 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2056 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2057 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2058
2059 @item S y
2060 @itemx C-y
2061 @kindex S y (Group)
2062 @kindex C-y (Group)
2063 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2064 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2065
2066 @item C-x C-t
2067 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2068 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2069 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2070 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2071 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2072
2073 @item S w
2074 @itemx C-w
2075 @kindex S w (Group)
2076 @kindex C-w (Group)
2077 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2078 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2079
2080 @item S z
2081 @kindex S z (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2083 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2084
2085 @item S C-k
2086 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2087 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2088 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2089 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2090 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2091 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2092 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2093 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2094 @file{.newsrc} file.
2095
2096 @end table
2097
2098 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2099
2100
2101 @node Group Data
2102 @section Group Data
2103
2104 @table @kbd
2105
2106 @item c
2107 @kindex c (Group)
2108 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2109 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2110 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2111 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2112 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2113 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2114 the group buffer.
2115
2116 @item C
2117 @kindex C (Group)
2118 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2119 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2120 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2121
2122 @item M-c
2123 @kindex M-c (Group)
2124 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2125 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2126 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2127
2128 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2129 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2130 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2131 If you have switched from one @sc{nntp} server to another, all your marks
2132 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2133 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2134 caution.
2135
2136 @end table
2137
2138
2139 @node Group Levels
2140 @section Group Levels
2141 @cindex group level
2142 @cindex level
2143
2144 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2145 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2146 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2147 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2148 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2149
2150 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2151
2152 @table @kbd
2153
2154 @item S l
2155 @kindex S l (Group)
2156 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2157 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2158 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2159 prompted for a level.
2160 @end table
2161
2162 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2163 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2164 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2165 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2166 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2167 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2168 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2169 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2170 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2171 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2172 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2173 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2174 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2175 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2176 reasons of efficiency.
2177
2178 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2179 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2180
2181 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2182 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2183 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2184 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2185 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2186 groups are hidden, in a way.
2187
2188 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2189 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2190 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2191 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2192 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2193 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2194
2195 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2196 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2197 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2198 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2199 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2200 list of killed groups.)
2201
2202 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2203 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2204 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2205
2206 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2207 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2208 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2209 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2210 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2211 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2212 relevant valid ranges.
2213
2214 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2215 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2216 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2217 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2218 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2219 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2220 rest.
2221
2222 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2223 one with the best level.
2224
2225 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2226 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2227 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2228 by default.
2229
2230 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2231 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2232 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2233 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2234 listed.
2235
2236 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2237 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2238 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2239 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2240
2241 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2242 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2243 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2244 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2245 to 5. The default is 6.
2246
2247
2248 @node Group Score
2249 @section Group Score
2250 @cindex group score
2251 @cindex group rank
2252 @cindex rank
2253
2254 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2255 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2256 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2257 reason?
2258
2259 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2260 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2261 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2262 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2263 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2264 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2265 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2266 least significant part.))
2267
2268 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2269 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2270 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2271 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2272 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2273 action after each summary exit, you can add
2274 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2275 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2276 slow things down somewhat.
2277
2278
2279 @node Marking Groups
2280 @section Marking Groups
2281 @cindex marking groups
2282
2283 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2284 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2285 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2286 bidding on those groups.
2287
2288 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2289 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2290 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2291
2292 @table @kbd
2293
2294 @item #
2295 @kindex # (Group)
2296 @itemx M m
2297 @kindex M m (Group)
2298 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2299 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2300
2301 @item M-#
2302 @kindex M-# (Group)
2303 @itemx M u
2304 @kindex M u (Group)
2305 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2306 Remove the mark from the current group
2307 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2308
2309 @item M U
2310 @kindex M U (Group)
2311 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2312 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2313
2314 @item M w
2315 @kindex M w (Group)
2316 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2317 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2318
2319 @item M b
2320 @kindex M b (Group)
2321 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2322 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2323
2324 @item M r
2325 @kindex M r (Group)
2326 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2327 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2328 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2329 @end table
2330
2331 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2332
2333 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2334 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2335 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2336 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2337 the command to be executed.
2338
2339
2340 @node Foreign Groups
2341 @section Foreign Groups
2342 @cindex foreign groups
2343
2344 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2345 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2346 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2347 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2348 consulted.
2349
2350 @table @kbd
2351
2352 @item G m
2353 @kindex G m (Group)
2354 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2355 @cindex making groups
2356 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2357 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2358 to subscribe to @sc{nntp} groups, @pxref{Browse Foreign Server}.
2359
2360 @item G r
2361 @kindex G r (Group)
2362 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2363 @cindex renaming groups
2364 Rename the current group to something else
2365 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2366 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2367 on some backends.
2368
2369 @item G c
2370 @kindex G c (Group)
2371 @cindex customizing
2372 @findex gnus-group-customize
2373 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2374
2375 @item G e
2376 @kindex G e (Group)
2377 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2378 @cindex renaming groups
2379 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2380 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2381
2382 @item G p
2383 @kindex G p (Group)
2384 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2385 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2386 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2387
2388 @item G E
2389 @kindex G E (Group)
2390 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2391 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2392 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2393
2394 @item G d
2395 @kindex G d (Group)
2396 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2397 @cindex nndir
2398 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2399 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2400
2401 @item G h
2402 @kindex G h (Group)
2403 @cindex help group
2404 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2405 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2406
2407 @item G a
2408 @kindex G a (Group)
2409 @cindex (ding) archive
2410 @cindex archive group
2411 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2412 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2413 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2414 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2415 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2416 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2417 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2418
2419 @item G k
2420 @kindex G k (Group)
2421 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2422 @cindex nnkiboze
2423 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2424 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2425 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2426 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2427
2428 @item G D
2429 @kindex G D (Group)
2430 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2431 @cindex nneething
2432 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2433 @code{nneething} backend (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2434 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2435
2436 @item G f
2437 @kindex G f (Group)
2438 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2439 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2440 @cindex nndoc
2441 Make a group based on some file or other
2442 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2443 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2444 Currently supported types are @code{babyl}, @code{mbox}, @code{digest},
2445 @code{mmdf}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{clari-briefs},
2446 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{nsmail} and @code{forward}.
2447 If you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2448 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2449
2450 @item G u
2451 @kindex G u (Group)
2452 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2453 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2454 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2455 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2456
2457 @item G w
2458 @kindex G w (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2460 @cindex DejaNews
2461 @cindex Alta Vista
2462 @cindex InReference
2463 @cindex nnweb
2464 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2465 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2466 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2467 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2468 include @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and @code{reference}.
2469 @xref{Web Searches}.
2470
2471 If you use the @code{dejanews} search engine, you can limit the search
2472 to a particular group by using a match string like
2473 @samp{~g alt.sysadmin.recovery shaving}.
2474
2475 @item G DEL
2476 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2477 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2478 This function will delete the current group
2479 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2480 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2481 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2482 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2483 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} group), though.
2484
2485 @item G V
2486 @kindex G V (Group)
2487 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2488 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2489 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2490
2491 @item G v
2492 @kindex G v (Group)
2493 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2494 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2495 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2496 @end table
2497
2498 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2499 methods.
2500
2501 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2502 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2503 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2504 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2505 groups from different @sc{nntp} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2506 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2507 newsgroups.
2508
2509
2510 @node Group Parameters
2511 @section Group Parameters
2512 @cindex group parameters
2513
2514 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2515 Here's an example group parameter list:
2516
2517 @example
2518 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2519 (auto-expire . t))
2520 @end example
2521
2522 We see that each element consists of a "dotted pair"---the thing before
2523 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2524 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2525 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2526
2527 The following group parameters can be used:
2528
2529 @table @code
2530 @item to-address
2531 @cindex to-address
2532 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2533
2534 @example
2535 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2536 @end example
2537
2538 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2539 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2540 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2541 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2542 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2543
2544 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2545 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2546 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2547 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2548 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2549 list address instead.
2550
2551 @item to-list
2552 @cindex to-list
2553 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2554
2555 @example
2556 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2557 @end example
2558
2559 It is totally ignored
2560 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2561 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2562
2563 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2564 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2565 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2566 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2567 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2568
2569 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you don't have a
2570 @code{to-list} group parameter, one will be added automatically upon
2571 sending the message.
2572
2573 @item visible
2574 @cindex visible
2575 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2576 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2577 of whether it has any unread articles.
2578
2579 @item broken-reply-to
2580 @cindex broken-reply-to
2581 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2582 headers in this group are to be ignored. This can be useful if you're
2583 reading a mailing list group where the listserv has inserted
2584 @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv itself. This is
2585 broken behavior. So there!
2586
2587 @item to-group
2588 @cindex to-group
2589 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2590 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2591
2592 @item newsgroup
2593 @cindex newsgroup
2594 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2595 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2596 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2597 news group.
2598
2599 @item gcc-self
2600 @cindex gcc-self
2601 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2602 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2603 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2604 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2605 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2606 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2607 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2608
2609 @item auto-expire
2610 @cindex auto-expire
2611 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2612 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2613 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2614
2615 @item total-expire
2616 @cindex total-expire
2617 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2618 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2619 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2620 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2621 expiry.
2622
2623 @item expiry-wait
2624 @cindex expiry-wait
2625 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2626 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(expiry-wait
2627 . 10)}, this value will override any @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and
2628 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} when expiring expirable messages.
2629 The value can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or
2630 the symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2631
2632 @item score-file
2633 @cindex score file group parameter
2634 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2635 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2636 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2637
2638 @item adapt-file
2639 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2640 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2641 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2642 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2643
2644 @item admin-address
2645 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2646 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2647 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2648 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2649
2650 @item display
2651 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2652 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2653
2654 @table @code
2655 @item all
2656 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2657
2658 @item default
2659 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2660 ticked articles.
2661 @end table
2662
2663 @item comment
2664 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")}
2665 are arbitrary comments on the group. They are currently ignored by
2666 Gnus, but provide a place for you to store information on particular
2667 groups.
2668
2669 @item charset
2670 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2671 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2672 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2673
2674 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2675 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2676 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2677 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2678 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2679 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2680 @code{eval}ed there.
2681
2682 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you'd like.
2683 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
2684 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
2685 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
2686 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
2687
2688 @item posting-style
2689 You can store additional posting style information for this group only
2690 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2691 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2692 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2693 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2694
2695 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2696 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2697 like this in the group parameters:
2698
2699 @example
2700 (posting-style
2701 (name "Funky Name")
2702 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2703 @end example
2704
2705 @end table
2706
2707 Use the @kbd{G p} command to edit group parameters of a group. You
2708 might also be interested in reading about topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
2709 Parameters}).
2710
2711
2712 @node Listing Groups
2713 @section Listing Groups
2714 @cindex group listing
2715
2716 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
2717
2718 @table @kbd
2719
2720 @item l
2721 @itemx A s
2722 @kindex A s (Group)
2723 @kindex l (Group)
2724 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
2725 List all groups that have unread articles
2726 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
2727 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
2728 only lists groups of level five (i. e.,
2729 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
2730 groups).
2731
2732 @item L
2733 @itemx A u
2734 @kindex A u (Group)
2735 @kindex L (Group)
2736 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
2737 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
2738 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
2739 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
2740 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
2741 unsubscribed groups).
2742
2743 @item A l
2744 @kindex A l (Group)
2745 @findex gnus-group-list-level
2746 List all unread groups on a specific level
2747 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
2748 with no unread articles.
2749
2750 @item A k
2751 @kindex A k (Group)
2752 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
2753 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
2754 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
2755 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
2756 from the server.
2757
2758 @item A z
2759 @kindex A z (Group)
2760 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
2761 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
2762
2763 @item A m
2764 @kindex A m (Group)
2765 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
2766 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
2767 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
2768
2769 @item A M
2770 @kindex A M (Group)
2771 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
2772 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
2773
2774 @item A A
2775 @kindex A A (Group)
2776 @findex gnus-group-list-active
2777 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
2778 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
2779 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
2780 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
2781 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
2782 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
2783 Take the output with some grains of salt.
2784
2785 @item A a
2786 @kindex A a (Group)
2787 @findex gnus-group-apropos
2788 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
2789 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
2790
2791 @item A d
2792 @kindex A d (Group)
2793 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
2794 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
2795 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
2796
2797 @item A c
2798 @kindex A c (Group)
2799 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
2800 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
2801
2802 @item A ?
2803 @kindex A ? (Group)
2804 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
2805 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
2806
2807 @end table
2808
2809 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2810 @cindex visible group parameter
2811 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
2812 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
2813 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
2814 get the same effect.
2815
2816 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
2817 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
2818 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
2819 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
2820 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
2821
2822
2823 @node Sorting Groups
2824 @section Sorting Groups
2825 @cindex sorting groups
2826
2827 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
2828 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
2829 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
2830 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
2831 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
2832 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
2833 include:
2834
2835 @table @code
2836
2837 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2838 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2839 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
2840
2841 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2842 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2843 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
2844
2845 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
2846 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
2847 Sort by group level.
2848
2849 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
2850 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
2851 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
2852
2853 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2854 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2855 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
2856 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
2857
2858 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2859 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2860 Sort by number of unread articles.
2861
2862 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
2863 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
2864 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
2865
2866
2867 @end table
2868
2869 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
2870 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
2871 the last one.
2872
2873
2874 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
2875 some sorting criteria:
2876
2877 @table @kbd
2878 @item G S a
2879 @kindex G S a (Group)
2880 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
2881 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
2882 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
2883
2884 @item G S u
2885 @kindex G S u (Group)
2886 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
2887 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
2888 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
2889
2890 @item G S l
2891 @kindex G S l (Group)
2892 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
2893 Sort the group buffer by group level
2894 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
2895
2896 @item G S v
2897 @kindex G S v (Group)
2898 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
2899 Sort the group buffer by group score
2900 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2901
2902 @item G S r
2903 @kindex G S r (Group)
2904 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
2905 Sort the group buffer by group rank
2906 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2907
2908 @item G S m
2909 @kindex G S m (Group)
2910 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
2911 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by backend name
2912 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
2913
2914 @end table
2915
2916 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
2917 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2918
2919 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
2920 commands will sort in reverse order.
2921
2922 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
2923
2924 @table @kbd
2925 @item G P a
2926 @kindex G P a (Group)
2927 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
2928 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
2929 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
2930
2931 @item G P u
2932 @kindex G P u (Group)
2933 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
2934 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
2935 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
2936
2937 @item G P l
2938 @kindex G P l (Group)
2939 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
2940 Sort the groups by group level
2941 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
2942
2943 @item G P v
2944 @kindex G P v (Group)
2945 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
2946 Sort the groups by group score
2947 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2948
2949 @item G P r
2950 @kindex G P r (Group)
2951 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
2952 Sort the groups by group rank
2953 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2954
2955 @item G P m
2956 @kindex G P m (Group)
2957 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
2958 Sort the groups alphabetically by backend name
2959 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
2960
2961 @end table
2962
2963
2964
2965 @node Group Maintenance
2966 @section Group Maintenance
2967 @cindex bogus groups
2968
2969 @table @kbd
2970 @item b
2971 @kindex b (Group)
2972 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
2973 Find bogus groups and delete them
2974 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
2975
2976 @item F
2977 @kindex F (Group)
2978 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
2979 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
2980 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
2981 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
2982 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
2983 zombies.
2984
2985 @item C-c C-x
2986 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
2987 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
2988 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
2989 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}).
2990
2991 @item C-c M-C-x
2992 @kindex C-c M-C-x (Group)
2993 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
2994 Run all articles in all groups through the expiry process
2995 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
2996
2997 @end table
2998
2999
3000 @node Browse Foreign Server
3001 @section Browse Foreign Server
3002 @cindex foreign servers
3003 @cindex browsing servers
3004
3005 @table @kbd
3006 @item B
3007 @kindex B (Group)
3008 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3009 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3010 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3011 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3012 @end table
3013
3014 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3015 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3016 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3017 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3018
3019 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3020
3021 @table @kbd
3022 @item n
3023 @kindex n (Browse)
3024 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3025 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3026
3027 @item p
3028 @kindex p (Browse)
3029 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3030 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3031
3032 @item SPACE
3033 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3034 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3035 Enter the current group and display the first article
3036 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3037
3038 @item RET
3039 @kindex RET (Browse)
3040 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3041 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3042
3043 @item u
3044 @kindex u (Browse)
3045 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3046 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3047 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3048
3049 @item l
3050 @itemx q
3051 @kindex q (Browse)
3052 @kindex l (Browse)
3053 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3054 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3055
3056 @item ?
3057 @kindex ? (Browse)
3058 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3059 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3060 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3061 @end table
3062
3063
3064 @node Exiting Gnus
3065 @section Exiting Gnus
3066 @cindex exiting Gnus
3067
3068 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3069
3070 @table @kbd
3071 @item z
3072 @kindex z (Group)
3073 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3074 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3075 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3076 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3077
3078 @item q
3079 @kindex q (Group)
3080 @findex gnus-group-exit
3081 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3082 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3083
3084 @item Q
3085 @kindex Q (Group)
3086 @findex gnus-group-quit
3087 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3088 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3089 @end table
3090
3091 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3092 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3093 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3094 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3095 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3096 exiting Gnus.
3097
3098 @findex gnus-unload
3099 @cindex unloading
3100 If you wish to completely unload Gnus and all its adherents, you can use
3101 the @code{gnus-unload} command. This command is also very handy when
3102 trying to customize meta-variables.
3103
3104 Note:
3105
3106 @quotation
3107 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3108 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3109 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3110 plastic chair.
3111 @end quotation
3112
3113
3114 @node Group Topics
3115 @section Group Topics
3116 @cindex topics
3117
3118 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3119 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3120 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3121 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3122 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3123 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3124
3125 @iftex
3126 @iflatex
3127 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3128 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group-topic.ps,height=9cm}}
3129 }
3130 @end iflatex
3131 @end iftex
3132
3133 Here's an example:
3134
3135 @example
3136 Gnus
3137 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3138 3: comp.emacs
3139 2: alt.religion.emacs
3140 Naughty Emacs
3141 452: alt.sex.emacs
3142 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3143 Misc
3144 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3145 13: comp.sources.unix
3146 @end example
3147
3148 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3149 @kindex t (Group)
3150 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3151 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3152 is a toggling command.)
3153
3154 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3155 dum... Nice tune, that... la la la... What, you're back? Yes, and now
3156 press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed under
3157 @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy? Hot and
3158 bothered?
3159
3160 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3161 the hook for the group mode:
3162
3163 @lisp
3164 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3165 @end lisp
3166
3167 @menu
3168 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3169 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3170 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3171 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3172 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3173 @end menu
3174
3175
3176 @node Topic Variables
3177 @subsection Topic Variables
3178 @cindex topic variables
3179
3180 Now, if you select a topic, it will fold/unfold that topic, which is
3181 really neat, I think.
3182
3183 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3184 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3185 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3186 Valid elements are:
3187
3188 @table @samp
3189 @item i
3190 Indentation.
3191 @item n
3192 Topic name.
3193 @item v
3194 Visibility.
3195 @item l
3196 Level.
3197 @item g
3198 Number of groups in the topic.
3199 @item a
3200 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3201 @item A
3202 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3203 @end table
3204
3205 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3206 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3207 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3208 The default is 2.
3209
3210 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3211 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3212
3213 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3214 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3215 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3216
3217
3218 @node Topic Commands
3219 @subsection Topic Commands
3220 @cindex topic commands
3221
3222 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3223 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3224 definitions slightly.
3225
3226 @table @kbd
3227
3228 @item T n
3229 @kindex T n (Topic)
3230 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3231 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3232 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3233
3234 @item T m
3235 @kindex T m (Topic)
3236 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3237 Move the current group to some other topic
3238 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3239 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3240
3241 @item T j
3242 @kindex T j (Topic)
3243 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3244 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3245
3246 @item T c
3247 @kindex T c (Topic)
3248 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3249 Copy the current group to some other topic
3250 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3251 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3252
3253 @item T h
3254 @kindex T h (Topic)
3255 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3256 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3257 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3258
3259 @item T s
3260 @kindex T s (Topic)
3261 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3262 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3263 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3264
3265 @item T D
3266 @kindex T D (Topic)
3267 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3268 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3269 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3270 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3271 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3272 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3273 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3274 topic.
3275
3276 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3277 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3278
3279 @item T M
3280 @kindex T M (Topic)
3281 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3282 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3283 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3284
3285 @item T C
3286 @kindex T C (Topic)
3287 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3288 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3289 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3290
3291 @item T H
3292 @kindex T H (Topic)
3293 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3294 Toggle hiding empty topics
3295 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3296
3297 @item T #
3298 @kindex T # (Topic)
3299 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3300 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3301 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}).
3302
3303 @item T M-#
3304 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3305 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3306 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3307 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}).
3308
3309 @item T TAB
3310 @itemx TAB
3311 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3312 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3313 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3314 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3315 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3316 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3317
3318 @item M-TAB
3319 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3320 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3321 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3322 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3323
3324 @item RET
3325 @kindex RET (Topic)
3326 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3327 @itemx SPACE
3328 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3329 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3330 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3331 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3332 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3333 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3334
3335 @item C-c C-x
3336 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3337 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3338 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the expiry
3339 process (if any) (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}).
3340
3341 @item C-k
3342 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3343 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3344 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3345 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3346
3347 @item C-y
3348 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3349 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3350 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3351 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3352 before all groups.
3353
3354 @item T r
3355 @kindex T r (Topic)
3356 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3357 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3358
3359 @item T DEL
3360 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3361 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3362 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3363
3364 @item A T
3365 @kindex A T (Topic)
3366 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3367 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3368 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3369
3370 @item G p
3371 @kindex G p (Topic)
3372 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3373 @cindex group parameters
3374 @cindex topic parameters
3375 @cindex parameters
3376 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3377 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3378
3379 @end table
3380
3381
3382 @node Topic Sorting
3383 @subsection Topic Sorting
3384 @cindex topic sorting
3385
3386 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3387 commands:
3388
3389
3390 @table @kbd
3391 @item T S a
3392 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3393 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3394 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3395 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3396
3397 @item T S u
3398 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3399 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3400 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3401 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3402
3403 @item T S l
3404 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3405 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3406 Sort the current topic by group level
3407 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3408
3409 @item T S v
3410 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3411 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3412 Sort the current topic by group score
3413 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3414
3415 @item T S r
3416 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3417 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3418 Sort the current topic by group rank
3419 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3420
3421 @item T S m
3422 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3423 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3424 Sort the current topic alphabetically by backend name
3425 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3426
3427 @end table
3428
3429 @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group sorting.
3430
3431
3432 @node Topic Topology
3433 @subsection Topic Topology
3434 @cindex topic topology
3435 @cindex topology
3436
3437 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3438
3439 @example
3440 Gnus
3441 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3442 3: comp.emacs
3443 2: alt.religion.emacs
3444 Naughty Emacs
3445 452: alt.sex.emacs
3446 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3447 Misc
3448 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3449 13: comp.sources.unix
3450 @end example
3451
3452 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3453 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3454 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3455 follows:
3456
3457 @lisp
3458 (("Gnus" visible)
3459 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3460 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3461 (("Misc" visible)))
3462 @end lisp
3463
3464 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3465 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3466 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3467 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3468 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3469 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3470
3471 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3472 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3473 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3474
3475
3476 @node Topic Parameters
3477 @subsection Topic Parameters
3478 @cindex topic parameters
3479
3480 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent (and
3481 ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid topic
3482 parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
3483
3484 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3485 parameters:
3486
3487 @table @code
3488 @item subscribe
3489 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3490 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3491 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3492 topic.
3493
3494 @end table
3495
3496 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3497 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3498 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3499 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3500
3501 @example
3502 Gnus
3503 Emacs
3504 3: comp.emacs
3505 2: alt.religion.emacs
3506 452: alt.sex.emacs
3507 Relief
3508 452: alt.sex.emacs
3509 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3510 Misc
3511 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3512 13: comp.sources.unix
3513 452: alt.sex.emacs
3514 @end example
3515
3516 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3517 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3518 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3519 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3520 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3521 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3522
3523 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3524 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3525 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
3526 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
3527 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
3528
3529 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
3530 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
3531 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
3532 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
3533 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
3534 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
3535 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
3536 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
3537
3538
3539 @node Misc Group Stuff
3540 @section Misc Group Stuff
3541
3542 @menu
3543 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
3544 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
3545 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
3546 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
3547 @end menu
3548
3549 @table @kbd
3550
3551 @item ^
3552 @kindex ^ (Group)
3553 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
3554 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
3555 @xref{The Server Buffer}.
3556
3557 @item a
3558 @kindex a (Group)
3559 @findex gnus-group-post-news
3560 Post an article to a group (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a
3561 prefix, the current group name will be used as the default.
3562
3563 @item m
3564 @kindex m (Group)
3565 @findex gnus-group-mail
3566 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}).
3567
3568 @end table
3569
3570 Variables for the group buffer:
3571
3572 @table @code
3573
3574 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
3575 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
3576 is called after the group buffer has been
3577 created.
3578
3579 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
3580 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3581 is called after the group buffer is
3582 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
3583 unnatural way.
3584
3585 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
3586 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3587 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
3588 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
3589
3590 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3591 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3592 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
3593 whether they are empty or not.
3594
3595 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3596 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3597 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
3598 non-ASCII group names.
3599
3600 For example:
3601 @lisp
3602 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3603 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
3604 @end lisp
3605
3606 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3607 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3608 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
3609 It is used to show non-ASCII group names.
3610
3611 For example:
3612 @lisp
3613 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3614 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
3615 @end lisp
3616
3617 @end table
3618
3619 @node Scanning New Messages
3620 @subsection Scanning New Messages
3621 @cindex new messages
3622 @cindex scanning new news
3623
3624 @table @kbd
3625
3626 @item g
3627 @kindex g (Group)
3628 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
3629 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
3630 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
3631 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
3632 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
3633 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
3634 backend(s).
3635
3636 @item M-g
3637 @kindex M-g (Group)
3638 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
3639 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
3640 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
3641 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
3642 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
3643 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
3644 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
3645
3646 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
3647 @cindex activating groups
3648 @item C-c M-g
3649 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
3650 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
3651
3652 @item R
3653 @kindex R (Group)
3654 @cindex restarting
3655 @findex gnus-group-restart
3656 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
3657 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
3658 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
3659
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
3663 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
3664
3665 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
3666 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
3667 news.
3668
3669
3670 @node Group Information
3671 @subsection Group Information
3672 @cindex group information
3673 @cindex information on groups
3674
3675 @table @kbd
3676
3677
3678 @item H f
3679 @kindex H f (Group)
3680 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
3681 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
3682 @cindex FAQ
3683 @cindex ange-ftp
3684 Try to fetch the FAQ for the current group
3685 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the FAQ from
3686 @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on a
3687 remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories. In
3688 that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
3689 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be used
3690 for fetching the file.
3691
3692 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
3693 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
3694
3695 @item H d
3696 @itemx C-c C-d
3697 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
3698 @kindex H d (Group)
3699 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
3700 @cindex describing groups
3701 @cindex group description
3702 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
3703 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
3704 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
3705
3706 @item M-d
3707 @kindex M-d (Group)
3708 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
3709 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
3710 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
3711
3712 @item H v
3713 @itemx V
3714 @kindex V (Group)
3715 @kindex H v (Group)
3716 @cindex version
3717 @findex gnus-version
3718 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
3719
3720 @item ?
3721 @kindex ? (Group)
3722 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
3723 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
3724
3725 @item C-c C-i
3726 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
3727 @cindex info
3728 @cindex manual
3729 @findex gnus-info-find-node
3730 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
3731 @end table
3732
3733
3734 @node Group Timestamp
3735 @subsection Group Timestamp
3736 @cindex timestamps
3737 @cindex group timestamps
3738
3739 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
3740 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
3741 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
3742
3743 @lisp
3744 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
3745 @end lisp
3746
3747 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
3748
3749 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
3750 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
3751
3752 @lisp
3753 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3754 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
3755 @end lisp
3756
3757 This will result in lines looking like:
3758
3759 @example
3760 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
3761 0: custom 19961002T012713
3762 @end example
3763
3764 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
3765 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
3766 something like:
3767
3768 @lisp
3769 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3770 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
3771 @end lisp
3772
3773
3774 @node File Commands
3775 @subsection File Commands
3776 @cindex file commands
3777
3778 @table @kbd
3779
3780 @item r
3781 @kindex r (Group)
3782 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
3783 @vindex gnus-init-file
3784 @cindex reading init file
3785 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
3786 @file{~/.gnus}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
3787
3788 @item s
3789 @kindex s (Group)
3790 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
3791 @cindex saving .newsrc
3792 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
3793 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
3794 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
3795
3796 @c @item Z
3797 @c @kindex Z (Group)
3798 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
3799 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
3800
3801 @end table
3802
3803
3804 @node The Summary Buffer
3805 @chapter The Summary Buffer
3806 @cindex summary buffer
3807
3808 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
3809 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
3810
3811 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
3812 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
3813
3814 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
3815
3816 @menu
3817 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
3818 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
3819 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
3820 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
3821 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
3822 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
3823 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
3824 * Threading:: How threads are made.
3825 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
3826 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
3827 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
3828 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
3829 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
3830 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
3831 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
3832 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
3833 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
3834 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
3835 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
3836 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
3837 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
3838 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
3839 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
3840 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
3841 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
3842 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
3843 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
3844 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
3845 @end menu
3846
3847
3848 @node Summary Buffer Format
3849 @section Summary Buffer Format
3850 @cindex summary buffer format
3851
3852 @iftex
3853 @iflatex
3854 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
3855 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary.ps,width=7.5cm}}
3856 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-article.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
3857 }
3858 @end iflatex
3859 @end iftex
3860
3861 @menu
3862 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
3863 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
3864 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
3865 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
3866 @end menu
3867
3868 @findex mail-extract-address-components
3869 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
3870 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
3871 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
3872 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
3873 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
3874 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
3875 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
3876 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
3877 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
3878 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
3879
3880 @lisp
3881 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
3882 'mail-extract-address-components)
3883 @end lisp
3884
3885 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
3886 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
3887 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
3888 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
3889
3890
3891 @node Summary Buffer Lines
3892 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
3893
3894 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
3895 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
3896 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
3897 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
3898 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3899
3900 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%) %s\n}.
3901
3902 The following format specification characters are understood:
3903
3904 @table @samp
3905 @item N
3906 Article number.
3907 @item S
3908 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
3909 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
3910 @item s
3911 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
3912 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
3913 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
3914 @item F
3915 Full @code{From} header.
3916 @item n
3917 The name (from the @code{From} header).
3918 @item f
3919 The name, code @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header
3920 (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
3921 @item a
3922 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
3923 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
3924 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
3925 may be more thorough.
3926 @item A
3927 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
3928 the @code{a} spec.
3929 @item L
3930 Number of lines in the article.
3931 @item c
3932 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported in some
3933 methods (like nnfolder).
3934 @item I
3935 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3936 @item T
3937 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
3938 pushes everything after it off the screen).
3939 @item [
3940 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
3941 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3942 @item ]
3943 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
3944 for adopted articles.
3945 @item >
3946 One space for each thread level.
3947 @item <
3948 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
3949 @item U
3950 Unread.
3951
3952 @item R
3953 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
3954 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
3955 or has been saved.
3956
3957 @item i
3958 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
3959 @item z
3960 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
3961 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
3962 default level. If the difference between
3963 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
3964 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
3965 @item V
3966 Total thread score.
3967 @item x
3968 @code{Xref}.
3969 @item D
3970 @code{Date}.
3971 @item d
3972 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
3973 @item o
3974 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
3975 @item M
3976 @code{Message-ID}.
3977 @item r
3978 @code{References}.
3979 @item t
3980 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
3981 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
3982 @item e
3983 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
3984 article has any children.
3985 @item P
3986 The line number.
3987 @item O
3988 Download mark.
3989 @item u
3990 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
3991 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
3992 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
3993 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
3994 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
3995 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
3996 @end table
3997
3998 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
3999 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4000 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4001 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4002 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4003 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4004
4005 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4006 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4007
4008 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4009
4010
4011 @node To From Newsgroups
4012 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4013 @cindex To
4014 @cindex Newsgroups
4015
4016 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4017 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4018 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4019 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4020 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4021
4022 @enumerate
4023 @item
4024 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4025 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4026 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4027 instance:
4028
4029 @lisp
4030 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4031 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4032 @end lisp
4033
4034 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4035 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4036
4037 @item
4038 @findex gnus-extra-header
4039 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4040 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4041 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4042
4043 @example
4044 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4045 @end example
4046
4047 @item
4048 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4049 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4050 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4051 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4052 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4053 headers are used instead.
4054
4055 @end enumerate
4056
4057 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4058 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4059 to include extra headers when generating overview (@sc{nov}) files. If
4060 you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after changing
4061 this variable.
4062
4063 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4064 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4065 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4066 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4067
4068 In summary, you'd typically do something like the following:
4069
4070 @lisp
4071 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4072 '(To Newsgroups))
4073 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4074 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4075 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20f%]%) %s\n")
4076 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4077 "Your Name Here")
4078 @end lisp
4079
4080 Now, this is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4081 the @sc{nov} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4082 nntp admin to add:
4083
4084 @example
4085 Newsgroups:full
4086 @end example
4087
4088 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4089 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4090
4091
4092 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4093 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4094
4095 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4096 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4097 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4098 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4099
4100 Here are the elements you can play with:
4101
4102 @table @samp
4103 @item G
4104 Group name.
4105 @item p
4106 Unprefixed group name.
4107 @item A
4108 Current article number.
4109 @item z
4110 Current article score.
4111 @item V
4112 Gnus version.
4113 @item U
4114 Number of unread articles in this group.
4115 @item e
4116 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4117 summary buffer.
4118 @item Z
4119 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4120 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4121 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4122 and no unselected ones.
4123 @item g
4124 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4125 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4126 @item S
4127 Subject of the current article.
4128 @item u
4129 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4130 @item s
4131 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4132 @item d
4133 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4134 @item t
4135 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4136 @item r
4137 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4138 @item E
4139 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4140 @end table
4141
4142
4143 @node Summary Highlighting
4144 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4145
4146 @table @code
4147
4148 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4149 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4150 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4151 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4152 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4153
4154 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4155 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4156 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4157 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4158
4159 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4160 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4161 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4162 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4163
4164 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4165 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4166 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4167 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4168 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4169 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4170 to something like
4171 @lisp
4172 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4173 ((> score default) . bold))
4174 @end lisp
4175 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4176 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4177 @end table
4178
4179
4180 @node Summary Maneuvering
4181 @section Summary Maneuvering
4182 @cindex summary movement
4183
4184 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4185 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4186
4187 None of these commands select articles.
4188
4189 @table @kbd
4190 @item G M-n
4191 @itemx M-n
4192 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4193 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4194 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4195 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4196 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4197
4198 @item G M-p
4199 @itemx M-p
4200 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4201 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4202 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4203 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4204 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4205
4206 @item G j
4207 @itemx j
4208 @kindex j (Summary)
4209 @kindex G j (Summary)
4210 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
4211 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
4212 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4213
4214 @item G g
4215 @kindex G g (Summary)
4216 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4217 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4218 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4219 @end table
4220
4221 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4222 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4223 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4224 to the group buffer.
4225
4226 Variables related to summary movement:
4227
4228 @table @code
4229
4230 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4231 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4232 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4233 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4234 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4235 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4236 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4237 next group, no matter whether it has any unread articles or not. As a
4238 special case, if this variable is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the
4239 next group without asking for confirmation. If this variable is
4240 @code{almost-quietly}, the same will happen only if you are located on
4241 the last article in the group. Finally, if this variable is
4242 @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n} command will go to the next group
4243 without confirmation. Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
4244
4245 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4246 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4247 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4248 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4249 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4250 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4251 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4252
4253 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4254
4255 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4256 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4257 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4258 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4259 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4260
4261 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4262 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4263 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4264 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4265 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4266 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4267 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4268 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4269 threads.
4270
4271 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4272 the given number of lines from the top.
4273
4274 @end table
4275
4276
4277 @node Choosing Articles
4278 @section Choosing Articles
4279 @cindex selecting articles
4280
4281 @menu
4282 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4283 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4284 @end menu
4285
4286
4287 @node Choosing Commands
4288 @subsection Choosing Commands
4289
4290 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4291 and they all select and display an article.
4292
4293 @table @kbd
4294 @item SPACE
4295 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4296 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4297 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4298 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4299
4300 @item G n
4301 @itemx n
4302 @kindex n (Summary)
4303 @kindex G n (Summary)
4304 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4305 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4306 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4307
4308 @item G p
4309 @itemx p
4310 @kindex p (Summary)
4311 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
4312 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
4313 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4314
4315 @item G N
4316 @itemx N
4317 @kindex N (Summary)
4318 @kindex G N (Summary)
4319 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
4320 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4321
4322 @item G P
4323 @itemx P
4324 @kindex P (Summary)
4325 @kindex G P (Summary)
4326 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
4327 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4328
4329 @item G C-n
4330 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
4331 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
4332 Go to the next article with the same subject
4333 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4334
4335 @item G C-p
4336 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
4337 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
4338 Go to the previous article with the same subject
4339 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4340
4341 @item G f
4342 @itemx .
4343 @kindex G f (Summary)
4344 @kindex . (Summary)
4345 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
4346 Go to the first unread article
4347 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4348
4349 @item G b
4350 @itemx ,
4351 @kindex G b (Summary)
4352 @kindex , (Summary)
4353 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
4354 Go to the article with the highest score
4355 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}).
4356
4357 @item G l
4358 @itemx l
4359 @kindex l (Summary)
4360 @kindex G l (Summary)
4361 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
4362 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4363
4364 @item G o
4365 @kindex G o (Summary)
4366 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
4367 @cindex history
4368 @cindex article history
4369 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
4370 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
4371 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
4372 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
4373 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
4374 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
4375 @end table
4376
4377
4378 @node Choosing Variables
4379 @subsection Choosing Variables
4380
4381 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4382
4383 @table @code
4384 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4385 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4386 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
4387 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
4388 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
4389 the server and display it in the article buffer.
4390
4391 @item gnus-select-article-hook
4392 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
4393 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
4394 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article.
4395
4396 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
4397 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4398 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
4399 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
4400 @findex gnus-unread-mark
4401 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
4402 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
4403 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
4404 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
4405 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
4406 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
4407 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
4408 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
4409 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4410
4411 @end table
4412
4413
4414 @node Paging the Article
4415 @section Scrolling the Article
4416 @cindex article scrolling
4417
4418 @table @kbd
4419
4420 @item SPACE
4421 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4422 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4423 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
4424 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
4425 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4426
4427 @item DEL
4428 @kindex DEL (Summary)
4429 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
4430 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4431
4432 @item RET
4433 @kindex RET (Summary)
4434 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
4435 Scroll the current article one line forward
4436 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4437
4438 @item M-RET
4439 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
4440 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
4441 Scroll the current article one line backward
4442 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4443
4444 @item A g
4445 @itemx g
4446 @kindex A g (Summary)
4447 @kindex g (Summary)
4448 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
4449 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4450 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
4451 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
4452 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
4453 the way it came from the server.
4454
4455 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
4456 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
4457 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4458
4459 @lisp
4460 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4461 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
4462 (2 . big5)))
4463 @end lisp
4464
4465 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4466
4467 @item A <
4468 @itemx <
4469 @kindex < (Summary)
4470 @kindex A < (Summary)
4471 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
4472 Scroll to the beginning of the article
4473 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4474
4475 @item A >
4476 @itemx >
4477 @kindex > (Summary)
4478 @kindex A > (Summary)
4479 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
4480 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4481
4482 @item A s
4483 @itemx s
4484 @kindex A s (Summary)
4485 @kindex s (Summary)
4486 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
4487 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
4488 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4489
4490 @item h
4491 @kindex h (Summary)
4492 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
4493 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
4494
4495 @end table
4496
4497
4498 @node Reply Followup and Post
4499 @section Reply, Followup and Post
4500
4501 @menu
4502 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
4503 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
4504 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
4505 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
4506 @end menu
4507
4508
4509 @node Summary Mail Commands
4510 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
4511 @cindex mail
4512 @cindex composing mail
4513
4514 Commands for composing a mail message:
4515
4516 @table @kbd
4517
4518 @item S r
4519 @itemx r
4520 @kindex S r (Summary)
4521 @kindex r (Summary)
4522 @findex gnus-summary-reply
4523 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
4524 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
4525 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
4526 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
4527
4528 @item S R
4529 @itemx R
4530 @kindex R (Summary)
4531 @kindex S R (Summary)
4532 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
4533 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
4534 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
4535 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
4536 command uses the process/prefix convention.
4537
4538 @item S w
4539 @kindex S w (Summary)
4540 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
4541 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
4542 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
4543 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
4544 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers.
4545
4546 @item S W
4547 @kindex S W (Summary)
4548 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
4549 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
4550 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
4551 the process/prefix convention.
4552
4553 @item S o m
4554 @itemx C-c C-f
4555 @kindex S o m (Summary)
4556 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
4557 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
4558 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
4559 Forward the current article to some other person
4560 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
4561 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
4562 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4563 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
4564 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4565 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
4566 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4567 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4568 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4569
4570 @item S m
4571 @itemx m
4572 @kindex m (Summary)
4573 @kindex S m (Summary)
4574 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
4575 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
4576 Send a mail to some other person
4577 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}).
4578
4579 @item S D b
4580 @kindex S D b (Summary)
4581 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
4582 @cindex bouncing mail
4583 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
4584 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
4585 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
4586 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
4587 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
4588 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
4589 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
4590 very well fail, though.
4591
4592 @item S D r
4593 @kindex S D r (Summary)
4594 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
4595 Not to be confused with the previous command,
4596 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
4597 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
4598 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
4599 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
4600 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
4601 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
4602 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
4603
4604 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
4605 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
4606 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
4607 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
4608 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muß sein!
4609
4610 This command understands the process/prefix convention
4611 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4612
4613 @item S O m
4614 @kindex S O m (Summary)
4615 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
4616 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
4617 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
4618 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4619
4620 @item S M-c
4621 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
4622 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
4623 @cindex crossposting
4624 @cindex excessive crossposting
4625 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
4626 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
4627
4628 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
4629 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
4630 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
4631 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
4632 command understands the process/prefix convention
4633 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
4634
4635 @end table
4636
4637 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4638
4639
4640 @node Summary Post Commands
4641 @subsection Summary Post Commands
4642 @cindex post
4643 @cindex composing news
4644
4645 Commands for posting a news article:
4646
4647 @table @kbd
4648 @item S p
4649 @itemx a
4650 @kindex a (Summary)
4651 @kindex S p (Summary)
4652 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
4653 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
4654 Post an article to the current group
4655 (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}).
4656
4657 @item S f
4658 @itemx f
4659 @kindex f (Summary)
4660 @kindex S f (Summary)
4661 @findex gnus-summary-followup
4662 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
4663 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
4664
4665 @item S F
4666 @itemx F
4667 @kindex S F (Summary)
4668 @kindex F (Summary)
4669 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
4670 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
4671 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
4672 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
4673 process/prefix convention.
4674
4675 @item S n
4676 @kindex S n (Summary)
4677 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
4678 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4679 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
4680
4681 @item S N
4682 @kindex S N (Summary)
4683 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
4684 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4685 message through mail and include the original message
4686 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
4687 the process/prefix convention.
4688
4689 @item S o p
4690 @kindex S o p (Summary)
4691 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
4692 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
4693 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
4694 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
4695 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
4696 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4697 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
4698 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4699 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
4700 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4701 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4702 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4703
4704 @item S O p
4705 @kindex S O p (Summary)
4706 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
4707 @cindex digests
4708 @cindex making digests
4709 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
4710 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
4711 process/prefix convention.
4712
4713 @item S u
4714 @kindex S u (Summary)
4715 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
4716 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
4717 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
4718 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
4719 @end table
4720
4721 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4722
4723
4724 @node Summary Message Commands
4725 @subsection Summary Message Commands
4726
4727 @table @kbd
4728 @item S y
4729 @kindex S y (Summary)
4730 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
4731 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
4732 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
4733 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
4734 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4735
4736 @end table
4737
4738
4739 @node Canceling and Superseding
4740 @subsection Canceling Articles
4741 @cindex canceling articles
4742 @cindex superseding articles
4743
4744 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
4745 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
4746
4747 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
4748
4749 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
4750 @kindex C (Summary)
4751 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
4752 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
4753 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
4754 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
4755 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
4756 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4757
4758 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
4759 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
4760 question.
4761
4762 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
4763 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
4764 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
4765
4766 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
4767 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
4768 your original article.
4769
4770 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
4771 @kindex S (Summary)
4772 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
4773 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
4774 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
4775 usual way.
4776
4777 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
4778 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
4779 have posted almost the same article twice.
4780
4781 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
4782 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
4783 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
4784 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
4785 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
4786 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
4787 header by substituting one of those words for the word
4788 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
4789 you would do normally. The previous article will be
4790 canceled/superseded.
4791
4792 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
4793
4794
4795 @node Marking Articles
4796 @section Marking Articles
4797 @cindex article marking
4798 @cindex article ticking
4799 @cindex marks
4800
4801 There are several marks you can set on an article.
4802
4803 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
4804 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
4805 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4806
4807 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4808
4809 @menu
4810 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
4811 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
4812 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
4813 @end menu
4814
4815 @ifinfo
4816 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
4817 @end ifinfo
4818
4819 @menu
4820 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
4821 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
4822 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
4823 @end menu
4824
4825
4826 @node Unread Articles
4827 @subsection Unread Articles
4828
4829 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
4830 other.
4831
4832 @table @samp
4833 @item !
4834 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
4835 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4836
4837 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
4838 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
4839 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
4840 tick it. However, articles can be expired, so if you want to keep an
4841 article forever, you'll have to make it persistent (@pxref{Persistent
4842 Articles}).
4843
4844 @item ?
4845 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
4846 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4847
4848 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
4849 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
4850 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
4851
4852 @item SPACE
4853 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
4854 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4855
4856 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
4857 @end table
4858
4859
4860 @node Read Articles
4861 @subsection Read Articles
4862 @cindex expirable mark
4863
4864 All the following marks mark articles as read.
4865
4866 @table @samp
4867
4868 @item r
4869 @vindex gnus-del-mark
4870 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
4871 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4872
4873 @item R
4874 @vindex gnus-read-mark
4875 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4876
4877 @item O
4878 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
4879 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
4880 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4881
4882 @item K
4883 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
4884 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4885
4886 @item X
4887 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
4888 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4889
4890 @item Y
4891 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
4892 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4893
4894 @item C
4895 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
4896 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4897
4898 @item G
4899 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
4900 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4901
4902 @item F
4903 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
4904 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
4905
4906 @item Q
4907 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
4908 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
4909 Threading}.
4910
4911 @item M
4912 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
4913 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
4914 (@code{gnus-duplicated-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4915
4916 @end table
4917
4918 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
4919 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4920
4921 One more special mark, though:
4922
4923 @table @samp
4924 @item E
4925 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
4926 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4927
4928 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
4929 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
4930 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
4931 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
4932 any time.
4933 @end table
4934
4935
4936 @node Other Marks
4937 @subsection Other Marks
4938 @cindex process mark
4939 @cindex bookmarks
4940
4941 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
4942 read or not.
4943
4944 @itemize @bullet
4945
4946 @item
4947 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
4948 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
4949 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
4950 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
4951 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
4952
4953 @item
4954 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
4955 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
4956 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
4957 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4958
4959 @item
4960 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
4961 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
4962 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4963
4964 @item
4965 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
4966 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
4967 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
4968 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
4969
4970 @item
4971 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
4972 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
4973 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
4974 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
4975 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
4976
4977 @item
4978 @vindex gnus-process-mark
4979 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
4980 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
4981 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
4982 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
4983 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
4984
4985 @end itemize
4986
4987 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
4988 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
4989 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
4990
4991 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
4992 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
4993 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
4994
4995
4996 @node Setting Marks
4997 @subsection Setting Marks
4998 @cindex setting marks
4999
5000 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5001
5002 @table @kbd
5003 @item M c
5004 @itemx M-u
5005 @kindex M c (Summary)
5006 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5007 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5008 @cindex mark as unread
5009 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5010 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5011 article as unread.
5012
5013 @item M t
5014 @itemx !
5015 @kindex ! (Summary)
5016 @kindex M t (Summary)
5017 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5018 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5019 @xref{Article Caching}.
5020
5021 @item M ?
5022 @itemx ?
5023 @kindex ? (Summary)
5024 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5025 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5026 Mark the current article as dormant
5027 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5028
5029 @item M d
5030 @itemx d
5031 @kindex M d (Summary)
5032 @kindex d (Summary)
5033 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5034 Mark the current article as read
5035 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5036
5037 @item D
5038 @kindex D (Summary)
5039 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5040 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5041 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5042
5043 @item M k
5044 @itemx k
5045 @kindex k (Summary)
5046 @kindex M k (Summary)
5047 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5048 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5049 and then select the next unread article
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5051
5052 @item M K
5053 @itemx C-k
5054 @kindex M K (Summary)
5055 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5057 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5058 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5059
5060 @item M C
5061 @kindex M C (Summary)
5062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5063 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5064 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5065
5066 @item M C-c
5067 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5069 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5070 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5071
5072 @item M H
5073 @kindex M H (Summary)
5074 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5075 Catchup the current group to point
5076 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5077
5078 @item C-w
5079 @kindex C-w (Summary)
5080 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
5081 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
5082 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
5083
5084 @item M V k
5085 @kindex M V k (Summary)
5086 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
5087 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
5088 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
5089
5090 @item M e
5091 @itemx E
5092 @kindex M e (Summary)
5093 @kindex E (Summary)
5094 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
5095 Mark the current article as expirable
5096 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
5097
5098 @item M b
5099 @kindex M b (Summary)
5100 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
5101 Set a bookmark in the current article
5102 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
5103
5104 @item M B
5105 @kindex M B (Summary)
5106 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
5107 Remove the bookmark from the current article
5108 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
5109
5110 @item M V c
5111 @kindex M V c (Summary)
5112 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
5113 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
5114 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5115
5116 @item M V u
5117 @kindex M V u (Summary)
5118 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
5119 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
5120 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
5121
5122 @item M V m
5123 @kindex M V m (Summary)
5124 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
5125 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
5126 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
5127 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5128 @end table
5129
5130 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
5131 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
5132 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
5133 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
5134 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
5135 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
5136 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
5137 The default is @code{t}.
5138
5139
5140 @node Generic Marking Commands
5141 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
5142
5143 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
5144 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
5145 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
5146 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
5147 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
5148 well.
5149
5150 Multiply these five behaviours by five different marking commands, and
5151 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
5152 command should do.
5153
5154 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
5155 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
5156 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
5157 to list in this manual.
5158
5159 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
5160 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
5161 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
5162 article, you could say something like:
5163
5164 @lisp
5165 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
5166 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5167 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
5168 @end lisp
5169
5170 or
5171
5172 @lisp
5173 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5174 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
5175 @end lisp
5176
5177
5178 @node Setting Process Marks
5179 @subsection Setting Process Marks
5180 @cindex setting process marks
5181
5182 @table @kbd
5183
5184 @item M P p
5185 @itemx #
5186 @kindex # (Summary)
5187 @kindex M P p (Summary)
5188 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
5189 Mark the current article with the process mark
5190 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
5191 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
5192
5193 @item M P u
5194 @itemx M-#
5195 @kindex M P u (Summary)
5196 @kindex M-# (Summary)
5197 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
5198 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
5199
5200 @item M P U
5201 @kindex M P U (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
5203 Remove the process mark from all articles
5204 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
5205
5206 @item M P i
5207 @kindex M P i (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
5209 Invert the list of process marked articles
5210 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
5211
5212 @item M P R
5213 @kindex M P R (Summary)
5214 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
5215 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5216 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
5217
5218 @item M P G
5219 @kindex M P G (Summary)
5220 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
5221 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5222 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
5223
5224 @item M P r
5225 @kindex M P r (Summary)
5226 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
5227 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
5228
5229 @item M P t
5230 @kindex M P t (Summary)
5231 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5232 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5233 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5234
5235 @item M P T
5236 @kindex M P T (Summary)
5237 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5238 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5239 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5240
5241 @item M P v
5242 @kindex M P v (Summary)
5243 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
5244 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
5245 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
5246
5247 @item M P s
5248 @kindex M P s (Summary)
5249 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
5250 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5251
5252 @item M P S
5253 @kindex M P S (Summary)
5254 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
5255 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
5256 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
5257
5258 @item M P a
5259 @kindex M P a (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
5261 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5262
5263 @item M P b
5264 @kindex M P b (Summary)
5265 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
5266 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
5267 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
5268
5269 @item M P k
5270 @kindex M P k (Summary)
5271 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
5272 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
5273 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
5274
5275 @item M P y
5276 @kindex M P y (Summary)
5277 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
5278 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
5279 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
5280
5281 @item M P w
5282 @kindex M P w (Summary)
5283 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
5284 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
5285 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
5286
5287 @end table
5288
5289 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @pxref{Searching for Articles} for how to
5290 set process marks based on article body contents.
5291
5292
5293 @node Limiting
5294 @section Limiting
5295 @cindex limiting
5296
5297 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
5298 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
5299 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
5300 buffer.
5301
5302 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
5303 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
5304 additional articles.
5305
5306 @table @kbd
5307
5308 @item / /
5309 @itemx / s
5310 @kindex / / (Summary)
5311 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
5312 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
5313 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}).
5314
5315 @item / a
5316 @kindex / a (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
5318 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
5319 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}).
5320
5321 @item / x
5322 @kindex / x (Summary)
5323 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
5324 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
5325 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}).
5327
5328 @item / u
5329 @itemx x
5330 @kindex / u (Summary)
5331 @kindex x (Summary)
5332 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
5333 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
5334 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
5335 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
5336 dormant articles will also be excluded.
5337
5338 @item / m
5339 @kindex / m (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
5341 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
5342 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
5343
5344 @item / t
5345 @kindex / t (Summary)
5346 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
5347 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
5348 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
5349 articles younger than that number of days.
5350
5351 @item / n
5352 @kindex / n (Summary)
5353 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
5354 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
5355 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
5356 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5357
5358 @item / w
5359 @kindex / w (Summary)
5360 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
5361 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
5363 the stack.
5364
5365 @item / v
5366 @kindex / v (Summary)
5367 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
5368 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
5369 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
5370
5371 @item / E
5372 @itemx M S
5373 @kindex M S (Summary)
5374 @kindex / E (Summary)
5375 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
5376 Include all expunged articles in the limit
5377 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
5378
5379 @item / D
5380 @kindex / D (Summary)
5381 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
5382 Include all dormant articles in the limit
5383 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
5384
5385 @item / *
5386 @kindex / * (Summary)
5387 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
5388 Include all cached articles in the limit
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
5390
5391 @item / d
5392 @kindex / d (Summary)
5393 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
5394 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
5395 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
5396
5397 @item / M
5398 @kindex / M (Summary)
5399 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
5400 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
5401
5402 @item / T
5403 @kindex / T (Summary)
5404 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
5405 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
5406
5407 @item / c
5408 @kindex / c (Summary)
5409 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
5410 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit
5411 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
5412
5413 @item / C
5414 @kindex / C (Summary)
5415 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
5416 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
5417 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
5418 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
5419
5420 @end table
5421
5422
5423 @node Threading
5424 @section Threading
5425 @cindex threading
5426 @cindex article threading
5427
5428 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
5429 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
5430 hierarchical fashion.
5431
5432 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
5433 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
5434 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
5435 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
5436 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
5437 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
5438 @pxref{Customizing Threading}.
5439
5440 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
5441
5442 @table @dfn
5443 @item root
5444 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
5445
5446 @item thread
5447 A tree-like article structure.
5448
5449 @item sub-thread
5450 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
5451
5452 @item loose threads
5453 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
5454 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
5455 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
5456 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
5457 called loose threads.
5458
5459 @item thread gathering
5460 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
5461
5462 @item sparse threads
5463 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
5464 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
5465
5466 @end table
5467
5468
5469 @menu
5470 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
5471 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
5472 @end menu
5473
5474
5475 @node Customizing Threading
5476 @subsection Customizing Threading
5477 @cindex customizing threading
5478
5479 @menu
5480 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
5481 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
5482 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
5483 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
5484 @end menu
5485
5486
5487 @node Loose Threads
5488 @subsubsection Loose Threads
5489 @cindex <
5490 @cindex >
5491 @cindex loose threads
5492
5493 @table @code
5494 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
5495 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
5496 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
5497 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
5498 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
5499 read or killed the root in a previous session.
5500
5501 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
5502 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
5503 There are four possible values:
5504
5505 @iftex
5506 @iflatex
5507 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
5508 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-adopt.ps,width=7.5cm}}
5509 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-empty.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5510 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-none.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5511 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-dummy.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5512 }
5513 @end iflatex
5514 @end iftex
5515
5516 @cindex adopting articles
5517
5518 @table @code
5519
5520 @item adopt
5521 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
5522 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
5523 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
5524 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
5525
5526 @item dummy
5527 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
5528 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
5529 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
5530 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
5531 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
5532 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
5533 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
5534
5535 @item empty
5536 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
5537 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
5538 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
5539 Buffer Format}).)
5540
5541 @item none
5542 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
5543 display them after one another.
5544
5545 @item nil
5546 Don't gather loose threads.
5547 @end table
5548
5549 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5550 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5551 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
5552 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
5553 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
5554 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
5555 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
5556 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
5557 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
5558 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
5559 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
5560
5561 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
5562 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
5563 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
5564 Matching}).
5565
5566 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5567 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5568 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
5569 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
5570 simplification is used.
5571
5572 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5573 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5574 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
5575 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
5576
5577 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
5578 @lisp
5579 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5580 (concat
5581 "\\`\\[?\\("
5582 (mapconcat
5583 'identity
5584 '("looking"
5585 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
5586 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
5587 "answer" "reference" "announce"
5588 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
5589 ;; ...
5590 )
5591 "\\|")
5592 "\\)\\s *\\("
5593 (mapconcat 'identity
5594 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
5595 "\\|")
5596 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
5597 @end lisp
5598
5599 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
5600 subjects.
5601
5602 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5603 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5604 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
5605 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
5606 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
5607 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
5608
5609 Useful functions to put in this list include:
5610
5611 @table @code
5612 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
5613 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
5614 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
5615
5616 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5617 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5618 Simplify fuzzily.
5619
5620 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
5621 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
5622 Remove excessive whitespace.
5623 @end table
5624
5625 You may also write your own functions, of course.
5626
5627
5628 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5629 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5630 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
5631 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
5632 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
5633 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
5634 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
5635 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
5636
5637 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5638 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5639 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
5640 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
5641 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
5642 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
5643 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
5644 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
5645 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
5646 cholera:
5647
5648 @table @code
5649 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5650 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5651 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
5652 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
5653
5654 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5655 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5656 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
5657 @end table
5658
5659 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
5660 something like:
5661
5662 @lisp
5663 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5664 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
5665 @end lisp
5666
5667 @end table
5668
5669
5670 @node Filling In Threads
5671 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
5672
5673 @table @code
5674 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
5675 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
5676 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
5677 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you
5678 would like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still
5679 connect as many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable
5680 to @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than
5681 that number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case,
5682 fetching old headers only works if the backend you are using carries
5683 overview files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and
5684 @code{nnml}. Also remember that if the root of the thread has been
5685 expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can do about that.
5686
5687 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
5688 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
5689 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
5690
5691 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
5692 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
5693 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
5694 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
5695 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
5696 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
5697 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
5698 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
5699 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
5700 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
5701 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
5702 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
5703 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
5704 @code{nil} by default.
5705
5706 @end table
5707
5708
5709 @node More Threading
5710 @subsubsection More Threading
5711
5712 @table @code
5713 @item gnus-show-threads
5714 @vindex gnus-show-threads
5715 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
5716 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
5717 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
5718 slower and more awkward.
5719
5720 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5721 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5722 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
5723 generated.
5724
5725 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
5726 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
5727 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
5728 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
5729 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
5730 threads are expunged.
5731
5732 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
5733 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
5734 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
5735 will be hidden.
5736
5737 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5738 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5739 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
5740 this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subject change is ignored. If it
5741 is @code{nil}, which is the default, a change in the subject will result
5742 in a new thread.
5743
5744 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
5745 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
5746 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
5747 The default is 4.
5748
5749 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5750 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5751 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
5752 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
5753 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
5754 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
5755 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
5756 Setting this variable to an alternate value
5757 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
5758 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
5759 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
5760
5761 @end table
5762
5763
5764 @node Low-Level Threading
5765 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
5766
5767 @table @code
5768
5769 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
5770 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
5771 Hook run before parsing any headers.
5772
5773 @item gnus-alter-header-function
5774 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
5775 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
5776 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
5777 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
5778 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
5779 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
5780 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
5781 meaningful. Here's one example:
5782
5783 @lisp
5784 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
5785
5786 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
5787 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
5788 (when (string-match
5789 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
5790 (mail-header-set-id
5791 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
5792 header))))
5793 @end lisp
5794
5795 @end table
5796
5797
5798 @node Thread Commands
5799 @subsection Thread Commands
5800 @cindex thread commands
5801
5802 @table @kbd
5803
5804 @item T k
5805 @itemx M-C-k
5806 @kindex T k (Summary)
5807 @kindex M-C-k (Summary)
5808 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
5809 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
5810 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
5811 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
5812 articles instead.
5813
5814 @item T l
5815 @itemx M-C-l
5816 @kindex T l (Summary)
5817 @kindex M-C-l (Summary)
5818 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
5819 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
5820 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
5821
5822 @item T i
5823 @kindex T i (Summary)
5824 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
5825 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
5826 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
5827
5828 @item T #
5829 @kindex T # (Summary)
5830 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5831 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
5832 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5833
5834 @item T M-#
5835 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
5836 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5837 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
5838 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5839
5840 @item T T
5841 @kindex T T (Summary)
5842 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
5843 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
5844
5845 @item T s
5846 @kindex T s (Summary)
5847 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
5848 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any
5849 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
5850
5851 @item T h
5852 @kindex T h (Summary)
5853 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
5854 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
5855
5856 @item T S
5857 @kindex T S (Summary)
5858 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
5859 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
5860
5861 @item T H
5862 @kindex T H (Summary)
5863 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
5864 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
5865
5866 @item T t
5867 @kindex T t (Summary)
5868 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
5869 Re-thread the current article's thread
5870 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
5871 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
5872
5873 @item T ^
5874 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
5875 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
5876 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
5877 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
5878
5879 @end table
5880
5881 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
5882 understand the numeric prefix.
5883
5884 @table @kbd
5885
5886 @item T n
5887 @kindex T n (Summary)
5888 @itemx M-C-n
5889 @kindex M-C-n (Summary)
5890 @itemx M-down
5891 @kindex M-down (Summary)
5892 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
5893 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
5894
5895 @item T p
5896 @kindex T p (Summary)
5897 @itemx M-C-p
5898 @kindex M-C-p (Summary)
5899 @itemx M-up
5900 @kindex M-up (Summary)
5901 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
5902 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
5903
5904 @item T d
5905 @kindex T d (Summary)
5906 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
5907 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
5908
5909 @item T u
5910 @kindex T u (Summary)
5911 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
5912 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
5913
5914 @item T o
5915 @kindex T o (Summary)
5916 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
5917 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
5918 @end table
5919
5920 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
5921 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
5922 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
5923 a command like `T k' (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
5924 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
5925 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
5926 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
5927 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
5928 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
5929 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
5930 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
5931 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
5932 Matching}).
5933
5934
5935 @node Sorting
5936 @section Sorting
5937
5938 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
5939 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
5940 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
5941 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5942 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
5943 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5944 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
5945 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
5946 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
5947 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
5948 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
5949
5950 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
5951 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
5952 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
5953 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score}, and
5954 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
5955
5956 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
5957 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
5958 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
5959
5960 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
5961 last function in the list. You should probably always include
5962 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
5963 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
5964 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
5965 ascending article order.
5966
5967 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
5968 by number, you could do something like:
5969
5970 @lisp
5971 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5972 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5973 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5974 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
5975 @end lisp
5976
5977 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
5978 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
5979 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
5980 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
5981 which the articles arrived.
5982
5983 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
5984 say something like:
5985
5986 @lisp
5987 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5988 '((lambda (t1 t2)
5989 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
5990 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
5991 @end lisp
5992
5993 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
5994 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
5995 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
5996 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
5997 tickles your fancy.
5998
5999 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
6000 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6001 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
6002 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
6003 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
6004 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6005 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or other,
6006 you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions} variable.
6007 It is very similar to the @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that
6008 it uses slightly different functions for article comparison. Available
6009 sorting predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
6010 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject},
6011 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date}, and @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
6012
6013 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
6014 say something like:
6015
6016 @lisp
6017 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
6018 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
6019 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
6020 @end lisp
6021
6022
6023
6024 @node Asynchronous Fetching
6025 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
6026 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
6027 @cindex article pre-fetch
6028 @cindex pre-fetch
6029
6030 If you read your news from an @sc{nntp} server that's far away, the
6031 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
6032 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
6033 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
6034 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
6035
6036 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
6037 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
6038
6039 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
6040 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
6041 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
6042 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
6043 connection is blocked.
6044
6045 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
6046 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
6047 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
6048 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
6049
6050 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
6051 the link between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server will become more
6052 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
6053 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
6054 extra connection.
6055
6056 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing... unless
6057 you really want to.
6058
6059 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
6060 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
6061 happen automatically.
6062
6063 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
6064 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
6065 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
6066 that when you read an article in the group, the backend will pre-fetch
6067 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the backend will
6068 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
6069 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
6070
6071 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
6072 @findex gnus-async-read-p
6073 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
6074 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p} variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This function should
6075 return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is to be
6076 pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which returns
6077 @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an article
6078 data structure as the only parameter.
6079
6080 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter than 100 lines, you could say something like:
6081
6082 @lisp
6083 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
6084 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
6085 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
6086 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
6087 100)))
6088
6089 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
6090 @end lisp
6091
6092 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
6093 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
6094 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
6095
6096 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
6097 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
6098 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
6099 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
6100
6101 @table @code
6102 @item read
6103 Remove articles when they are read.
6104
6105 @item exit
6106 Remove articles when exiting the group.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
6110
6111 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
6112 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
6113 @c from the next group.
6114
6115
6116 @node Article Caching
6117 @section Article Caching
6118 @cindex article caching
6119 @cindex caching
6120
6121 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @sc{nntp} connection, you may
6122 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
6123 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
6124 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
6125 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
6126
6127 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
6128
6129 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6130 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
6131 @vindex gnus-use-cache
6132 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
6133 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
6134 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
6135 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
6136 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
6137
6138 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
6139 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
6140 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
6141 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
6142 as dormant, and don't worry.
6143
6144 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
6145
6146 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
6147 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
6148 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
6149 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
6150 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
6151 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
6152 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
6153 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
6154 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
6155 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
6156
6157 @findex gnus-jog-cache
6158 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
6159 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
6160 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
6161 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
6162 command if 1) your connection to the @sc{nntp} server is really, really,
6163 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
6164 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
6165 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
6166 not then be downloaded by this command.
6167
6168 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
6169 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
6170 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
6171 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
6172 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
6173 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
6174
6175 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
6176 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
6177 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
6178 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
6179 variables, the group is not cached.
6180
6181 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
6182 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
6183 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
6184 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
6185 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
6186 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
6187 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
6188 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @sc{nov}
6189 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
6190 file.
6191
6192
6193 @node Persistent Articles
6194 @section Persistent Articles
6195 @cindex persistent articles
6196
6197 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
6198 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
6199 useful in my opinion.
6200
6201 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
6202 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
6203 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
6204 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
6205 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
6206 the expiry going on at the news server.
6207
6208 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
6209 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
6210 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
6211
6212 @table @kbd
6213
6214 @item *
6215 @kindex * (Summary)
6216 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
6217 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
6218
6219 @item M-*
6220 @kindex M-* (Summary)
6221 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
6222 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
6223 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
6224 article.
6225 @end table
6226
6227 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
6228
6229 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
6230 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
6231 interested in persistent articles:
6232
6233 @lisp
6234 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
6235 @end lisp
6236
6237
6238 @node Article Backlog
6239 @section Article Backlog
6240 @cindex backlog
6241 @cindex article backlog
6242
6243 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
6244 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
6245 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
6246 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
6247 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
6248 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
6249 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
6250 increase memory usage some.
6251
6252 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
6253 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
6254 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
6255 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
6256 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
6257 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
6258 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
6259
6260 This variable is @code{nil} by default.
6261
6262
6263 @node Saving Articles
6264 @section Saving Articles
6265 @cindex saving articles
6266
6267 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
6268 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
6269 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
6270 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
6271 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
6272
6273 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
6274 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
6275 unwanted headers before saving the article.
6276
6277 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
6278 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
6279 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
6280 deleted before saving.
6281
6282 @table @kbd
6283
6284 @item O o
6285 @itemx o
6286 @kindex O o (Summary)
6287 @kindex o (Summary)
6288 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
6289 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
6290 Save the current article using the default article saver
6291 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
6292
6293 @item O m
6294 @kindex O m (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
6296 Save the current article in mail format
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
6298
6299 @item O r
6300 @kindex O r (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
6302 Save the current article in rmail format
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
6304
6305 @item O f
6306 @kindex O f (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
6308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
6309 Save the current article in plain file format
6310 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
6311
6312 @item O F
6313 @kindex O F (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
6315 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
6316 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
6317
6318 @item O b
6319 @kindex O b (Summary)
6320 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
6321 Save the current article body in plain file format
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
6323
6324 @item O h
6325 @kindex O h (Summary)
6326 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
6327 Save the current article in mh folder format
6328 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
6329
6330 @item O v
6331 @kindex O v (Summary)
6332 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
6333 Save the current article in a VM folder
6334 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
6335
6336 @item O p
6337 @kindex O p (Summary)
6338 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
6339 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
6340 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
6341 @end table
6342
6343 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
6344 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
6345 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
6346 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
6347 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
6348 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
6349 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
6350 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
6351 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
6352 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
6353 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
6354 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
6355 files.
6356
6357
6358 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
6359 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
6360 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
6361 functions below, or you can create your own.
6362
6363 @table @code
6364
6365 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6366 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6367 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
6368 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6369 This is the default format, @dfn{babyl}. Uses the function in the
6370 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6371 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6372
6373 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6374 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6375 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
6376 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
6377 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6378 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6379
6380 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
6381 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
6382 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
6383 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6384 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
6385 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6386 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6387
6388 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6389 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6390 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
6391 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6392 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6393
6394 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6395 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6396 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
6397 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
6398 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
6399 @cindex rcvstore
6400 @cindex MH folders
6401 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
6402 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
6403 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
6404 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
6405 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
6406
6407 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6408 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6409 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
6410 reader to use this setting.
6411 @end table
6412
6413 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
6414 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
6415 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
6416 @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
6417 default.
6418
6419 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
6420 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
6421 available functions that generate names:
6422
6423 @table @code
6424
6425 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
6426 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
6427 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6428
6429 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
6430 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6431 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6432
6433 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
6434 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
6435 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6436
6437 @item gnus-plain-save-name
6438 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6439 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6440 @end table
6441
6442 @vindex gnus-split-methods
6443 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
6444 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
6445 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
6446 related to VM in @code{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
6447 like:
6448
6449 @lisp
6450 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
6451 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
6452 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
6453 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
6454 @end lisp
6455
6456 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
6457 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
6458 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
6459 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
6460 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
6461 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
6462 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
6463 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
6464 called returns a string or a list of strings.
6465
6466 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
6467 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
6468 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
6469 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
6470
6471 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
6472 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
6473 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
6474 name.
6475
6476 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
6477 lots of mail groups called things like
6478 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
6479 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
6480 following will do just that:
6481
6482 @lisp
6483 (defun my-save-name (group)
6484 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
6485 (substring group (match-end 0))))
6486
6487 (setq gnus-split-methods
6488 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
6489 (my-save-name)))
6490 @end lisp
6491
6492
6493 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6494 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
6495 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
6496 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
6497 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
6498 all the files in the top level directory
6499 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
6500 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
6501 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
6502 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
6503
6504 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
6505 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
6506 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
6507 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
6508 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
6509 for kill files.
6510
6511 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
6512 a spool, you could
6513
6514 @lisp
6515 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; to get a hierarchy
6516 (setq gnus-default-article-saver 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; no encoding
6517 @end lisp
6518
6519 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
6520 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
6521 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
6522 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
6523
6524
6525 @node Decoding Articles
6526 @section Decoding Articles
6527 @cindex decoding articles
6528
6529 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
6530 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
6531
6532 @menu
6533 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
6534 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
6535 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
6536 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
6537 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
6538 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
6539 @end menu
6540
6541 @cindex series
6542 @cindex article series
6543 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
6544 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
6545 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
6546 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
6547 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
6548
6549 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
6550 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
6551 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
6552
6553 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
6554 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
6555 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
6556
6557 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
6558 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
6559 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
6560
6561
6562 @node Uuencoded Articles
6563 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
6564 @cindex uudecode
6565 @cindex uuencoded articles
6566
6567 @table @kbd
6568
6569 @item X u
6570 @kindex X u (Summary)
6571 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
6572 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
6573 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
6574
6575 @item X U
6576 @kindex X U (Summary)
6577 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
6578 Uudecodes and saves the current series
6579 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6580
6581 @item X v u
6582 @kindex X v u (Summary)
6583 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
6584 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
6585
6586 @item X v U
6587 @kindex X v U (Summary)
6588 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
6589 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
6590 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
6591
6592 @end table
6593
6594 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
6595 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
6596 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
6597 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
6598 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6599
6600 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
6601 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
6602 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
6603 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
6604 @kbd{X u}.
6605
6606 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
6607 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
6608 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
6609 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
6610 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
6611 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
6612 off.
6613
6614
6615 @node Shell Archives
6616 @subsection Shell Archives
6617 @cindex unshar
6618 @cindex shell archives
6619 @cindex shared articles
6620
6621 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
6622 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
6623 some commands to deal with these:
6624
6625 @table @kbd
6626
6627 @item X s
6628 @kindex X s (Summary)
6629 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
6630 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
6631
6632 @item X S
6633 @kindex X S (Summary)
6634 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
6635 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
6636
6637 @item X v s
6638 @kindex X v s (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
6640 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
6641
6642 @item X v S
6643 @kindex X v S (Summary)
6644 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
6645 Unshars, views and saves the current series
6646 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
6647 @end table
6648
6649
6650 @node PostScript Files
6651 @subsection PostScript Files
6652 @cindex PostScript
6653
6654 @table @kbd
6655
6656 @item X p
6657 @kindex X p (Summary)
6658 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
6659 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
6660
6661 @item X P
6662 @kindex X P (Summary)
6663 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
6664 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
6665 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
6666
6667 @item X v p
6668 @kindex X v p (Summary)
6669 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
6670 View the current PostScript series
6671 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
6672
6673 @item X v P
6674 @kindex X v P (Summary)
6675 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
6676 View and save the current PostScript series
6677 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
6678 @end table
6679
6680
6681 @node Other Files
6682 @subsection Other Files
6683
6684 @table @kbd
6685 @item X o
6686 @kindex X o (Summary)
6687 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
6688 Save the current series
6689 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
6690
6691 @item X b
6692 @kindex X b (Summary)
6693 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
6694 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
6695 doesn't really work yet.
6696 @end table
6697
6698
6699 @node Decoding Variables
6700 @subsection Decoding Variables
6701
6702 Adjective, not verb.
6703
6704 @menu
6705 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
6706 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
6707 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
6708 @end menu
6709
6710
6711 @node Rule Variables
6712 @subsubsection Rule Variables
6713 @cindex rule variables
6714
6715 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
6716 variables are of the form
6717
6718 @lisp
6719 (list '(regexp1 command2)
6720 '(regexp2 command2)
6721 ...)
6722 @end lisp
6723
6724 @table @code
6725
6726 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6727 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6728 @cindex sox
6729 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
6730 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @samp{.au} sound file, you could
6731 say something like:
6732 @lisp
6733 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6734 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
6735 @end lisp
6736
6737 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6738 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6739 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
6740 user and default view rules.
6741
6742 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6743 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6744 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
6745 archives.
6746 @end table
6747
6748
6749 @node Other Decode Variables
6750 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6754
6755 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6756 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
6757 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
6758 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
6759 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
6760
6761 @table @code
6762
6763 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
6764 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
6765 View the file.
6766
6767 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
6768 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
6769 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
6770 @end table
6771
6772 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6773 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6774 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
6775 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
6776 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
6777 time.
6778
6779 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6780 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6781 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
6782
6783 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6784 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6785 Files with a @sc{mime} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
6786 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
6787 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @sc{mime} package (yet), so this is slightly
6788 kludgey.
6789
6790 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6791 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6792 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
6793
6794 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6795 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6796 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
6797 looking for files to display.
6798
6799 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
6800 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
6801 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
6802 after viewing it.
6803
6804 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6805 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6806 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
6807 rules.
6808
6809 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6810 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6811 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
6812 unpacking commands.
6813
6814 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6815 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6816 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
6817 from articles.
6818
6819 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6820 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6821 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
6822 decoded articles as unread.
6823
6824 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6825 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6826 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
6827 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
6828
6829 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6830 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6831 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
6832
6833 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6834 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6835 @cindex metamail
6836 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
6837 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @sc{mime}
6838 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
6839 @code{metamail} for viewing.
6840
6841 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6842 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6843 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
6844 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
6845 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
6846 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
6847 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
6848 simply dropped them.
6849
6850 @end table
6851
6852
6853 @node Uuencoding and Posting
6854 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
6855
6856 @table @code
6857
6858 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6859 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6860 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
6861 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
6862 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
6863 for you when you post the article.
6864
6865 @item gnus-uu-post-length
6866 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
6867 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
6868 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
6869
6870 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
6871 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
6872 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
6873 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
6874 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
6875 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
6876 think that counts...) Default is @code{nil}.
6877
6878 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6879 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6880 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
6881 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
6882 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
6883 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
6884 Default is @code{t}.
6885
6886 @end table
6887
6888
6889 @node Viewing Files
6890 @subsection Viewing Files
6891 @cindex viewing files
6892 @cindex pseudo-articles
6893
6894 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
6895 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
6896 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
6897 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
6898 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
6899 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
6900 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
6901
6902 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
6903 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
6904 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
6905 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
6906
6907 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
6908 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
6909 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
6910
6911 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
6912 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
6913 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
6914 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
6915 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
6916
6917 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
6918 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
6919 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
6920 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
6921 a list of parameters to that command.
6922
6923 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
6924 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
6925 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
6926
6927 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
6928 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
6929 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
6930
6931
6932 @node Article Treatment
6933 @section Article Treatment
6934
6935 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
6936 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
6937 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
6938 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
6939 these articles easier.
6940
6941 @menu
6942 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
6943 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
6944 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
6945 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
6946 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
6947 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
6948 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
6949 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
6950 @end menu
6951
6952
6953 @node Article Highlighting
6954 @subsection Article Highlighting
6955 @cindex highlighting
6956
6957 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
6958 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
6959
6960 @table @kbd
6961
6962 @item W H a
6963 @kindex W H a (Summary)
6964 @findex gnus-article-highlight
6965 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
6966 Do much highlighting of the current article
6967 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
6968 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
6969
6970 @item W H h
6971 @kindex W H h (Summary)
6972 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
6973 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
6974 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
6975 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
6976 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
6977 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
6978 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
6979 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
6980 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
6981 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
6982 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
6983
6984 @item W H c
6985 @kindex W H c (Summary)
6986 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
6987 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
6988
6989 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
6990
6991 @table @code
6992 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6993
6994 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6995 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
6996 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
6997
6998 @item gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
6999 @vindex gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
7000 Regexp matching the longest possible citation prefix on a line.
7001
7002 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
7003 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
7004 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
7005
7006 @item gnus-cite-face-list
7007 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
7008 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
7009 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
7010 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
7011 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
7012
7013 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
7014 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
7015 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
7016
7017 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7018 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7019 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
7020
7021 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7022 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7023 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
7024 that it's a citation.
7025
7026 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7027 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7028 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
7029
7030 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7031 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7032 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
7033
7034 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
7035 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
7036 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
7037 cited text belonging to the attribution.
7038
7039 @end table
7040
7041
7042 @item W H s
7043 @kindex W H s (Summary)
7044 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7045 @vindex gnus-signature-face
7046 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
7047 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
7048 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
7049 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
7050 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
7051 default.
7052
7053 @end table
7054
7055 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
7056
7057
7058 @node Article Fontisizing
7059 @subsection Article Fontisizing
7060 @cindex emphasis
7061 @cindex article emphasis
7062
7063 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
7064 @kindex W e (Summary)
7065 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
7066 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
7067 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
7068 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
7069
7070 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
7071 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
7072 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
7073 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
7074 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
7075 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
7076 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
7077 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
7078 highlighting.
7079
7080 @lisp
7081 (setq gnus-article-emphasis
7082 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
7083 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
7084 @end lisp
7085
7086 @cindex slash
7087 @cindex asterisk
7088 @cindex underline
7089 @cindex /
7090 @cindex *
7091
7092 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
7093 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
7094 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
7095 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
7096 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
7097 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
7098 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
7099 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
7100 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
7101 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
7102 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
7103 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
7104 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
7105
7106 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
7107 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
7108 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
7109 say something like:
7110
7111 @lisp
7112 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
7113 @end lisp
7114
7115 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
7116
7117 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
7118 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
7119 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
7120 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
7121
7122 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
7123
7124
7125 @node Article Hiding
7126 @subsection Article Hiding
7127 @cindex article hiding
7128
7129 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
7130 too much cruft in most articles.
7131
7132 @table @kbd
7133
7134 @item W W a
7135 @kindex W W a (Summary)
7136 @findex gnus-article-hide
7137 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
7138 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
7139 headers, PGP, cited text and the signature.
7140
7141 @item W W h
7142 @kindex W W h (Summary)
7143 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
7144 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
7145 Headers}.
7146
7147 @item W W b
7148 @kindex W W b (Summary)
7149 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
7150 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
7151 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
7152
7153 @item W W s
7154 @kindex W W s (Summary)
7155 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
7156 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
7157 Signature}.
7158
7159 @item W W l
7160 @kindex W W l (Summary)
7161 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
7162 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7163 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
7164 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
7165 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
7166 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
7167 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
7168
7169 @table @code
7170
7171 @item gnus-list-identifiers
7172 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7173 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
7174 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
7175
7176 @end table
7177
7178 @item W W p
7179 @kindex W W p (Summary)
7180 @findex gnus-article-hide-pgp
7181 @vindex gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7182 Hide @sc{pgp} signatures (@code{gnus-article-hide-pgp}). The
7183 @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook} hook will be run after a @sc{pgp}
7184 signature has been hidden. For example, to automatically verify
7185 articles that have signatures in them do:
7186 @lisp
7187 ;;; Hide pgp cruft if any.
7188
7189 (setq gnus-treat-strip-pgp t)
7190
7191 ;;; After hiding pgp, verify the message;
7192 ;;; only happens if pgp signature is found.
7193
7194 (add-hook 'gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7195 (lambda ()
7196 (save-excursion
7197 (set-buffer gnus-original-article-buffer)
7198 (mc-verify))))
7199 @end lisp
7200
7201 @item W W P
7202 @kindex W W P (Summary)
7203 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
7204 Hide @sc{pem} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
7205 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
7206
7207 @item W W B
7208 @kindex W W B (Summary)
7209 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
7210 @cindex banner
7211 @cindex OneList
7212 @cindex stripping advertisements
7213 @cindex advertisements
7214 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
7215 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
7216 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
7217 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
7218 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
7219 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
7220 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
7221 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
7222 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
7223 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
7224 used.
7225
7226 @item W W c
7227 @kindex W W c (Summary)
7228 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
7229 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
7230 customizing the hiding:
7231
7232 @table @code
7233
7234 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7235 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7236 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7237 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7238 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
7239 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
7240 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
7241 specs are valid:
7242
7243 @table @samp
7244 @item b
7245 Starting point of the hidden text.
7246 @item e
7247 Ending point of the hidden text.
7248 @item l
7249 Number of characters in the hidden region.
7250 @item n
7251 Number of lines of hidden text.
7252 @end table
7253
7254 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
7255 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
7256 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
7257 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
7258 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
7259
7260 @end table
7261
7262 @item W W C-c
7263 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
7264 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
7265
7266 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
7267 following two variables:
7268
7269 @table @code
7270 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7271 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7272 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
7273 50), hide the cited text.
7274
7275 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7276 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7277 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
7278 is hidden.
7279 @end table
7280
7281 @item W W C
7282 @kindex W W C (Summary)
7283 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
7284 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
7285 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
7286 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
7287 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
7288
7289 @end table
7290
7291 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
7292 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
7293 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
7294
7295 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
7296 citation customization.
7297
7298 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
7299 automatically.
7300
7301
7302 @node Article Washing
7303 @subsection Article Washing
7304 @cindex washing
7305 @cindex article washing
7306
7307 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
7308 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
7309
7310 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
7311 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
7312 Cleaner, perhaps.
7313
7314 @table @kbd
7315
7316 @item W l
7317 @kindex W l (Summary)
7318 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
7319 Remove page breaks from the current article
7320 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
7321 delimiters.
7322
7323 @item W r
7324 @kindex W r (Summary)
7325 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
7326 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
7327 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
7328 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
7329 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
7330 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
7331
7332 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
7333 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
7334 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
7335 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
7336
7337 @item W t
7338 @item t
7339 @kindex W t (Summary)
7340 @kindex t (Summary)
7341 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
7342 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
7343 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
7344
7345 @item W v
7346 @kindex W v (Summary)
7347 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-header
7348 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
7349 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-header}).
7350
7351 @item W o
7352 @kindex W o (Summary)
7353 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
7354 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
7355
7356 @item W d
7357 @kindex W d (Summary)
7358 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
7359 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
7360 @cindex Smartquotes
7361 @cindex M******** sm*rtq**t*s
7362 @cindex Latin 1
7363 Treat M******** sm*rtq**t*s according to
7364 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
7365 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
7366 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
7367 interactively.
7368
7369 @item W w
7370 @kindex W w (Summary)
7371 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
7372 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
7373
7374 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
7375 when filling.
7376
7377 @item W Q
7378 @kindex W Q (Summary)
7379 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
7380 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
7381
7382 @item W C
7383 @kindex W C (Summary)
7384 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
7385 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
7386 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
7387
7388 @item W c
7389 @kindex W c (Summary)
7390 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
7391 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
7392 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
7393 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
7394 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
7395
7396 @item W q
7397 @kindex W q (Summary)
7398 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
7399 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
7400 Quoted-Printable is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending
7401 non-ASCII (i. e., 8-bit) articles. It typically makes strings like
7402 @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which doesn't look very
7403 readable to me. Note that the this is usually done automatically by
7404 Gnus if the message in question has a @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding}
7405 header that says that this encoding has been done.
7406
7407 @item W 6
7408 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
7409 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
7410 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}).
7411 Base64 is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending non-ASCII
7412 (i. e., 8-bit) articles. Note that the this is usually done
7413 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
7414 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding has
7415 been done.
7416
7417 @item W Z
7418 @kindex W Z (Summary)
7419 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
7420 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
7421 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
7422 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
7423
7424 @item W h
7425 @kindex W h (Summary)
7426 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
7427 Treat HTML (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}).
7428 Note that the this is usually done automatically by Gnus if the message
7429 in question has a @code{Content-Type} header that says that this type
7430 has been done.
7431
7432 @item W f
7433 @kindex W f (Summary)
7434 @cindex x-face
7435 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
7436 @findex gnus-article-x-face-command
7437 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
7438 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
7439 @iftex
7440 @iflatex
7441 \include{xface}
7442 @end iflatex
7443 @end iftex
7444 @anchor{X-Face}
7445 Look for and display any X-Face headers
7446 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}). The command executed by this
7447 function is given by the @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable.
7448 If this variable is a string, this string will be executed in a
7449 sub-shell. If it is a function, this function will be called with the
7450 face as the argument. If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which
7451 is a regexp) matches the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
7452 The default action under Emacs is to fork off the @code{display}
7453 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For the
7454 @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
7455 like `compface' or `faces-xface' on a GNU/Linux system.}
7456 to view the face. Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image
7457 support, the default action is to display the face before the
7458 @code{From} header. (It's nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with X-Face
7459 support---that will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native
7460 X-Face support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
7461 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
7462 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
7463 like @code{netpbm} or @code{libgr-progs}.}) If you
7464 want to have this function in the display hook, it should probably come
7465 last.
7466
7467 @item W b
7468 @kindex W b (Summary)
7469 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
7470 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
7471 @xref{Article Buttons}.
7472
7473 @item W B
7474 @kindex W B (Summary)
7475 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
7476 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
7477 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
7478
7479 @item W W H
7480 @kindex W W H (Summary)
7481 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body
7482 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
7483 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body}).
7484
7485 @item W E l
7486 @kindex W E l (Summary)
7487 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
7488 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
7489 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
7490
7491 @item W E m
7492 @kindex W E m (Summary)
7493 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
7494 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
7495 lines with a single empty line.
7496 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
7497
7498 @item W E t
7499 @kindex W E t (Summary)
7500 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
7501 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
7502 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
7503
7504 @item W E a
7505 @kindex W E a (Summary)
7506 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
7507 Do all the three commands above
7508 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
7509
7510 @item W E A
7511 @kindex W E A (Summary)
7512 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
7513 Remove all blank lines
7514 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
7515
7516 @item W E s
7517 @kindex W E s (Summary)
7518 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
7519 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
7520 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
7521
7522 @item W E e
7523 @kindex W E e (Summary)
7524 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
7525 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
7526 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
7527
7528 @end table
7529
7530 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
7531
7532
7533 @node Article Buttons
7534 @subsection Article Buttons
7535 @cindex buttons
7536
7537 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
7538 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
7539 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
7540 button on these references.
7541
7542 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
7543 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses and Message-IDs. This is controlled by
7544 two variables, one that handles article bodies and one that handles
7545 article heads:
7546
7547 @table @code
7548
7549 @item gnus-button-alist
7550 @vindex gnus-button-alist
7551 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
7552
7553 @lisp
7554 (REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7555 @end lisp
7556
7557 @table @var
7558
7559 @item regexp
7560 All text that match this regular expression will be considered an
7561 external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches embedded URLs:
7562 @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}.
7563
7564 @item button-par
7565 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
7566 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
7567 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
7568
7569 @item use-p
7570 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
7571 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
7572 avoid false matches.
7573
7574 @item function
7575 This function will be called when you click on this button.
7576
7577 @item data-par
7578 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
7579 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
7580
7581 @end table
7582
7583 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
7584
7585 @lisp
7586 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
7587 @end lisp
7588
7589 @item gnus-header-button-alist
7590 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
7591 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
7592 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
7593 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
7594
7595 @lisp
7596 (HEADER REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7597 @end lisp
7598
7599 @var{header} is a regular expression.
7600
7601 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
7602 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
7603 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
7604 default values of the variables above.
7605
7606 @item gnus-article-button-face
7607 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
7608 Face used on buttons.
7609
7610 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
7611 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
7612 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
7613
7614 @end table
7615
7616 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
7617
7618
7619 @node Article Date
7620 @subsection Article Date
7621
7622 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
7623 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
7624 when the article was sent.
7625
7626 @table @kbd
7627
7628 @item W T u
7629 @kindex W T u (Summary)
7630 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
7631 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
7632 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
7633
7634 @item W T i
7635 @kindex W T i (Summary)
7636 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
7637 @cindex ISO 8601
7638 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
7639 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
7640
7641 @item W T l
7642 @kindex W T l (Summary)
7643 @findex gnus-article-date-local
7644 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
7645
7646 @item W T s
7647 @kindex W T s (Summary)
7648 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
7649 @findex gnus-article-date-user
7650 @findex format-time-string
7651 Display the date using a user-defined format
7652 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
7653 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
7654 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
7655 for a list of possible format specs.
7656
7657 @item W T e
7658 @kindex W T e (Summary)
7659 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
7660 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
7661 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
7662 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
7663 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
7664
7665 @example
7666 X-Sent: 9 years, 6 weeks, 4 days, 9 hours, 3 minutes, 28 seconds ago
7667 @end example
7668
7669 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
7670 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
7671 replace it.
7672
7673 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
7674 into wonderful absurdities.
7675
7676 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
7677
7678 @lisp
7679 (gnus-start-date-timer)
7680 @end lisp
7681
7682 in your @file{.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
7683 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
7684 command.
7685
7686 @item W T o
7687 @kindex W T o (Summary)
7688 @findex gnus-article-date-original
7689 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
7690 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
7691 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
7692 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
7693 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
7694
7695 @end table
7696
7697 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
7698 preferred format automatically.
7699
7700
7701 @node Article Signature
7702 @subsection Article Signature
7703 @cindex signatures
7704 @cindex article signature
7705
7706 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7707 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
7708 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
7709 that says what is to be considered a signature is
7710 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
7711 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
7712 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
7713 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
7714 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
7715
7716 @lisp
7717 (setq gnus-signature-separator
7718 '("^-- $" ; The standard
7719 "^-- *$" ; A common mangling
7720 "^-------*$" ; Many people just use a looong
7721 ; line of dashes. Shame!
7722 "^ *--------*$" ; Double-shame!
7723 "^________*$" ; Underscores are also popular
7724 "^========*$")) ; Pervert!
7725 @end lisp
7726
7727 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
7728 positives.
7729
7730 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
7731 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
7732 signature when displaying articles.
7733
7734 @enumerate
7735 @item
7736 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
7737 that integer.
7738 @item
7739 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
7740 than that number.
7741 @item
7742 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
7743 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
7744 @item
7745 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
7746 in question is not a signature.
7747 @end enumerate
7748
7749 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
7750 listed above. Here's an example:
7751
7752 @lisp
7753 (setq gnus-signature-limit
7754 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
7755 @end lisp
7756
7757 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
7758 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
7759 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
7760 signature after all.
7761
7762
7763 @node Article Miscellania
7764 @subsection Article Miscellania
7765
7766 @table @kbd
7767 @item A t
7768 @kindex A t (Summary)
7769 @findex gnus-article-babel
7770 Translate the article from one language to another
7771 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
7772
7773 @end table
7774
7775
7776 @node MIME Commands
7777 @section @sc{mime} Commands
7778 @cindex MIME decoding
7779 @cindex attachments
7780 @cindex viewing attachments
7781
7782 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
7783 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @sc{mime} part''.
7784
7785 @table @kbd
7786 @item b
7787 @itemx K v
7788 @kindex b (Summary)
7789 @kindex K v (Summary)
7790 View the @sc{mime} part.
7791
7792 @item K o
7793 @kindex K o (Summary)
7794 Save the @sc{mime} part.
7795
7796 @item K c
7797 @kindex K c (Summary)
7798 Copy the @sc{mime} part.
7799
7800 @item K e
7801 @kindex K e (Summary)
7802 View the @sc{mime} part externally.
7803
7804 @item K i
7805 @kindex K i (Summary)
7806 View the @sc{mime} part internally.
7807
7808 @item K |
7809 @kindex K | (Summary)
7810 Pipe the @sc{mime} part to an external command.
7811 @end table
7812
7813 The rest of these @sc{mime} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
7814 the same manner:
7815
7816 @table @kbd
7817 @item K b
7818 @kindex K b (Summary)
7819 Make all the @sc{mime} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
7820 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
7821 parts.
7822
7823 @item K m
7824 @kindex K m (Summary)
7825 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
7826 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
7827 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
7828 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
7829 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
7830
7831 @item X m
7832 @kindex X m (Summary)
7833 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
7834 Save all parts matching a @sc{mime} type to a directory
7835 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
7836 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
7837
7838 @item M-t
7839 @kindex M-t (Summary)
7840 @findex gnus-summary-display-buttonized
7841 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
7842 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
7843
7844 @item W M w
7845 @kindex W M w (Summary)
7846 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
7847 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
7848
7849 @item W M c
7850 @kindex W M c (Summary)
7851 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
7852 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
7853
7854 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
7855 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
7856 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
7857 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not include
7858 MIME headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic parameter to
7859 the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
7860
7861 @item W M v
7862 @kindex W M v (Summary)
7863 View all the @sc{mime} parts in the current article
7864 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
7865
7866 @end table
7867
7868 Relevant variables:
7869
7870 @table @code
7871 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
7872 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
7873 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7874 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
7875 @code{nil}.
7876
7877 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
7878
7879 @lisp
7880 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
7881 '("text/x-vcard"))
7882 @end lisp
7883
7884 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7885 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7886 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7887 this list won't have @sc{mime} buttons inserted unless they aren't
7888 displayed. The default value is @code{(".*/.*")}.
7889
7890 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
7891 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
7892 For each @sc{mime} part, this function will be called with the @sc{mime}
7893 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
7894 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
7895 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
7896 save all jpegs into some directory).
7897
7898 Here's an example function the does the latter:
7899
7900 @lisp
7901 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
7902 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
7903 (with-temp-buffer
7904 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
7905 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
7906 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
7907 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
7908 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
7909 @end lisp
7910
7911 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7912 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7913 Alist of @sc{mime} multipart types and functions to handle them.
7914
7915 @end table
7916
7917
7918 @node Charsets
7919 @section Charsets
7920 @cindex charsets
7921
7922 People use different charsets, and we have @sc{mime} to let us know what
7923 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
7924 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @sc{mime}, and
7925 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
7926 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
7927 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
7928 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
7929
7930 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
7931 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
7932 variable, which is an alist of regexps (to match group names) and
7933 default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
7934
7935 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @sc{mime}-aware agents that
7936 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1} even
7937 if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
7938 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
7939 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be set
7940 on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
7941 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit)}, which is
7942 something some agents insist on having in there.
7943
7944 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
7945 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
7946 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @sc{mime}
7947 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
7948 quoted-printable header encoding.
7949
7950 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
7951 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
7952 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
7953
7954 @table @var
7955 @item test
7956 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
7957 variable to query,
7958 @item header
7959 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
7960 means encode all charsets),
7961 @item body-list
7962 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
7963 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
7964 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
7965 @end table
7966
7967 @cindex Russian
7968 @cindex koi8-r
7969 @cindex koi8-u
7970 @cindex iso-8859-5
7971 @cindex coding system aliases
7972 @cindex preferred charset
7973
7974 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
7975
7976 If there are several @sc{mime} charsets that encode the same Emacs
7977 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
7978
7979 @lisp
7980 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
7981 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
7982 @end lisp
7983
7984 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
7985 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @sc{mime} charset.
7986
7987 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
7988
7989 @lisp
7990 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
7991 @end lisp
7992
7993 This will almost do the right thing.
7994
7995 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
7996 something like
7997
7998 @lisp
7999 (codepage-setup 1251)
8000 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
8001 @end lisp
8002
8003
8004 @node Article Commands
8005 @section Article Commands
8006
8007 @table @kbd
8008
8009 @item A P
8010 @cindex PostScript
8011 @cindex printing
8012 @kindex A P (Summary)
8013 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
8014 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
8015 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
8016 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will be
8017 run just before printing the buffer.
8018
8019 @end table
8020
8021
8022 @node Summary Sorting
8023 @section Summary Sorting
8024 @cindex summary sorting
8025
8026 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
8027 can't really see why you'd want that.
8028
8029 @table @kbd
8030
8031 @item C-c C-s C-n
8032 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
8033 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
8034 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
8035
8036 @item C-c C-s C-a
8037 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
8038 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
8039 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
8040
8041 @item C-c C-s C-s
8042 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
8043 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
8044 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
8045
8046 @item C-c C-s C-d
8047 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
8048 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
8049 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
8050
8051 @item C-c C-s C-l
8052 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
8053 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
8054 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
8055
8056 @item C-c C-s C-c
8057 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
8058 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
8059 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
8060
8061 @item C-c C-s C-i
8062 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
8063 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
8064 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
8065 @end table
8066
8067 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
8068 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
8069 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
8070 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
8071 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
8072 Commands}).
8073
8074
8075 @node Finding the Parent
8076 @section Finding the Parent
8077 @cindex parent articles
8078 @cindex referring articles
8079
8080 @table @kbd
8081 @item ^
8082 @kindex ^ (Summary)
8083 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
8084 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
8085 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
8086 if the current group is fetched by @sc{nntp}, the parent hasn't expired
8087 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
8088 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
8089 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
8090 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
8091 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
8092
8093 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
8094 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
8095 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
8096 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
8097 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
8098 article.
8099
8100 @item A R (Summary)
8101 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
8102 @kindex A R (Summary)
8103 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
8104 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
8105
8106 @item A T (Summary)
8107 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
8108 @kindex A T (Summary)
8109 Display the full thread where the current article appears
8110 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
8111 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
8112 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
8113 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
8114 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
8115 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
8116
8117 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
8118 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
8119 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
8120 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
8121 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
8122 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
8123
8124 @item M-^ (Summary)
8125 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
8126 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
8127 @cindex Message-ID
8128 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
8129 You can also ask the @sc{nntp} server for an arbitrary article, no
8130 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
8131 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
8132 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
8133 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
8134 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
8135 @end table
8136
8137 The current select method will be used when fetching by
8138 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
8139 by giving this command a prefix.
8140
8141 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
8142 If the group you are reading is located on a backend that does not
8143 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
8144 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @sc{nntp} method. It
8145 would, perhaps, be best if the @sc{nntp} server you consult is the one
8146 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
8147 necessary.
8148
8149 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
8150 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
8151 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
8152 match.
8153
8154 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
8155 then ask Deja if that fails:
8156
8157 @lisp
8158 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
8159 '(current
8160 (nnweb "refer" (nnweb-type dejanews))))
8161 @end lisp
8162
8163 Most of the mail backends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but do
8164 not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox} and
8165 @code{nnbabyl} are able to locate articles from any groups, while
8166 @code{nnml} and @code{nnfolder} are only able to locate articles that
8167 have been posted to the current group. (Anything else would be too time
8168 consuming.) @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
8169
8170
8171 @node Alternative Approaches
8172 @section Alternative Approaches
8173
8174 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
8175 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
8176
8177 @menu
8178 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
8179 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
8180 @end menu
8181
8182
8183 @node Pick and Read
8184 @subsection Pick and Read
8185 @cindex pick and read
8186
8187 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
8188 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
8189 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
8190 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
8191
8192 @findex gnus-pick-mode
8193 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
8194 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
8195 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
8196 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
8197 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
8198
8199 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
8200
8201 @table @kbd
8202 @item .
8203 @kindex . (Pick)
8204 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
8205 Pick the article or thread on the current line
8206 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8207 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
8208 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
8209 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
8210 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
8211 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
8212
8213 @item SPACE
8214 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
8215 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
8216 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
8217 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
8218
8219 @item u
8220 @kindex u (Pick)
8221 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
8222 Unpick the thread or article
8223 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8224 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
8225 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
8226 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
8227 the thread or article at that line.
8228
8229 @item RET
8230 @kindex RET (Pick)
8231 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
8232 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
8233 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
8234 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
8235 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
8236 will still be visible when you are reading.
8237
8238 @end table
8239
8240 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
8241 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
8242 which is mapped to the same function
8243 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
8244
8245 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
8246
8247 @lisp
8248 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
8249 @end lisp
8250
8251 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
8252 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
8253
8254 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
8255 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
8256 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
8257
8258 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
8259 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
8260 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
8261 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
8262 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
8263 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
8264 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
8265
8266
8267 @node Binary Groups
8268 @subsection Binary Groups
8269 @cindex binary groups
8270
8271 @findex gnus-binary-mode
8272 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
8273 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
8274 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
8275 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
8276 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
8277 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
8278
8279 @kindex g (Binary)
8280 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
8281 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
8282 command, when you have turned on this mode
8283 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
8284
8285 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
8286 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
8287
8288
8289 @node Tree Display
8290 @section Tree Display
8291 @cindex trees
8292
8293 @vindex gnus-use-trees
8294 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
8295 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
8296 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
8297 in the tree buffer.
8298
8299 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
8300
8301 @table @code
8302 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
8303 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
8304 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
8305
8306 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8307 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8308 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
8309 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
8310 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
8311
8312 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
8313 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
8314 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
8315 default is @code{modeline}.
8316
8317 @item gnus-tree-line-format
8318 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
8319 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
8320 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
8321 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
8322 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
8323 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
8324
8325 Valid specs are:
8326
8327 @table @samp
8328 @item n
8329 The name of the poster.
8330 @item f
8331 The @code{From} header.
8332 @item N
8333 The number of the article.
8334 @item [
8335 The opening bracket.
8336 @item ]
8337 The closing bracket.
8338 @item s
8339 The subject.
8340 @end table
8341
8342 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
8343
8344 Variables related to the display are:
8345
8346 @table @code
8347 @item gnus-tree-brackets
8348 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
8349 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
8350 ``sparse'' articles. The format is @code{((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
8351 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close}) (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))}, and the
8352 default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
8353
8354 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8355 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8356 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
8357 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
8358
8359 @end table
8360
8361 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
8362 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
8363 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
8364 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
8365 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
8366 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
8367 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
8368 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
8369 other windows displayed next to it.
8370
8371 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
8372 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
8373 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8374 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
8375 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
8376 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
8377 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
8378
8379 @end table
8380
8381 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
8382
8383 @example
8384 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
8385 | \[Jan]
8386 | \[odd]-[Eri]
8387 | \(***)-[Eri]
8388 | \[odd]-[Paa]
8389 \[Bjo]
8390 \[Gun]
8391 \[Gun]-[Jor]
8392 @end example
8393
8394 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
8395
8396 @example
8397 @{***@}
8398 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
8399 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
8400 |--\-----\-----\ |
8401 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
8402 | | |--\
8403 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
8404 |
8405 [Paa]
8406 @end example
8407
8408 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
8409 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
8410 following to your @file{.gnus.el} file:
8411
8412 @lisp
8413 (setq gnus-use-trees t
8414 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8415 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
8416 (gnus-add-configuration
8417 '(article
8418 (vertical 1.0
8419 (horizontal 0.25
8420 (summary 0.75 point)
8421 (tree 1.0))
8422 (article 1.0))))
8423 @end lisp
8424
8425 @xref{Windows Configuration}.
8426
8427
8428 @node Mail Group Commands
8429 @section Mail Group Commands
8430 @cindex mail group commands
8431
8432 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
8433 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
8434
8435 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
8436 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8437
8438 @table @kbd
8439
8440 @item B e
8441 @kindex B e (Summary)
8442 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
8443 Expire all expirable articles in the group
8444 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}).
8445
8446 @item B M-C-e
8447 @kindex B M-C-e (Summary)
8448 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
8449 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
8450 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
8451 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
8452 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
8453
8454 @item B DEL
8455 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
8456 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
8457 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
8458 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
8459 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
8460 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
8461
8462 @item B m
8463 @kindex B m (Summary)
8464 @cindex move mail
8465 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
8466 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
8467 Move the article from one mail group to another
8468 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8469 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8470
8471 @item B c
8472 @kindex B c (Summary)
8473 @cindex copy mail
8474 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
8475 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
8476 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
8477 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8478 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8479
8480 @item B B
8481 @kindex B B (Summary)
8482 @cindex crosspost mail
8483 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
8484 Crosspost the current article to some other group
8485 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
8486 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
8487 be properly updated.
8488
8489 @item B i
8490 @kindex B i (Summary)
8491 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
8492 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
8493 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
8494 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
8495
8496 @item B r
8497 @kindex B r (Summary)
8498 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
8499 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
8500 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
8501 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
8502 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
8503 Marks will be preserved if @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
8504 (which is the default).
8505
8506 @item B w
8507 @itemx e
8508 @kindex B w (Summary)
8509 @kindex e (Summary)
8510 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
8511 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
8512 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
8513 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
8514 (@kbd{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
8515 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
8516
8517 @item B q
8518 @kindex B q (Summary)
8519 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
8520 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
8521 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
8522 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
8523
8524 @item B t
8525 @kindex B t (Summary)
8526 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
8527 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
8528 when repooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
8529
8530 @item B p
8531 @kindex B p (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
8533 Some people have a tendency to send you "courtesy" copies when they
8534 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
8535 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
8536 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
8537 article from your news server (or rather, from
8538 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
8539 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
8540 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
8541 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
8542 just not have arrived yet.
8543
8544 @end table
8545
8546 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
8547 @cindex moving articles
8548 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
8549 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
8550 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
8551 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
8552 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
8553 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
8554 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
8555
8556 @lisp
8557 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
8558 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
8559 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
8560 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
8561 @end lisp
8562
8563
8564 @node Various Summary Stuff
8565 @section Various Summary Stuff
8566
8567 @menu
8568 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
8569 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
8570 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
8571 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
8572 @end menu
8573
8574 @table @code
8575 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
8576 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
8577 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
8578
8579 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
8580 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
8581 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
8582 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
8583 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
8584 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
8585 have been set.
8586
8587 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8588 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8589 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
8590 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
8591 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
8592
8593 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8594 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8595 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
8596 generated.
8597
8598 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8599 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8600 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
8601 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
8602 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
8603 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
8604 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
8605 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
8606 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
8607 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
8608
8609 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8610 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8611 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
8612 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
8613 list of articles to be selected.
8614
8615 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
8616 the list in one particular group:
8617
8618 @lisp
8619 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
8620 (if (string= group "some.group")
8621 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
8622 articles))
8623 @end lisp
8624
8625 @end table
8626
8627
8628 @node Summary Group Information
8629 @subsection Summary Group Information
8630
8631 @table @kbd
8632
8633 @item H f
8634 @kindex H f (Summary)
8635 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
8636 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
8637 Try to fetch the FAQ (list of frequently asked questions) for the
8638 current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the
8639 FAQ from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory
8640 on a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
8641 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
8642 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will probably
8643 be used for fetching the file.
8644
8645 @item H d
8646 @kindex H d (Summary)
8647 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
8648 Give a brief description of the current group
8649 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
8650 rereading the description from the server.
8651
8652 @item H h
8653 @kindex H h (Summary)
8654 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
8655 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
8656 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
8657
8658 @item H i
8659 @kindex H i (Summary)
8660 @findex gnus-info-find-node
8661 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
8662 @end table
8663
8664
8665 @node Searching for Articles
8666 @subsection Searching for Articles
8667
8668 @table @kbd
8669
8670 @item M-s
8671 @kindex M-s (Summary)
8672 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
8673 Search through all subsequent articles for a regexp
8674 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
8675
8676 @item M-r
8677 @kindex M-r (Summary)
8678 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
8679 Search through all previous articles for a regexp
8680 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
8681
8682 @item &
8683 @kindex & (Summary)
8684 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
8685 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
8686 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
8687 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
8688 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
8689 search backward instead.
8690
8691 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string #} will put the process mark on
8692 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
8693
8694 @item M-&
8695 @kindex M-& (Summary)
8696 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
8697 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
8698 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
8699 @end table
8700
8701 @node Summary Generation Commands
8702 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
8703
8704 @table @kbd
8705
8706 @item Y g
8707 @kindex Y g (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
8709 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
8710
8711 @item Y c
8712 @kindex Y c (Summary)
8713 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
8714 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
8715 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
8716
8717 @end table
8718
8719
8720 @node Really Various Summary Commands
8721 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
8722
8723 @table @kbd
8724
8725 @item A D
8726 @itemx C-d
8727 @kindex C-d (Summary)
8728 @kindex A D (Summary)
8729 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
8730 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
8731 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
8732 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
8733 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
8734 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
8735 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
8736 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
8737 fashion.
8738
8739 @item M-C-d
8740 @kindex M-C-d (Summary)
8741 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
8742 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
8743 several documents into one biiig group
8744 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
8745 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
8746 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
8747 command understands the process/prefix convention
8748 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8749
8750 @item C-t
8751 @kindex C-t (Summary)
8752 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
8753 Toggle truncation of summary lines
8754 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
8755 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
8756 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
8757
8758 @item =
8759 @kindex = (Summary)
8760 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
8761 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
8762 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
8763
8764 @item M-C-e
8765 @kindex M-C-e (Summary)
8766 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
8767 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8768 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
8769
8770 @item M-C-a
8771 @kindex M-C-a (Summary)
8772 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
8773 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8774 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
8775
8776 @end table
8777
8778
8779 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
8780 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
8781 @cindex summary exit
8782 @cindex exiting groups
8783
8784 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
8785 group and return you to the group buffer.
8786
8787 @table @kbd
8788
8789 @item Z Z
8790 @itemx q
8791 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
8792 @kindex q (Summary)
8793 @findex gnus-summary-exit
8794 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
8795 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
8796 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
8797 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
8798 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
8799 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
8800 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
8801 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
8802 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
8803 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
8804
8805 @item Z E
8806 @itemx Q
8807 @kindex Z E (Summary)
8808 @kindex Q (Summary)
8809 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
8810 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
8811 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
8812
8813 @item Z c
8814 @itemx c
8815 @kindex Z c (Summary)
8816 @kindex c (Summary)
8817 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
8818 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
8819 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
8820 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
8821
8822 @item Z C
8823 @kindex Z C (Summary)
8824 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
8825 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
8826 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
8827
8828 @item Z n
8829 @kindex Z n (Summary)
8830 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
8831 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
8832 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
8833
8834 @item Z R
8835 @kindex Z R (Summary)
8836 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
8837 Exit this group, and then enter it again
8838 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
8839 all articles, both read and unread.
8840
8841 @item Z G
8842 @itemx M-g
8843 @kindex Z G (Summary)
8844 @kindex M-g (Summary)
8845 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
8846 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
8847 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
8848 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
8849 articles, both read and unread.
8850
8851 @item Z N
8852 @kindex Z N (Summary)
8853 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
8854 Exit the group and go to the next group
8855 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
8856
8857 @item Z P
8858 @kindex Z P (Summary)
8859 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
8860 Exit the group and go to the previous group
8861 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
8862
8863 @item Z s
8864 @kindex Z s (Summary)
8865 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
8866 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
8867 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
8868 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
8869 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
8870 @end table
8871
8872 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
8873 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
8874 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
8875 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
8876
8877 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
8878 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
8879 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
8880 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
8881 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
8882 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
8883 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
8884 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
8885 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
8886 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
8887 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
8888 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
8889
8890 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
8891
8892 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
8893 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
8894 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
8895 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
8896 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
8897 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
8898 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
8899 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
8900 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
8901
8902
8903 @node Crosspost Handling
8904 @section Crosspost Handling
8905
8906 @cindex velveeta
8907 @cindex spamming
8908 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
8909 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
8910 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
8911 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
8912 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
8913 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
8914 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
8915
8916 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
8917 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
8918 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
8919 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
8920 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
8921
8922 @cindex cross-posting
8923 @cindex Xref
8924 @cindex @sc{nov}
8925 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
8926 correctly is if you use an @sc{nntp} server that supports @sc{xover}
8927 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
8928 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @sc{nov} lines. This is
8929 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
8930 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
8931 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
8932 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
8933 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
8934 the cross reference mechanism.
8935
8936 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
8937 @cindex overview.fmt
8938 To check whether your @sc{nntp} server includes the @code{Xref} header
8939 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
8940 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
8941 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
8942 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
8943 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
8944 overview files.
8945
8946 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
8947 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
8948 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
8949 considerably.
8950
8951 C'est la vie.
8952
8953 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
8954
8955
8956 @node Duplicate Suppression
8957 @section Duplicate Suppression
8958
8959 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
8960 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
8961 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
8962 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
8963 reasons.
8964
8965 @enumerate
8966 @item
8967 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
8968 is evil and not very common.
8969
8970 @item
8971 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
8972 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
8973
8974 @item
8975 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
8976 different @sc{nntp} servers.
8977
8978 @item
8979 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
8980 @end enumerate
8981
8982 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
8983 well, but these four are the most common situations.
8984
8985 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
8986 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
8987 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
8988 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
8989 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
8990 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
8991 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
8992 once.
8993
8994 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
8995 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
8996 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
8997 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
8998 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
8999 saw the article in.
9000
9001 @table @code
9002 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
9003 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
9004 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
9005
9006 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
9007 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
9008 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
9009 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
9010 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
9011 session are suppressed.
9012
9013 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
9014 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
9015 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
9016 suppression list. The default is 10000.
9017
9018 @item gnus-duplicate-file
9019 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
9020 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
9021 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
9022 @end table
9023
9024 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
9025 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
9026 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
9027 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
9028 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
9029 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
9030 to you to figure out, I think.
9031
9032
9033 @node The Article Buffer
9034 @chapter The Article Buffer
9035 @cindex article buffer
9036
9037 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
9038 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
9039 tell Gnus otherwise.
9040
9041 @menu
9042 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
9043 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
9044 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
9045 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
9046 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
9047 @end menu
9048
9049
9050 @node Hiding Headers
9051 @section Hiding Headers
9052 @cindex hiding headers
9053 @cindex deleting headers
9054
9055 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
9056 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
9057
9058 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
9059 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
9060 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
9061 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
9062 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
9063 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
9064 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseum---and you'll probably want to get rid
9065 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
9066 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
9067
9068 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
9069
9070 @table @code
9071
9072 @item gnus-visible-headers
9073 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
9074 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
9075 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
9076 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
9077
9078 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
9079 the article and the subject, you'd say:
9080
9081 @lisp
9082 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
9083 @end lisp
9084
9085 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9086 remain visible.
9087
9088 @item gnus-ignored-headers
9089 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
9090 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
9091 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
9092 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
9093 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
9094
9095 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
9096 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
9097
9098 @lisp
9099 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
9100 @end lisp
9101
9102 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9103 be removed.
9104
9105 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
9106 variable will have no effect.
9107
9108 @end table
9109
9110 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
9111 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
9112 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
9113 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
9114 the headers are to be displayed.
9115
9116 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
9117 and then the subject, you might say something like:
9118
9119 @lisp
9120 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
9121 @end lisp
9122
9123 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
9124 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
9125
9126 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9127 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
9128 You can hide further boring headers by setting
9129 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-header} to @code{head}. What this function
9130 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
9131 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead is
9132 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
9133 from sight.
9134
9135 These conditions are:
9136 @table @code
9137 @item empty
9138 Remove all empty headers.
9139 @item followup-to
9140 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
9141 @code{Newsgroups} header.
9142 @item reply-to
9143 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same address as the
9144 @code{From} header.
9145 @item newsgroups
9146 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
9147 name.
9148 @item date
9149 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
9150 old.
9151 @item long-to
9152 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
9153 @item many-to
9154 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
9155 @end table
9156
9157 To include the four three elements, you could say something like;
9158
9159 @lisp
9160 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
9161 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
9162 @end lisp
9163
9164 This is also the default value for this variable.
9165
9166
9167 @node Using MIME
9168 @section Using @sc{mime}
9169 @cindex @sc{mime}
9170
9171 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
9172 while people stand around yawning.
9173
9174 @sc{mime}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
9175 while all newsreaders die of fear.
9176
9177 @sc{mime} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
9178 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
9179 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
9180
9181 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
9182 @findex gnus-display-mime
9183 Gnus pushes @sc{mime} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
9184 to display the @sc{mime} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
9185 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
9186 display, save and manipulate the @sc{mime} objects.
9187
9188 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
9189 @sc{mime} button:
9190
9191 @table @kbd
9192 @findex gnus-article-press-button
9193 @item RET (Article)
9194 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
9195 Toggle displaying of the @sc{mime} object
9196 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}).
9197
9198 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
9199 @item M-RET (Article)
9200 @itemx v (Article)
9201 Prompt for a method, and then view the @sc{mime} object using this
9202 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
9203
9204 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
9205 @item o (Article)
9206 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @sc{mime} object
9207 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
9208
9209 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
9210 @item c (Article)
9211 Copy the @sc{mime} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
9212 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}).
9213
9214 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
9215 @item t (Article)
9216 View the @sc{mime} object as if it were a different @sc{mime} media type
9217 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
9218
9219 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
9220 @item | (Article)
9221 Output the @sc{mime} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
9222
9223 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
9224 @item i (Article)
9225 Insert the contents of the @sc{mime} object into the buffer
9226 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
9227 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
9228 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
9229 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @pxref{Paging the
9230 Article}).
9231
9232 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
9233 @item . (Article)
9234 Interactively run an action on the @sc{mime} object
9235 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
9236
9237 @end table
9238
9239 Gnus will display some @sc{mime} objects automatically. The way Gnus
9240 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs MIME
9241 manual.
9242
9243 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
9244 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
9245 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @sc{mime} has
9246 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
9247 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
9248 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
9249 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
9250 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
9251 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
9252
9253 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
9254
9255 Also see @pxref{MIME Commands}.
9256
9257
9258 @node Customizing Articles
9259 @section Customizing Articles
9260 @cindex article customization
9261
9262 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
9263 exist. You can call these functions interactively, or you can have them
9264 called automatically when you select the articles.
9265
9266 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
9267 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
9268 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
9269 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
9270
9271 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
9272 for sensible values.
9273
9274 @enumerate
9275 @item
9276 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
9277
9278 @item
9279 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
9280
9281 @item
9282 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
9283
9284 @item
9285 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
9286
9287 @item
9288 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
9289 than this number.
9290
9291 @item
9292 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
9293 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
9294 regexps in the list.
9295
9296 @item
9297 A list where the first element is not a string:
9298
9299 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
9300 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
9301 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
9302
9303 @lisp
9304 (or last
9305 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
9306 @end lisp
9307
9308 @end enumerate
9309
9310 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
9311 to the fact that some messages are @sc{mime} multipart articles that may
9312 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
9313 considered to contain just a single part.
9314
9315 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
9316 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
9317 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
9318 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
9319 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
9320 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
9321 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
9322
9323 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
9324 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
9325 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
9326 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
9327
9328 @table @code
9329 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last)
9330 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
9331 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
9332 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
9333 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
9334 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
9335 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
9336 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
9337 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
9338 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
9339 @item gnus-treat-strip-pgp (t, last, integer)
9340 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
9341 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
9342 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
9343 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
9344 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
9345 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
9346 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
9347 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
9348 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
9349 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
9350 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
9351 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
9352 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
9353 @item gnus-treat-display-xface (head)
9354 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
9355 @item gnus-treat-display-picons (head)
9356 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
9357 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
9358 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
9359 @item gnus-treat-translate
9360 @end table
9361
9362 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
9363 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
9364 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
9365 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
9366 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
9367 everything.
9368
9369
9370 @node Article Keymap
9371 @section Article Keymap
9372
9373 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
9374 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
9375 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
9376 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
9377 buffer.
9378
9379 A few additional keystrokes are available:
9380
9381 @table @kbd
9382
9383 @item SPACE
9384 @kindex SPACE (Article)
9385 @findex gnus-article-next-page
9386 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
9387
9388 @item DEL
9389 @kindex DEL (Article)
9390 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
9391 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
9392
9393 @item C-c ^
9394 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
9395 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
9396 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
9397 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
9398 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
9399
9400 @item C-c C-m
9401 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
9402 @findex gnus-article-mail
9403 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
9404 given a prefix, include the mail.
9405
9406 @item s
9407 @kindex s (Article)
9408 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
9409 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
9410 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
9411
9412 @item ?
9413 @kindex ? (Article)
9414 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
9415 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
9416 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
9417
9418 @item TAB
9419 @kindex TAB (Article)
9420 @findex gnus-article-next-button
9421 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
9422 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
9423
9424 @item M-TAB
9425 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
9426 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
9427 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
9428
9429 @end table
9430
9431
9432 @node Misc Article
9433 @section Misc Article
9434
9435 @table @code
9436
9437 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
9438 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
9439 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
9440 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
9441 article buffer.
9442
9443 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
9444 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
9445 @cindex MIME
9446 Hook used to decode @sc{mime} articles. The default value is
9447 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
9448
9449 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
9450 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
9451 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
9452 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
9453 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
9454 the contents of the article buffer.
9455
9456 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
9457 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
9458 Hook called in article mode buffers.
9459
9460 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9461 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9462 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
9463 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
9464
9465 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
9466 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
9467 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
9468 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
9469 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with two
9470 extensions:
9471
9472 @table @samp
9473 @item w
9474 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
9475 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
9476 performed.
9477 @item m
9478 The number of @sc{mime} parts in the article.
9479 @end table
9480
9481 @vindex gnus-break-pages
9482
9483 @item gnus-break-pages
9484 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
9485 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
9486 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
9487 paging will not be done.
9488
9489 @item gnus-page-delimiter
9490 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
9491 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
9492 (formfeed).
9493 @end table
9494
9495
9496 @node Composing Messages
9497 @chapter Composing Messages
9498 @cindex composing messages
9499 @cindex messages
9500 @cindex mail
9501 @cindex sending mail
9502 @cindex reply
9503 @cindex followup
9504 @cindex post
9505
9506 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
9507 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
9508 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
9509 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Top, message, The
9510 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
9511 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
9512
9513 @menu
9514 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
9515 * Post:: Posting and following up.
9516 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
9517 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
9518 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
9519 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
9520 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
9521 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
9522 @end menu
9523
9524 Also see @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
9525 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
9526
9527
9528 @node Mail
9529 @section Mail
9530
9531 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
9532
9533 @table @code
9534 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
9535 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
9536 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
9537 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched.
9538
9539 @item gnus-add-to-list
9540 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
9541 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
9542 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
9543
9544 @item message-send-mail-partially-limit
9545 @vindex message-send-mail-partially-limit
9546 The limitation of messages sent as message/partial.
9547 The lower bound of message size in characters, beyond which the message
9548 should be sent in several parts. If it is nil, the size is unlimited.
9549
9550 @end table
9551
9552
9553 @node Post
9554 @section Post
9555
9556 Variables for composing news articles:
9557
9558 @table @code
9559 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-file
9560 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-file
9561 Gnus will keep a @code{Message-ID} history file of all the mails it has
9562 sent. If it discovers that it has already sent a mail, it will ask the
9563 user whether to re-send the mail. (This is primarily useful when
9564 dealing with @sc{soup} packets and the like where one is apt to send the
9565 same packet multiple times.) This variable says what the name of this
9566 history file is. It is @file{~/News/Sent-Message-IDs} by default. Set
9567 this variable to @code{nil} if you don't want Gnus to keep a history
9568 file.
9569
9570 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-length
9571 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-length
9572 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the history
9573 file. It is 1000 by default.
9574
9575 @end table
9576
9577
9578 @node Posting Server
9579 @section Posting Server
9580
9581 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
9582 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
9583
9584 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
9585
9586 @vindex gnus-post-method
9587
9588 It can be quite complicated. Normally, Gnus will use the same native
9589 server. However. If your native server doesn't allow posting, just
9590 reading, you probably want to use some other server to post your
9591 (extremely intelligent and fabulously interesting) articles. You can
9592 then set the @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
9593
9594 @lisp
9595 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
9596 @end lisp
9597
9598 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
9599 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
9600 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
9601 the ``current'' server for posting.
9602
9603 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
9604 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
9605
9606 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
9607 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
9608 for posting.
9609
9610 Finally, if you want to always post using the same select method as
9611 you're reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
9612 groups from different private servers), you can set this variable to
9613 @code{current}.
9614
9615
9616 @node Mail and Post
9617 @section Mail and Post
9618
9619 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
9620 posting:
9621
9622 @table @code
9623 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
9624 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
9625 @cindex mailing lists
9626
9627 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
9628 gatewayed to the @sc{nntp} server, you can read those groups without
9629 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
9630 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
9631 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
9632 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
9633 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
9634 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
9635 still a pain, though.
9636
9637 @end table
9638
9639 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
9640 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
9641 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
9642
9643 @cindex ispell
9644 @findex ispell-message
9645 @lisp
9646 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
9647 @end lisp
9648
9649 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
9650 you're in, you could say something like the following:
9651
9652 @lisp
9653 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
9654 (lambda ()
9655 (cond
9656 ((string-match "^de\\." gnus-newsgroup-name)
9657 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
9658 (t
9659 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
9660 @end lisp
9661
9662 Modify to suit your needs.
9663
9664
9665 @node Archived Messages
9666 @section Archived Messages
9667 @cindex archived messages
9668 @cindex sent messages
9669
9670 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
9671 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
9672 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
9673 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
9674 is the default.
9675
9676 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
9677 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
9678 use to store sent messages. The default is:
9679
9680 @lisp
9681 (nnfolder "archive"
9682 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
9683 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
9684 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
9685 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
9686 @end lisp
9687
9688 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
9689 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
9690 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
9691 directory chosen, you could say something like:
9692
9693 @lisp
9694 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
9695 '(nnfolder "archive"
9696 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
9697 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
9698 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
9699 @end lisp
9700
9701 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
9702 @cindex Gcc
9703 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
9704 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
9705 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
9706
9707 This variable can be used to do the following:
9708
9709 @itemize @bullet
9710 @item a string
9711 Messages will be saved in that group.
9712
9713 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
9714 message will not be stored in the select method given by
9715 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
9716 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
9717 has the default value shown above. Then setting
9718 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
9719 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
9720 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
9721 @samp{nnml:foo}.
9722 @item a list of strings
9723 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
9724 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
9725 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
9726 @item @code{nil}
9727 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
9728 @end itemize
9729
9730 Let's illustrate:
9731
9732 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
9733 @lisp
9734 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
9735 @end lisp
9736
9737 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
9738 @lisp
9739 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
9740 @end lisp
9741
9742 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
9743 @lisp
9744 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9745 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
9746 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
9747 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
9748 @end lisp
9749
9750 More complex stuff:
9751 @lisp
9752 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9753 '((if (message-news-p)
9754 "misc-news"
9755 "misc-mail")))
9756 @end lisp
9757
9758 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
9759 messages in one file per month:
9760
9761 @lisp
9762 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9763 '((if (message-news-p)
9764 "misc-news"
9765 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
9766 @end lisp
9767
9768 (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
9769 use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
9770
9771 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
9772 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
9773 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
9774 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
9775 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
9776 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
9777 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
9778 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
9779 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
9780 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
9781
9782 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
9783 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
9784 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
9785 this will disable archiving.
9786
9787 @table @code
9788 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
9789 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
9790 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
9791 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
9792 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
9793 group names.
9794
9795 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
9796 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
9797 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
9798 of names).
9799
9800 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
9801 but the latter is the preferred method.
9802 @end table
9803
9804
9805 @node Posting Styles
9806 @section Posting Styles
9807 @cindex posting styles
9808 @cindex styles
9809
9810 All them variables, they make my head swim.
9811
9812 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
9813 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
9814 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
9815 on?
9816
9817 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
9818 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
9819 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
9820 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
9821 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
9822 variable:
9823
9824 @lisp
9825 ((".*"
9826 (signature "Peace and happiness")
9827 (organization "What me?"))
9828 ("^comp"
9829 (signature "Death to everybody"))
9830 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
9831 (organization "Emacs is it")))
9832 @end lisp
9833
9834 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
9835 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
9836 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
9837 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
9838 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
9839 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
9840 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
9841 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
9842
9843 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
9844 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
9845 If it is the symbol @code{header}, then Gnus will look for header that
9846 match the next element in the match, and compare that to the last header
9847 in the match. If it's a function symbol, that function will be called
9848 with no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
9849 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
9850 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is said
9851 to @dfn{match}.
9852
9853 Each style may contain a arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
9854 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} . @var{value})} pair. The
9855 attribute name can be one of @code{signature}, @code{signature-file},
9856 @code{organization}, @code{address}, @code{name} or @code{body}. The
9857 attribute name can also be a string. In that case, this will be used as
9858 a header name, and the value will be inserted in the headers of the
9859 article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header name will be removed.
9860 If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form is evaluated, and the
9861 result is thrown away.
9862
9863 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
9864 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
9865 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
9866 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
9867 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
9868 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable.
9869
9870 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
9871 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
9872 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
9873
9874 @findex message-mail-p
9875 @findex message-news-p
9876
9877 So here's a new example:
9878
9879 @lisp
9880 (setq gnus-posting-styles
9881 '((".*"
9882 (signature-file "~/.signature")
9883 (name "User Name")
9884 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
9885 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
9886 ("^rec.humor"
9887 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
9888 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly")
9889 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
9890 ((message-news-p)
9891 (signature my-news-signature))
9892 (header "From\\|To" "larsi.*org"
9893 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
9894 ((posting-from-work-p)
9895 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
9896 (address "user@@bar.foo")
9897 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
9898 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
9899 ("^nn.+:"
9900 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
9901 @end lisp
9902
9903
9904 @node Drafts
9905 @section Drafts
9906 @cindex drafts
9907
9908 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
9909 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
9910 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
9911 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
9912 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
9913
9914 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
9915 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
9916 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
9917 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
9918 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
9919 group.)
9920
9921 @cindex nndraft
9922 @vindex nndraft-directory
9923 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
9924 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
9925 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
9926 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
9927 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
9928 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
9929
9930 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
9931 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
9932 unsubscribe it.
9933
9934 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
9935 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
9936 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
9937 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
9938 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
9939 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
9940 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
9941 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
9942 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
9943 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
9944 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
9945 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
9946 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
9947 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
9948 @c
9949 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
9950 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
9951 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
9952
9953 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
9954 @kindex D e (Draft)
9955 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
9956 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
9957 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
9958
9959 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
9960 Articles}).
9961
9962 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
9963 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
9964 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
9965 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
9966 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
9967 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
9968 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
9969 in the buffer.
9970
9971 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
9972 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
9973 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
9974
9975
9976 @node Rejected Articles
9977 @section Rejected Articles
9978 @cindex rejected articles
9979
9980 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
9981 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
9982 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
9983 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
9984
9985 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
9986 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
9987 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
9988 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
9989 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
9990
9991 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
9992 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
9993 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
9994
9995
9996 @node Select Methods
9997 @chapter Select Methods
9998 @cindex foreign groups
9999 @cindex select methods
10000
10001 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
10002 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
10003 @sc{nntp} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
10004 personal mail group.
10005
10006 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
10007 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
10008 list where the first element says what backend to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
10009 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
10010 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
10011 value may have special meaning for the backend in question.
10012
10013 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
10014 we do just that (@pxref{The Server Buffer}).
10015
10016 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the backend will recognize the
10017 group as.
10018
10019 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @sc{nntp} server
10020 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
10021 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
10022 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
10023 backend just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
10024
10025 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
10026
10027 @menu
10028 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
10029 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
10030 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
10031 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
10032 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
10033 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
10034 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
10035 @end menu
10036
10037
10038 @node The Server Buffer
10039 @section The Server Buffer
10040
10041 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
10042 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
10043 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
10044 one backend or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
10045 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
10046 backend represents a virtual server.
10047
10048 For instance, the @code{nntp} backend may be used to connect to several
10049 different actual @sc{nntp} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
10050 on the same actual @sc{nntp} server. You tell Gnus which backend to
10051 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
10052
10053 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
10054 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
10055 @sc{nntp} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
10056 hangs if queried for @sc{nov} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
10057 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
10058 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
10059 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
10060
10061 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
10062 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
10063
10064 @menu
10065 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
10066 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
10067 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
10068 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
10069 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
10070 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
10071 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
10072 @end menu
10073
10074 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
10075 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
10076
10077
10078 @node Server Buffer Format
10079 @subsection Server Buffer Format
10080 @cindex server buffer format
10081
10082 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
10083 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
10084 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
10085 variable, with some simple extensions:
10086
10087 @table @samp
10088
10089 @item h
10090 How the news is fetched---the backend name.
10091
10092 @item n
10093 The name of this server.
10094
10095 @item w
10096 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
10097
10098 @item s
10099 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
10100 @end table
10101
10102 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
10103 The mode line can also be customized by using the
10104 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
10105 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
10106
10107 @table @samp
10108 @item S
10109 Server name.
10110
10111 @item M
10112 Server method.
10113 @end table
10114
10115 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
10116
10117
10118 @node Server Commands
10119 @subsection Server Commands
10120 @cindex server commands
10121
10122 @table @kbd
10123
10124 @item a
10125 @kindex a (Server)
10126 @findex gnus-server-add-server
10127 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
10128
10129 @item e
10130 @kindex e (Server)
10131 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
10132 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
10133
10134 @item SPACE
10135 @kindex SPACE (Server)
10136 @findex gnus-server-read-server
10137 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
10138
10139 @item q
10140 @kindex q (Server)
10141 @findex gnus-server-exit
10142 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
10143
10144 @item k
10145 @kindex k (Server)
10146 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
10147 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
10148
10149 @item y
10150 @kindex y (Server)
10151 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
10152 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
10153
10154 @item c
10155 @kindex c (Server)
10156 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
10157 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
10158
10159 @item l
10160 @kindex l (Server)
10161 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
10162 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
10163
10164 @item s
10165 @kindex s (Server)
10166 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
10167 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
10168 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
10169 servers.
10170
10171 @item g
10172 @kindex g (Server)
10173 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
10174 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
10175 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
10176 a mail backend that has gotten out of sync.
10177
10178 @end table
10179
10180
10181 @node Example Methods
10182 @subsection Example Methods
10183
10184 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
10185
10186 @lisp
10187 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
10188 @end lisp
10189
10190 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
10191
10192 @lisp
10193 (nnspool "")
10194 @end lisp
10195
10196 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
10197 backend, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
10198 will.
10199
10200 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
10201 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
10202
10203 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
10204 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
10205 look like then:
10206
10207 @lisp
10208 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
10209 @end lisp
10210
10211 You should read the documentation to each backend to find out what
10212 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
10213
10214 @code{nnmh} is a mail backend that reads a spool-like structure. Say
10215 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
10216 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
10217 your private mail:
10218
10219 @lisp
10220 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
10221 @end lisp
10222
10223 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
10224 that.)
10225
10226 Here's the method for a public spool:
10227
10228 @lisp
10229 (nnmh "public"
10230 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
10231 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
10232 @end lisp
10233
10234 @cindex proxy
10235 @cindex firewall
10236
10237 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @sc{nntp}
10238 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
10239 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @sc{nntp} server.
10240 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
10241 should probably look something like this:
10242
10243 @lisp
10244 (nntp "firewall"
10245 (nntp-address "the.firewall.machine")
10246 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10247 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10248 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10249 ("telnet" "the.real.nntp.host" "nntp")))
10250 @end lisp
10251
10252 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
10253 compressed connection over the modem line, you could create a virtual
10254 server that would look something like this:
10255
10256 @lisp
10257 (nntp "news"
10258 (nntp-address "copper.uio.no")
10259 (nntp-rlogin-program "ssh")
10260 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10261 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10262 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10263 ("telnet" "news.uio.no" "nntp")))
10264 @end lisp
10265
10266 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
10267 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
10268 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
10269 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
10270
10271
10272 @node Creating a Virtual Server
10273 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
10274
10275 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
10276 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
10277
10278 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
10279 would probably be best to use @code{nnspool} to read the cache. You
10280 could also use @code{nnml} or @code{nnmh}, though.
10281
10282 Type @kbd{a nnspool RET cache RET}.
10283
10284 You should now have a brand new @code{nnspool} virtual server called
10285 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
10286 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
10287 will contain the following:
10288
10289 @lisp
10290 (nnspool "cache")
10291 @end lisp
10292
10293 Change that to:
10294
10295 @lisp
10296 (nnspool "cache"
10297 (nnspool-spool-directory "~/News/cache/")
10298 (nnspool-nov-directory "~/News/cache/")
10299 (nnspool-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
10300 @end lisp
10301
10302 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
10303 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
10304 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
10305
10306
10307 @node Server Variables
10308 @subsection Server Variables
10309
10310 One sticky point when defining variables (both on backends and in Emacs
10311 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
10312 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
10313 change the "base" variable after the variables have been loaded, you
10314 won't change the "derived" variables.
10315
10316 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
10317 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
10318 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
10319 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
10320 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
10321 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
10322 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
10323 variables for each backend, see each backend's section later in this
10324 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
10325
10326 @lisp
10327 (nnml "public"
10328 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
10329 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
10330 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
10331 @end lisp
10332
10333
10334 @node Servers and Methods
10335 @subsection Servers and Methods
10336
10337 Wherever you would normally use a select method
10338 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
10339 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
10340 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
10341 over.
10342
10343
10344 @node Unavailable Servers
10345 @subsection Unavailable Servers
10346
10347 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
10348 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
10349 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
10350 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
10351 actually the case or not.
10352
10353 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
10354 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
10355 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
10356 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
10357 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
10358 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
10359 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
10360 it will regard that server as ``down''.
10361
10362 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
10363 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
10364
10365 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{The Server Buffer}) and poke it
10366 with the following commands:
10367
10368 @table @kbd
10369
10370 @item O
10371 @kindex O (Server)
10372 @findex gnus-server-open-server
10373 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
10374 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
10375
10376 @item C
10377 @kindex C (Server)
10378 @findex gnus-server-close-server
10379 Close the connection (if any) to the server
10380 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
10381
10382 @item D
10383 @kindex D (Server)
10384 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
10385 Mark the current server as unreachable
10386 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
10387
10388 @item M-o
10389 @kindex M-o (Server)
10390 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
10391 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
10392 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
10393
10394 @item M-c
10395 @kindex M-c (Server)
10396 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
10397 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
10398 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
10399
10400 @item R
10401 @kindex R (Server)
10402 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
10403 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
10404 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
10405
10406 @end table
10407
10408
10409 @node Getting News
10410 @section Getting News
10411 @cindex reading news
10412 @cindex news backends
10413
10414 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
10415 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @sc{nntp} server,
10416 or it can read from a local spool.
10417
10418 @menu
10419 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
10420 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
10421 @end menu
10422
10423
10424 @node NNTP
10425 @subsection @sc{nntp}
10426 @cindex nntp
10427
10428 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @sc{nntp} server is rather easy.
10429 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @sc{nntp}
10430 server as the, uhm, address.
10431
10432 If the @sc{nntp} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
10433 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
10434 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
10435 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
10436
10437 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
10438 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
10439 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
10440
10441 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
10442 server:
10443
10444 @table @code
10445
10446 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
10447 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
10448 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
10449 @cindex authinfo
10450 @cindex authentification
10451 @cindex nntp authentification
10452 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10453 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
10454 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
10455 commands to the @sc{nntp} server after it has been contacted. By
10456 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
10457 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
10458 present in this hook.
10459
10460 @item nntp-authinfo-function
10461 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
10462 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10463 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
10464 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @sc{nntp}
10465 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
10466 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
10467 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
10468 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
10469 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
10470 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
10471 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
10472
10473 @enumerate
10474 @item
10475 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
10476
10477 @item
10478 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
10479 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
10480 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
10481 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
10482 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
10483 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
10484 @samp{force} is explained below.
10485
10486 @end enumerate
10487
10488 Here's an example file:
10489
10490 @example
10491 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
10492 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
10493 @end example
10494
10495 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
10496 have to be first, for instance.
10497
10498 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
10499 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
10500 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
10501 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
10502 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
10503 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
10504 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
10505
10506 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
10507 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
10508
10509 @example
10510 default force yes
10511 @end example
10512
10513 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
10514 previously mentioned.
10515
10516 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
10517
10518 @item nntp-server-action-alist
10519 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
10520 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
10521 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
10522 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
10523
10524 @lisp
10525 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
10526 '(("innd" (ding))))
10527 @end lisp
10528
10529 You probably don't want to do that, though.
10530
10531 The default value is
10532
10533 @lisp
10534 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
10535 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
10536 @end lisp
10537
10538 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
10539 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
10540
10541 @item nntp-maximum-request
10542 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
10543 If the @sc{nntp} server doesn't support @sc{nov} headers, this backend
10544 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
10545 speed things up, the backend sends lots of these commands without
10546 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
10547 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
10548 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
10549
10550 @item nntp-connection-timeout
10551 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
10552 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
10553 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @sc{nntp} servers not
10554 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
10555 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
10556 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
10557 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} backend should wait for a
10558 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
10559 no timeouts are done.
10560
10561 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
10562 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
10563 @c @cindex PPP connections
10564 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
10565 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
10566 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
10567 @c changes after connecting to the @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will simply sit
10568 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
10569 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
10570 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
10571 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
10572 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
10573 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
10574 @c
10575 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
10576 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
10577 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
10578 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
10579 @c described above.
10580
10581 @item nntp-server-hook
10582 @vindex nntp-server-hook
10583 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @sc{nntp}
10584 server.
10585
10586 @findex nntp-open-rlogin
10587 @findex nntp-open-telnet
10588 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
10589 @item nntp-open-connection-function
10590 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
10591 This function is used to connect to the remote system. Four pre-made
10592 functions are supplied:
10593
10594 @table @code
10595 @item nntp-open-network-stream
10596 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
10597 remote system.
10598
10599 @item nntp-open-rlogin
10600 Does an @samp{rlogin} on the
10601 remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet} to the @sc{nntp} server
10602 available there.
10603
10604 @code{nntp-open-rlogin}-related variables:
10605
10606 @table @code
10607
10608 @item nntp-rlogin-program
10609 @vindex nntp-rlogin-program
10610 Program used to log in on remote machines. The default is @samp{rsh},
10611 but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
10612
10613 @item nntp-rlogin-parameters
10614 @vindex nntp-rlogin-parameters
10615 This list will be used as the parameter list given to @code{rsh}.
10616
10617 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10618 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10619 User name on the remote system.
10620
10621 @end table
10622
10623 @item nntp-open-telnet
10624 Does a @samp{telnet} to the remote system and then another @samp{telnet}
10625 to get to the @sc{nntp} server.
10626
10627 @code{nntp-open-telnet}-related variables:
10628
10629 @table @code
10630 @item nntp-telnet-command
10631 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
10632 Command used to start @code{telnet}.
10633
10634 @item nntp-telnet-switches
10635 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
10636 List of strings to be used as the switches to the @code{telnet} command.
10637
10638 @item nntp-telnet-user-name
10639 @vindex nntp-telnet-user-name
10640 User name for log in on the remote system.
10641
10642 @item nntp-telnet-passwd
10643 @vindex nntp-telnet-passwd
10644 Password to use when logging in.
10645
10646 @item nntp-telnet-parameters
10647 @vindex nntp-telnet-parameters
10648 A list of strings executed as a command after logging in
10649 via @code{telnet}.
10650
10651 @item nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10652 @vindex nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10653 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the remote machine. The default is
10654 @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
10655
10656 @item nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10657 @vindex nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10658 If non-@code{nil}, the @code{telnet} session (client and server both)
10659 will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for login name.
10660 This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
10661
10662 @end table
10663
10664 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
10665 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
10666 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use this
10667 you must have SSLay installed
10668 (@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL}, and you also need
10669 @file{ssl.el} (from the W3 distribution, for instance). You then
10670 define a server as follows:
10671
10672 @lisp
10673 ;; Type `C-c C-c' after you've finished editing.
10674 ;;
10675 ;; "snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our /etc/services
10676 ;;
10677 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
10678 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
10679 (nntp-port-number "snews")
10680 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
10681 @end lisp
10682
10683 @end table
10684
10685 @item nntp-end-of-line
10686 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
10687 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @sc{nntp}
10688 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
10689 using @code{rlogin} to talk to the server.
10690
10691 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10692 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10693 User name on the remote system when using the @code{rlogin} connect
10694 function.
10695
10696 @item nntp-address
10697 @vindex nntp-address
10698 The address of the remote system running the @sc{nntp} server.
10699
10700 @item nntp-port-number
10701 @vindex nntp-port-number
10702 Port number to connect to when using the @code{nntp-open-network-stream}
10703 connect function.
10704
10705 @item nntp-buggy-select
10706 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
10707 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
10708
10709 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
10710 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
10711 If the @sc{nntp} server does not support @sc{nov}, you could set this
10712 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @sc{nov}
10713 can be used.
10714
10715 @item nntp-xover-commands
10716 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
10717 @cindex nov
10718 @cindex XOVER
10719 List of strings used as commands to fetch @sc{nov} lines from a
10720 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
10721 "XOVERVIEW")}.
10722
10723 @item nntp-nov-gap
10724 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
10725 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @sc{nov} lines to
10726 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
10727 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
10728 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @sc{nov}
10729 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
10730 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
10731 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
10732 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
10733 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
10734 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
10735
10736 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
10737 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
10738 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @sc{nntp} server.
10739
10740 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10741 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10742 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
10743 server closes connection.
10744
10745 @item nntp-record-commands
10746 @vindex nntp-record-commands
10747 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
10748 @sc{nntp} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
10749 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@sc{nntp} connection
10750 that doesn't seem to work.
10751
10752 @end table
10753
10754
10755 @node News Spool
10756 @subsection News Spool
10757 @cindex nnspool
10758 @cindex news spool
10759
10760 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
10761 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
10762 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
10763 instance.
10764
10765 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
10766 anything else) as the address.
10767
10768 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
10769 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
10770 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
10771 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
10772
10773 @table @code
10774
10775 @item nnspool-inews-program
10776 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
10777 Program used to post an article.
10778
10779 @item nnspool-inews-switches
10780 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
10781 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
10782
10783 @item nnspool-spool-directory
10784 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
10785 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
10786 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
10787
10788 @item nnspool-nov-directory
10789 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
10790 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @sc{nov} files. This is normally
10791 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
10792
10793 @item nnspool-lib-dir
10794 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
10795 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
10796
10797 @item nnspool-active-file
10798 @vindex nnspool-active-file
10799 The path to the active file.
10800
10801 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
10802 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
10803 The path to the group descriptions file.
10804
10805 @item nnspool-history-file
10806 @vindex nnspool-history-file
10807 The path to the news history file.
10808
10809 @item nnspool-active-times-file
10810 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
10811 The path to the active date file.
10812
10813 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
10814 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
10815 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @sc{nov} files
10816 that it finds.
10817
10818 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10819 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10820 @cindex sed
10821 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
10822 relevant portion from the overview file. If nil, @code{nnspool} will
10823 load the entire file into a buffer and process it there.
10824
10825 @end table
10826
10827
10828 @node Getting Mail
10829 @section Getting Mail
10830 @cindex reading mail
10831 @cindex mail
10832
10833 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
10834 course.
10835
10836 @menu
10837 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
10838 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
10839 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
10840 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
10841 * Mail Backend Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
10842 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
10843 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
10844 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
10845 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
10846 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
10847 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
10848 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail backends for reading other files.
10849 * Choosing a Mail Backend:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
10850 @end menu
10851
10852
10853 @node Mail in a Newsreader
10854 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
10855
10856 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
10857 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
10858 of a culture shock.
10859
10860 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
10861 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
10862
10863 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
10864 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
10865 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
10866 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
10867
10868 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
10869
10870 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
10871 deleted? How awful!
10872
10873 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
10874 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
10875 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
10876 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @pxref{Expiring
10877 Mail}.
10878
10879 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
10880 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
10881 they want to treat a message.
10882
10883 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
10884 via SMTP, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
10885 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
10886 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
10887 archived somewhere else.
10888
10889 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
10890 These are transported via @sc{nntp}, and are therefore news. But we may need
10891 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
10892 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
10893 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
10894
10895 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
10896 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
10897 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
10898
10899 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
10900 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
10901 differently.
10902
10903 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
10904 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
10905 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
10906 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
10907 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
10908
10909 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
10910 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
10911 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
10912 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
10913 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
10914 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
10915 You Do.)
10916
10917
10918 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
10919 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
10920
10921 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
10922 mail backend of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
10923 and things will happen automatically.
10924
10925 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a "one file per
10926 mail" backend), you could put the following in your @file{.gnus} file:
10927
10928 @lisp
10929 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
10930 '((nnml "private")))
10931 @end lisp
10932
10933 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this backend will be queried for new
10934 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
10935 directory, which is @code{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
10936 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
10937 like any other group.
10938
10939 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
10940
10941 @lisp
10942 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10943 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
10944 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
10945 ("other" "")))
10946 @end lisp
10947
10948 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
10949 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
10950 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
10951 last group.
10952
10953 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
10954 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
10955 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Backend} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
10956
10957
10958 @node Splitting Mail
10959 @subsection Splitting Mail
10960 @cindex splitting mail
10961 @cindex mail splitting
10962
10963 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
10964 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
10965 to be split into groups.
10966
10967 @lisp
10968 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10969 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
10970 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
10971 ("mail.other" "")))
10972 @end lisp
10973
10974 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
10975 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
10976 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
10977 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
10978 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
10979 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
10980 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
10981
10982 @lisp
10983 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
10984 @end lisp
10985
10986 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
10987 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
10988 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
10989 mail belongs in that group.
10990
10991 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
10992 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{} so that it matches any mails
10993 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
10994 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
10995 rule to make a match will "win", unless you have crossposting enabled.
10996 In that case, all matching rules will "win".)
10997
10998 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
10999 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
11000 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
11001 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
11002 thinks should carry this mail message.
11003
11004 Note that the mail backends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
11005 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
11006 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
11007 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
11008
11009 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
11010 The mail backends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
11011 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
11012 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
11013 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{}) group.
11014
11015 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
11016 @cindex crosspost
11017 @cindex links
11018 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
11019 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
11020 links. If that's the case for you, set
11021 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
11022 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
11023
11024 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
11025 @kindex nnmail-split-history
11026 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
11027 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
11028 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
11029 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
11030 Group Commands}).
11031
11032 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
11033 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
11034 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
11035 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
11036 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
11037 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
11038 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
11039 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
11040 month's rent money.
11041
11042
11043 @node Mail Sources
11044 @subsection Mail Sources
11045
11046 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from a
11047 POP mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a maildir, for
11048 instance.
11049
11050 @menu
11051 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
11052 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
11053 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
11054 @end menu
11055
11056
11057 @node Mail Source Specifiers
11058 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
11059 @cindex POP
11060 @cindex mail server
11061 @cindex procmail
11062 @cindex mail spool
11063 @cindex mail source
11064
11065 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
11066 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
11067
11068 Here's an example:
11069
11070 @lisp
11071 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
11072 @end lisp
11073
11074 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
11075 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
11076 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
11077 default values.
11078
11079 The following mail source types are available:
11080
11081 @table @code
11082 @item file
11083 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
11084
11085 Keywords:
11086
11087 @table @code
11088 @item :path
11089 The path of the file. Defaults to the value of the @code{MAIL}
11090 environment variable or @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}.
11091 @end table
11092
11093 An example file mail source:
11094
11095 @lisp
11096 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
11097 @end lisp
11098
11099 Or using the default path:
11100
11101 @lisp
11102 (file)
11103 @end lisp
11104
11105 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best to
11106 use POP or @sc{imap} or the like to fetch the mail. You can not use ange-ftp
11107 file names here---it has no way to lock the mail spool while moving the
11108 mail.
11109
11110 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
11111
11112 @lisp
11113 (setq mail-sources
11114 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
11115 @end lisp
11116
11117 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
11118
11119 @example
11120 #!/bin/sh
11121 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
11122 # flu@@iki.fi
11123
11124 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
11125 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
11126 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
11127 @end example
11128
11129 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
11130
11131
11132 @item directory
11133 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used when
11134 you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files. Setting
11135 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-nil force Gnus to
11136 scan the mail source only once.
11137
11138 Keywords:
11139
11140 @table @code
11141 @item :path
11142 The path of the directory where the files are. There is no default
11143 value.
11144
11145 @item :suffix
11146 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
11147 @samp{.spool}.
11148
11149 @item :predicate
11150 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
11151 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
11152 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
11153 predicate are considered.
11154
11155 @item :prescript
11156 @itemx :postscript
11157 Script run before/after fetching mail.
11158
11159 @end table
11160
11161 An example directory mail source:
11162
11163 @lisp
11164 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
11165 :suffix ".prcml")
11166 @end lisp
11167
11168 @item pop
11169 Get mail from a POP server.
11170
11171 Keywords:
11172
11173 @table @code
11174 @item :server
11175 The name of the POP server. The default is taken from the
11176 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11177
11178 @item :port
11179 The port number of the POP server. This can be a number (e.g.@:
11180 @samp{:port 110}) or a string (e.g.@: @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
11181 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
11182 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
11183 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
11184
11185 @item :user
11186 The user name to give to the POP server. The default is the login
11187 name.
11188
11189 @item :password
11190 The password to give to the POP server. If not specified, the user is
11191 prompted.
11192
11193 @item :program
11194 The program to use to fetch mail from the POP server. This is should be
11195 a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
11196
11197 @example
11198 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
11199 @end example
11200
11201 The valid format specifier characters are:
11202
11203 @table @samp
11204 @item t
11205 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
11206 included in this string.
11207
11208 @item s
11209 The name of the server.
11210
11211 @item P
11212 The port number of the server.
11213
11214 @item u
11215 The user name to use.
11216
11217 @item p
11218 The password to use.
11219 @end table
11220
11221 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
11222 corresponding keywords.
11223
11224 @item :prescript
11225 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11226 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11227
11228 @item :postscript
11229 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11230 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11231
11232 @item :function
11233 The function to use to fetch mail from the POP server. The function is
11234 called with one parameter---the name of the file where the mail should
11235 be moved to.
11236
11237 @item :authentication
11238 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
11239 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
11240 @code{password}.
11241
11242 @end table
11243
11244 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
11245 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
11246
11247 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default POP server, using the
11248 default user name, and default fetcher:
11249
11250 @lisp
11251 (pop)
11252 @end lisp
11253
11254 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
11255
11256 @lisp
11257 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
11258 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
11259 @end lisp
11260
11261 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
11262
11263 @lisp
11264 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
11265 @end lisp
11266
11267 @item maildir
11268 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
11269 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
11270 contains exactly one mail.
11271
11272 Keywords:
11273
11274 @table @code
11275 @item :path
11276 The path of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
11277 taken from the @code{MAILDIR} environment variable or
11278 @samp{~/Maildir/}.
11279 @item :subdirs
11280 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
11281 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
11282
11283 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
11284 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
11285 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
11286 @c below.
11287
11288 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
11289 from locking problems).
11290
11291 @end table
11292
11293 Two example maildir mail sources:
11294
11295 @lisp
11296 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/" :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
11297 @end lisp
11298
11299 @lisp
11300 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/" :subdirs ("new"))
11301 @end lisp
11302
11303 @item imap
11304 Get mail from a @sc{imap} server. If you don't want to use @sc{imap} as
11305 intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie with nnimap), for some
11306 reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar to a POP server and
11307 fetches articles from a given @sc{imap} mailbox.
11308
11309 Keywords:
11310
11311 @table @code
11312 @item :server
11313 The name of the @sc{imap} server. The default is taken from the
11314 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11315
11316 @item :port
11317 The port number of the @sc{imap} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
11318 @samp{993} for SSL connections.
11319
11320 @item :user
11321 The user name to give to the @sc{imap} server. The default is the login
11322 name.
11323
11324 @item :password
11325 The password to give to the @sc{imap} server. If not specified, the user is
11326 prompted.
11327
11328 @item :stream
11329 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
11330 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
11331 @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{ssl} or the default @samp{network}.
11332
11333 @item :authentication
11334 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is one
11335 of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now, this
11336 means @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default
11337 @samp{login}.
11338
11339 @item :mailbox
11340 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
11341 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
11342
11343 @item :predicate
11344 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
11345 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
11346 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @sc{imap} client and mark some
11347 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{nil}.
11348 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
11349 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 §6.4.4.
11350
11351 @item :fetchflag
11352 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
11353 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
11354 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
11355 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 §2.3.2.
11356
11357 @item :dontexpunge
11358 If non-nil, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the mailbox
11359 after finishing the fetch.
11360
11361 @end table
11362
11363 An example @sc{imap} mail source:
11364
11365 @lisp
11366 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com" :stream kerberos4 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
11367 @end lisp
11368
11369 @item webmail
11370 Get mail from a webmail server, such as www.hotmail.com,
11371 webmail.netscape.com, www.netaddress.com, www.my-deja.com.
11372
11373 NOTE: Now mail.yahoo.com provides POP3 service, so @sc{pop} mail source
11374 is suggested.
11375
11376 NOTE: Webmail largely depends cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
11377 required for url "4.0pre.46".
11378
11379 WARNING: Mails may lost. NO WARRANTY.
11380
11381 Keywords:
11382
11383 @table @code
11384 @item :subtype
11385 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
11386 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
11387
11388 @item :user
11389 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
11390 name.
11391
11392 @item :password
11393 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
11394 prompted.
11395
11396 @item :dontexpunge
11397 If non-nil, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to trash
11398 folder after finishing the fetch.
11399
11400 @end table
11401
11402 An example webmail source:
11403
11404 @lisp
11405 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail :user "user-name" :password "secret")
11406 @end lisp
11407 @end table
11408
11409 @table @dfn
11410 @item Common Keywords
11411 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
11412
11413 Keywords:
11414
11415 @table @code
11416 @item :plugged
11417 If non-nil, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you use
11418 directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this example:
11419
11420 @lisp
11421 (setq mail-sources
11422 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
11423 :suffix ""
11424 :plugged t)))
11425 @end lisp
11426
11427 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
11428 useful when you use local mail and news.
11429
11430 @end table
11431 @end table
11432
11433 @subsubheading Function Interface
11434
11435 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
11436 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
11437 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
11438 consider the following mail-source setting:
11439
11440 @lisp
11441 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
11442 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
11443 @end lisp
11444
11445 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
11446 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
11447 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
11448 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
11449 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
11450
11451 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
11452
11453
11454 @node Mail Source Customization
11455 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
11456
11457 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
11458 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
11459 variables.
11460
11461 @table @code
11462 @item mail-source-crash-box
11463 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
11464 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is
11465 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
11466
11467 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
11468 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
11469 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them.
11470
11471 @item mail-source-directory
11472 @vindex mail-source-directory
11473 Directory where files (if any) will be stored. The default is
11474 @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for is to say
11475 where the incoming files will be stored if the previous variable is
11476 @code{nil}.
11477
11478 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11479 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11480 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
11481 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
11482 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
11483 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
11484
11485 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
11486 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
11487 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
11488
11489 @end table
11490
11491
11492 @node Fetching Mail
11493 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
11494
11495 @vindex mail-sources
11496 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
11497 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
11498 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
11499 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
11500
11501 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
11502 @code{nil}, the mail backends will never attempt to fetch mail by
11503 themselves.
11504
11505 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a POP
11506 mail server, you'd say something like:
11507
11508 @lisp
11509 (setq mail-sources
11510 '((file)
11511 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11512 :password "secret")))
11513 @end lisp
11514
11515 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
11516
11517 @lisp
11518 (setq mail-sources
11519 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
11520 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11521 :user "user-name"
11522 :port "pop3"
11523 :password "secret")))
11524 @end lisp
11525
11526
11527 When you use a mail backend, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
11528 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
11529 mail if you're not using a mail backend---you have to do a lot of magic
11530 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
11531 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
11532 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
11533
11534
11535
11536 @node Mail Backend Variables
11537 @subsection Mail Backend Variables
11538
11539 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
11540 mail backends.
11541
11542 @table @code
11543 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11544 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11545 The mail backends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
11546 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
11547
11548 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
11549 @item nnmail-split-hook
11550 @findex article-decode-encoded-words
11551 @findex RFC 1522 decoding
11552 @findex RFC 2047 decoding
11553 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
11554 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
11555 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
11556 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
11557 in the buffer will show up in any files.
11558 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
11559 to this hook.
11560
11561 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11562 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11563 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11564 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11565 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
11566 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
11567 starting to handle the new mail) and
11568 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
11569 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
11570 default file modes the new mail files get:
11571
11572 @lisp
11573 (add-hook 'gnus-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11574 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
11575
11576 (add-hook 'gnus-post-get-new-mail-hook
11577 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
11578 @end lisp
11579
11580 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
11581 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
11582 If non-@code{nil}, the mail backends will use long file and directory
11583 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
11584 (assuming use of @code{nnml} backend) or files (assuming use of
11585 @code{nnfolder} backend) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
11586 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
11587
11588 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
11589 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
11590 @findex delete-file
11591 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
11592
11593 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11594 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11595 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
11596 the backend (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
11597 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
11598
11599 @end table
11600
11601
11602 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
11603 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
11604 @cindex mail splitting
11605 @cindex fancy mail splitting
11606
11607 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
11608 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
11609 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
11610 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
11611 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
11612 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
11613
11614 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
11615
11616 @lisp
11617 ;; Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of
11618 ;; the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group
11619 ;; from real errors.
11620 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
11621 "mail.misc"))
11622 ;; Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant
11623 ;; groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the
11624 ;; (ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.
11625 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
11626 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
11627 ;; Other mailing lists...
11628 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
11629 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
11630 ;; Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent
11631 ;; cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to
11632 ;; the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the
11633 ;; message was really cross-posted.
11634 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
11635 (any "mypackage@@somewhere\" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
11636 ;; People...
11637 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
11638 ;; Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.
11639 "misc.misc")
11640 @end lisp
11641
11642 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a (possibly)
11643 recursive structure where each split may contain other splits. Here are
11644 the five possible split syntaxes:
11645
11646 @enumerate
11647
11648 @item
11649 @samp{group}: If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group
11650 name. Normal regexp match expansion will be done. See below for
11651 examples.
11652
11653 @item
11654 @code{(@var{field} @var{value} @code{[-} @var{restrict}
11655 @code{[@dots{}]}@code{]} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, the
11656 first element of which is a string, then store the message as
11657 specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field} (a regexp) contains
11658 @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp)
11659 matches some string after @var{field} and before the end of the
11660 matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If none of the
11661 @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
11662
11663 @item
11664 @code{(| @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11665 element is @code{|} (vertical bar), then process each @var{split} until
11666 one of them matches. A @var{split} is said to match if it will cause
11667 the mail message to be stored in one or more groups.
11668
11669 @item
11670 @code{(& @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11671 element is @code{&}, then process all @var{split}s in the list.
11672
11673 @item
11674 @code{junk}: If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save
11675 this message. Use with extreme caution.
11676
11677 @item
11678 @code{(: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})}: If the split is
11679 a list, and the first element is @code{:}, then the second element will
11680 be called as a function with @var{args} given as arguments. The
11681 function should return a @var{split}.
11682
11683 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
11684 body of the messages:
11685
11686 @lisp
11687 (defun split-on-body ()
11688 (save-excursion
11689 (set-buffer " *nnmail incoming*")
11690 (goto-char (point-min))
11691 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
11692 "string.group")))
11693 @end lisp
11694
11695 @item
11696 @code{(! @var{func} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11697 element is @code{!}, then SPLIT will be processed, and FUNC will be
11698 called as a function with the result of SPLIT as argument. FUNC should
11699 return a split.
11700
11701 @item
11702 @code{nil}: If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
11703
11704 @end enumerate
11705
11706 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
11707 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
11708 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
11709 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
11710 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
11711
11712 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
11713 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be lisp symbols, in that case they
11714 are expanded as specified by the variable
11715 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells, where
11716 the @code{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @code{cdr} contains the associated
11717 value.
11718
11719 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
11720 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
11721 when all this splitting is performed.
11722
11723 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
11724 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
11725 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
11726
11727 @example
11728 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
11729 @end example
11730
11731 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
11732 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
11733
11734 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
11735 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
11736 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
11737 groupings 1 through 9.
11738
11739 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
11740 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
11741 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
11742 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
11743 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
11744 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
11745 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
11746 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
11747 it once per thread.
11748
11749 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to a
11750 non-nil value. And then you can include
11751 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} using the colon feature, like so:
11752 @lisp
11753 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
11754 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
11755 ;; other splits go here
11756 ))
11757 @end lisp
11758
11759 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
11760 non-nil, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees in the
11761 file specified by the variable @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file},
11762 together with the group it is in (the group is omitted for non-mail
11763 messages). When mail splitting is invoked, the function
11764 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks at the References (and
11765 In-Reply-To) header of each message to split and searches the file
11766 specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file} for the message ids.
11767 When it has found a parent, it returns the corresponding group name. It
11768 is recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
11769 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
11770 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some 300
11771 kBytes in size.)
11772 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11773 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
11774 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
11775 messages goes into the new group.
11776
11777
11778 @node Group Mail Splitting
11779 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
11780 @cindex mail splitting
11781 @cindex group mail splitting
11782
11783 @findex gnus-group-split
11784 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
11785 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
11786 You just have to set @var{to-list} and/or @var{to-address} in group
11787 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
11788 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
11789 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
11790 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @var{to-list} or
11791 @var{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
11792
11793 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
11794 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @var{extra-aliases} group
11795 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
11796 rather use a regular expression, set @var{split-regexp}.
11797
11798 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
11799 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
11800 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
11801 @var{to-list}, @var{to-address}, all of @var{extra-aliases} and all
11802 matches of @var{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
11803 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
11804 @var{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
11805
11806 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
11807 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
11808 parameter @var{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
11809 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
11810 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @var{split-spec} may be set to
11811 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
11812 @code{gnus-group-split}.
11813
11814 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
11815 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
11816 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
11817 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
11818 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
11819 some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
11820 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
11821 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
11822 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
11823 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
11824 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
11825 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
11826 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
11827
11828 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
11829 been defined:
11830
11831 @example
11832 nnml:mail.bar:
11833 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
11834 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
11835 nnml:mail.foo:
11836 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
11837 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
11838 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
11839 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
11840 nnml:mail.others:
11841 ((split-spec . catch-all))
11842 @end example
11843
11844 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
11845 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
11846 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
11847
11848 @lisp
11849 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
11850 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
11851 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
11852 "mail.others")
11853 @end lisp
11854
11855 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
11856 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
11857 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
11858 splits like this:
11859
11860 @lisp
11861 (: gnus-mlsplt-fancy GROUPS NO-CROSSPOST CATCH-ALL)
11862 @end lisp
11863
11864 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
11865 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
11866 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
11867 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fallback
11868 fancy split, used like @var{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
11869 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @var{split-regexp} matches the
11870 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
11871 Otherwise, if some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
11872 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
11873
11874 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
11875 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
11876 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
11877 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
11878 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
11879 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
11880 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
11881 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
11882 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
11883
11884 @findex gnus-group-split-update
11885 However, if you change group parameters, you have to update
11886 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
11887 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
11888 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
11889 you. For example, add to your @file{.gnus}:
11890
11891 @lisp
11892 (gnus-group-split-setup AUTO-UPDATE CATCH-ALL)
11893 @end lisp
11894
11895 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
11896 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
11897 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
11898 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
11899 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
11900 value.
11901
11902 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
11903 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
11904 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
11905 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
11906
11907 @node Incorporating Old Mail
11908 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
11909
11910 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
11911 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
11912 backends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
11913 your mail groups.
11914
11915 Doing so can be quite easy.
11916
11917 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
11918 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
11919 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
11920 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
11921 your @code{nnml} groups.
11922
11923 Here's how:
11924
11925 @enumerate
11926 @item
11927 Go to the group buffer.
11928
11929 @item
11930 Type `G f' and give the path to the mbox file when prompted to create an
11931 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
11932
11933 @item
11934 Type `SPACE' to enter the newly created group.
11935
11936 @item
11937 Type `M P b' to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
11938 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
11939
11940 @item
11941 Type `B r' to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
11942 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
11943 @end enumerate
11944
11945 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
11946 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
11947 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
11948 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
11949 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
11950
11951 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
11952 backend to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
11953 using the new mail backend.
11954
11955
11956 @node Expiring Mail
11957 @subsection Expiring Mail
11958 @cindex article expiry
11959
11960 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
11961 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
11962 different approach to mail reading.
11963
11964 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
11965 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
11966 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
11967 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
11968 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
11969 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
11970 course.
11971
11972 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
11973 articles as @dfn{expirable}. This does not mean that the articles will
11974 disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
11975 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
11976 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
11977 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
11978 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
11979 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
11980
11981 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
11982 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Groups that
11983 match the regular expression @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will
11984 have all articles that you read marked as expirable automatically. All
11985 articles marked as expirable have an @samp{E} in the first
11986 column in the summary buffer.
11987
11988 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
11989 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
11990 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
11991 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
11992 @file{.gnus} file:
11993
11994 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
11995 @lisp
11996 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
11997 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
11998 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
11999 @end lisp
12000
12001 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
12002 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
12003 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
12004 groups expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
12005 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
12006
12007 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
12008 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
12009
12010 @lisp
12011 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
12012 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
12013 @end lisp
12014
12015 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
12016 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
12017
12018 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
12019 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
12020 don't really mix very well.
12021
12022 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
12023 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
12024 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
12025 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
12026 days.
12027
12028 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
12029 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
12030 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
12031 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
12032 everywhere else:
12033
12034 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12035 @lisp
12036 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12037 (lambda (group)
12038 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
12039 31)
12040 ((string= group "mail.junk")
12041 1)
12042 ((string= group "important")
12043 'never)
12044 (t
12045 6))))
12046 @end lisp
12047
12048 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
12049 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
12050
12051 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
12052 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
12053 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
12054 @code{never}.
12055
12056 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
12057 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
12058
12059 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
12060 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
12061 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them to
12062 other groups instead of deleting them. The variable @code{nnmail-expiry-target}
12063 (and the @code{expiry-target} group parameter) controls this. The
12064 variable supplies a default value for all groups, which can be
12065 overridden for specific groups by the group parameter.
12066 default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a string (which
12067 should be the name of the group the message should be moved to), or a
12068 function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to the message in
12069 question, and with the name of the group being moved from as its
12070 parameter) which should return a target -- either a group name or
12071 @code{delete}.
12072
12073 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
12074 @lisp
12075 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
12076 @end lisp
12077
12078
12079 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
12080 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
12081 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
12082 easier for procmail users.
12083
12084 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
12085 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
12086 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
12087 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
12088 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
12089 caution. Even more dangerous is the
12090 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
12091 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
12092 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
12093 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
12094 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
12095 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
12096 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
12097 with! So there!
12098
12099 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
12100
12101 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
12102 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
12103 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
12104 auto-expire turned on.
12105
12106
12107 @node Washing Mail
12108 @subsection Washing Mail
12109 @cindex mail washing
12110 @cindex list server brain damage
12111 @cindex incoming mail treatment
12112
12113 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
12114 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
12115 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
12116 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
12117 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
12118 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
12119
12120 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
12121 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
12122 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
12123 laugh.
12124
12125 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
12126 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
12127 storing the mail to disc. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
12128 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
12129
12130 @table @code
12131 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12132 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12133 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
12134 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
12135 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
12136
12137 @table @code
12138 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12139 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12140 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
12141 Emacs running on MS machines.
12142
12143 @end table
12144
12145 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12146 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12147 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
12148 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
12149
12150 @table @code
12151 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12152 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12153 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
12154 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
12155
12156 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12157 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12158 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
12159 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
12160 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
12161 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
12162 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
12163 @code{\\(..\\)}.
12164
12165 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
12166 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
12167
12168 @lisp
12169 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
12170 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
12171 @end lisp
12172
12173 This can also be done non-destructively with
12174 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
12175
12176 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
12177 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
12178 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
12179
12180 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12181 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12182 @cindex Eudora
12183 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
12184 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
12185 @code{References} headers.
12186
12187 @end table
12188
12189 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12190 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12191 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
12192 include:
12193
12194 @table @code
12195 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
12196 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
12197 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
12198
12199 @end table
12200 @end table
12201
12202
12203 @node Duplicates
12204 @subsection Duplicates
12205
12206 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
12207 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
12208 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
12209 @cindex duplicate mails
12210 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
12211 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
12212 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
12213 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
12214 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
12215 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
12216 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
12217 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
12218 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
12219 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
12220 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
12221 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
12222 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
12223
12224 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
12225 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
12226 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
12227 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
12228
12229 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
12230 @code{nil}.
12231
12232 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
12233 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
12234 methods:
12235
12236 @lisp
12237 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
12238 '(| ;; Messages duplicates go to a separate group.
12239 ("gnus-warning" "duplication of message" "duplicate")
12240 ;; Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.
12241 (any mail "mail.misc")
12242 ;; Other rules.
12243 [ ... ] ))
12244 @end lisp
12245
12246 Or something like:
12247 @lisp
12248 (setq nnmail-split-methods
12249 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:")
12250 ;; Other rules.
12251 [...]))
12252 @end lisp
12253
12254 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
12255 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
12256 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
12257 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
12258 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
12259
12260
12261 @node Not Reading Mail
12262 @subsection Not Reading Mail
12263
12264 If you start using any of the mail backends, they have the annoying
12265 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
12266 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
12267
12268 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
12269 @code{nil}, none of the backends will ever attempt to read incoming
12270 mail, which should help.
12271
12272 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12273 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12274 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12275 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12276 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12277 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
12278 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old @sc{rmail}
12279 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All backends have
12280 variables called backend-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
12281 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
12282 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
12283
12284 All the mail backends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
12285 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
12286 incoming mail.
12287
12288
12289 @node Choosing a Mail Backend
12290 @subsection Choosing a Mail Backend
12291
12292 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
12293 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
12294 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
12295
12296 There are five different mail backends in the standard Gnus, and more
12297 backends are available separately. The mail backend most people use
12298 (because it is the fastest and most flexible) is @code{nnml}
12299 (@pxref{Mail Spool}).
12300
12301 @menu
12302 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
12303 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
12304 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
12305 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like backend.
12306 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
12307 * Comparing Mail Backends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
12308 @end menu
12309
12310
12311 @node Unix Mail Box
12312 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
12313 @cindex nnmbox
12314 @cindex unix mail box
12315
12316 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12317 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12318 The @dfn{nnmbox} backend will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
12319 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
12320 which group it belongs in.
12321
12322 Virtual server settings:
12323
12324 @table @code
12325 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
12326 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12327 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory.
12328
12329 @item nnmbox-active-file
12330 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12331 The name of the active file for the mail box.
12332
12333 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
12334 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12335 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
12336 into groups.
12337 @end table
12338
12339
12340 @node Rmail Babyl
12341 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
12342 @cindex nnbabyl
12343 @cindex rmail mbox
12344
12345 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12346 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12347 The @dfn{nnbabyl} backend will use a babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{rmail
12348 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
12349 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
12350
12351 Virtual server settings:
12352
12353 @table @code
12354 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
12355 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12356 The name of the rmail mbox file.
12357
12358 @item nnbabyl-active-file
12359 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12360 The name of the active file for the rmail box.
12361
12362 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12363 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12364 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail.
12365 @end table
12366
12367
12368 @node Mail Spool
12369 @subsubsection Mail Spool
12370 @cindex nnml
12371 @cindex mail @sc{nov} spool
12372
12373 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
12374 format. It should be used with some caution.
12375
12376 @vindex nnml-directory
12377 If you use this backend, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
12378 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
12379 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
12380 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
12381
12382 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
12383 care of all that.
12384
12385 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
12386 in your account, you should not use this backend. As each mail gets its
12387 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
12388 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
12389 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
12390 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
12391 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
12392 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
12393
12394 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest backend when it comes to article
12395 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
12396 @sc{nov} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it the fastest
12397 backend when it comes to reading mail.
12398
12399 Virtual server settings:
12400
12401 @table @code
12402 @item nnml-directory
12403 @vindex nnml-directory
12404 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory.
12405
12406 @item nnml-active-file
12407 @vindex nnml-active-file
12408 The active file for the @code{nnml} server.
12409
12410 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
12411 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
12412 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
12413 Format}.
12414
12415 @item nnml-get-new-mail
12416 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12417 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail.
12418
12419 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
12420 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
12421 If non-@code{nil}, this backend will ignore any @sc{nov} files.
12422
12423 @item nnml-nov-file-name
12424 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
12425 The name of the @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
12426
12427 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12428 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12429 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
12430
12431 @end table
12432
12433 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
12434 If your @code{nnml} groups and @sc{nov} files get totally out of whack,
12435 you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
12436 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
12437 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
12438 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
12439 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
12440 Commands}).
12441
12442
12443 @node MH Spool
12444 @subsubsection MH Spool
12445 @cindex nnmh
12446 @cindex mh-e mail spool
12447
12448 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
12449 @sc{nov} databases and it doesn't keep an active file. This makes
12450 @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower backend than @code{nnml}, but it also
12451 makes it easier to write procmail scripts for.
12452
12453 Virtual server settings:
12454
12455 @table @code
12456 @item nnmh-directory
12457 @vindex nnmh-directory
12458 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory.
12459
12460 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
12461 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12462 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail.
12463
12464 @item nnmh-be-safe
12465 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
12466 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
12467 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks they
12468 are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
12469 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
12470 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not have
12471 to set this variable to @code{t}.
12472 @end table
12473
12474
12475 @node Mail Folders
12476 @subsubsection Mail Folders
12477 @cindex nnfolder
12478 @cindex mbox folders
12479 @cindex mail folders
12480
12481 @code{nnfolder} is a backend for storing each mail group in a separate
12482 file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format. @code{nnfolder}
12483 will add extra headers to keep track of article numbers and arrival
12484 dates.
12485
12486 Virtual server settings:
12487
12488 @table @code
12489 @item nnfolder-directory
12490 @vindex nnfolder-directory
12491 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this directory.
12492
12493 @item nnfolder-active-file
12494 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
12495 The name of the active file.
12496
12497 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12498 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12499 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File Format}.
12500
12501 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
12502 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12503 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail.
12504
12505 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12506 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12507 @cindex backup files
12508 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
12509 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If you
12510 wish to switch this off, you could say something like the following in
12511 your @file{.emacs} file:
12512
12513 @lisp
12514 (defun turn-off-backup ()
12515 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
12516
12517 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
12518 @end lisp
12519
12520 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12521 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12522 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
12523 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
12524 extract some information from it before removing it.
12525
12526 @end table
12527
12528
12529 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
12530 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
12531 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
12532 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
12533 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
12534 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
12535 though.
12536
12537 @node Comparing Mail Backends
12538 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Backends
12539
12540 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{backend} is the common word for a
12541 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
12542 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
12543 and so selection of a suitable backend is required in order to get that
12544 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
12545
12546 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
12547 typically done by @sc{nntp} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
12548 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
12549 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @sc{nntp} server), and
12550 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
12551 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
12552 @code{nnspool} backends, to select between these methods, if one happens
12553 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
12554 via NFS).
12555
12556 The goal in selecting a mail backend is to pick one which
12557 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
12558 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
12559 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
12560
12561 @table @code
12562 @item nnmbox
12563
12564 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
12565 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
12566 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
12567 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
12568 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
12569 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
12570 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
12571 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
12572 this backend, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
12573 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
12574 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
12575 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
12576 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
12577 what's where.
12578
12579 @item nnbabyl
12580
12581 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
12582 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
12583 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
12584 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
12585 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
12586 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
12587 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
12588 RMAIL was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
12589 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote RMAIL
12590 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
12591 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
12592 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
12593 headers/status bits stuff. RMAIL itself still exists as well, of
12594 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
12595
12596 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
12597 filesystem, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
12598 look at your mail.
12599
12600 @item nnml
12601
12602 @code{nnml} is the backend which smells the most as though you were
12603 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
12604 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
12605 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
12606 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
12607 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
12608 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
12609 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
12610 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
12611 @sc{nntp} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
12612 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
12613 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
12614 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
12615 provided by the active file and overviews.
12616
12617 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
12618 resource which defines available places in the filesystem to put new
12619 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
12620 tight, shared filesystems. But if you live on a personal machine where
12621 the filesystem is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
12622 wins big.
12623
12624 It is also problematic using this backend if you are living in a
12625 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
12626 tiny files.
12627
12628 @item nnmh
12629
12630 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
12631 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
12632 individual files, but with little or no indexing support -- @code{nnmh}
12633 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
12634 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
12635 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
12636 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
12637
12638 @item nnfolder
12639
12640 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
12641 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
12642 itself puts *all* one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
12643 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
12644 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
12645 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
12646 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
12647 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
12648 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
12649
12650 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
12651 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
12652 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
12653 friendly mail backend all over.
12654
12655 @end table
12656
12657
12658 @node Browsing the Web
12659 @section Browsing the Web
12660 @cindex web
12661 @cindex browsing the web
12662 @cindex www
12663 @cindex http
12664
12665 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
12666 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
12667 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
12668 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
12669 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
12670 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
12671 even know what a news group is.
12672
12673 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
12674 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
12675 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
12676 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
12677 you mad in the end.
12678
12679 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
12680 to do it instead?
12681
12682 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of backends for providing
12683 interfaces to these sources.
12684
12685 @menu
12686 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
12687 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
12688 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
12689 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
12690 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
12691 @end menu
12692
12693 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
12694
12695 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
12696 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @sc{html} data
12697 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus backend
12698 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these backends,
12699 though, you should be ok.
12700
12701 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
12702 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
12703 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
12704 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
12705 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
12706
12707
12708 @node Web Searches
12709 @subsection Web Searches
12710 @cindex nnweb
12711 @cindex DejaNews
12712 @cindex Alta Vista
12713 @cindex InReference
12714 @cindex Usenet searches
12715 @cindex searching the Usenet
12716
12717 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
12718 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
12719 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
12720 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
12721 searches without having to use a browser.
12722
12723 The @code{nnweb} backend allows an easy interface to the mighty search
12724 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
12725 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
12726 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
12727 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
12728
12729 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
12730 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
12731 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
12732 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
12733 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
12734 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
12735 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
12736 engines (DejaNews, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
12737 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
12738 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
12739 group as read.
12740
12741 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
12742 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
12743 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
12744 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
12745 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
12746 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
12747
12748 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
12749 to use @code{nnweb}.
12750
12751 Virtual server variables:
12752
12753 @table @code
12754 @item nnweb-type
12755 @vindex nnweb-type
12756 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
12757 are @code{dejanews}, @code{dejanewsold}, @code{altavista} and
12758 @code{reference}.
12759
12760 @item nnweb-search
12761 @vindex nnweb-search
12762 The search string to feed to the search engine.
12763
12764 @item nnweb-max-hits
12765 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
12766 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
12767 100.
12768
12769 @item nnweb-type-definition
12770 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
12771 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
12772 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
12773 present:
12774
12775 @table @code
12776 @item article
12777 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
12778 understands.
12779
12780 @item map
12781 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
12782
12783 @item search
12784 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
12785
12786 @item address
12787 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
12788 to.
12789
12790 @item id
12791 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
12792 @end table
12793
12794 @end table
12795
12796
12797 @node Slashdot
12798 @subsection Slashdot
12799 @cindex Slashdot
12800 @cindex nnslashdot
12801
12802 Slashdot (@uref{http://slashdot.org/}) is a popular news site, with
12803 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
12804 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
12805
12806 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
12807 following in your @file{.gnus.el} file:
12808
12809 @lisp
12810 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
12811 '((nnslashdot "")))
12812 @end lisp
12813
12814 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} backend for new comments
12815 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
12816 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
12817 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
12818 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
12819 Methods}).
12820
12821 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
12822 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12823
12824 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
12825 comments), some light @sc{html}izations will be performed. In
12826 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
12827 @code{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @code{br} added to
12828 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @sc{html}
12829 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
12830 @sc{html} forms.
12831
12832 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
12833
12834 @table @code
12835 @item nnslashdot-threaded
12836 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
12837 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
12838 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
12839 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
12840 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
12841 but much, much slower than untreaded.
12842
12843 @item nnslashdot-login-name
12844 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
12845 The login name to use when posting.
12846
12847 @item nnslashdot-password
12848 @vindex nnslashdot-password
12849 The password to use when posting.
12850
12851 @item nnslashdot-directory
12852 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
12853 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default value is
12854 @samp{~/News/slashdot/}.
12855
12856 @item nnslashdot-active-url
12857 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
12858 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the information on
12859 news articles and comments. The default is
12860 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
12861
12862 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
12863 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
12864 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch comments. The
12865 default is
12866 @samp{http://slashdot.org/comments.pl?sid=%s&threshold=%d&commentsort=%d&mode=flat&startat=%d}.
12867
12868 @item nnslashdot-article-url
12869 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
12870 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the news article. The
12871 default is
12872 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
12873
12874 @item nnslashdot-threshold
12875 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
12876 The score threshold. The default is -1.
12877
12878 @item nnslashdot-group-number
12879 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
12880 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
12881 updated. The default is 0.
12882
12883 @end table
12884
12885
12886
12887 @node Ultimate
12888 @subsection Ultimate
12889 @cindex nnultimate
12890 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
12891
12892 The Ultimate Bulletin Board (@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/}) is
12893 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
12894 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
12895 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
12896
12897 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
12898 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
12899 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @sc{url}
12900 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
12901 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
12902 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
12903 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
12904
12905 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
12906
12907 @table @code
12908 @item nnultimate-directory
12909 @vindex nnultimate-directory
12910 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is
12911 @samp{~/News/ultimate/}.
12912 @end table
12913
12914
12915 @node Web Archive
12916 @subsection Web Archive
12917 @cindex nnwarchive
12918 @cindex Web Archive
12919
12920 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
12921 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
12922 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
12923 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
12924 groups updated.
12925
12926 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
12927 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
12928 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET an_egroup RET egroups RET
12929 www.egroups.com RET your@@email.address RET}. (Substitute the
12930 @sc{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
12931 @sc{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
12932 backend by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
12933
12934 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
12935
12936 @table @code
12937 @item nnwarchive-directory
12938 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
12939 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is
12940 @samp{~/News/warchive/}.
12941
12942 @item nnwarchive-login
12943 @vindex nnwarchive-login
12944 The account name on the web server.
12945
12946 @item nnwarchive-passwd
12947 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
12948 The password for your account on the web server.
12949 @end table
12950
12951
12952 @node Customizing w3
12953 @subsection Customizing w3
12954 @cindex w3
12955 @cindex html
12956 @cindex url
12957 @cindex Netscape
12958
12959 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
12960 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
12961 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
12962
12963 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
12964 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
12965 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
12966
12967 @lisp
12968 (eval-after-load "w3"
12969 '(progn
12970 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
12971 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
12972 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
12973 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
12974 (browse-url url)
12975 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
12976 @end lisp
12977
12978 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
12979 @sc{html} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
12980 follow the link.
12981
12982
12983 @node Other Sources
12984 @section Other Sources
12985
12986 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
12987 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
12988 newsgroups.
12989
12990 @menu
12991 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
12992 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
12993 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
12994 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
12995 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
12996 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
12997 @end menu
12998
12999
13000 @node Directory Groups
13001 @subsection Directory Groups
13002 @cindex nndir
13003 @cindex directory groups
13004
13005 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
13006 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
13007 names, of course.
13008
13009 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
13010 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
13011 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
13012 backend to read directories. Big deal.
13013
13014 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
13015 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
13016 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
13017 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
13018 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
13019
13020 @code{nndir} will use @sc{nov} files if they are present.
13021
13022 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' backend---you can't delete or expire
13023 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
13024 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
13025 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
13026
13027
13028 @node Anything Groups
13029 @subsection Anything Groups
13030 @cindex nneething
13031
13032 From the @code{nndir} backend (which reads a single spool-like
13033 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
13034 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
13035 true.
13036
13037 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
13038 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
13039 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
13040 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
13041 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
13042 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
13043 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
13044 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
13045 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
13046 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
13047 elements.
13048
13049 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
13050 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
13051 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
13052 in the article buffer, just as usual.
13053
13054 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
13055 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
13056 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
13057 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
13058
13059 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
13060 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
13061 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
13062 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
13063 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
13064 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
13065 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
13066 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
13067
13068 Some variables:
13069
13070 @table @code
13071 @item nneething-map-file-directory
13072 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
13073 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
13074 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
13075
13076 @item nneething-exclude-files
13077 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
13078 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
13079 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
13080
13081 @item nneething-include-files
13082 @vindex nneething-include-files
13083 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
13084 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
13085
13086 @item nneething-map-file
13087 @vindex nneething-map-file
13088 Name of the map files.
13089 @end table
13090
13091
13092 @node Document Groups
13093 @subsection Document Groups
13094 @cindex nndoc
13095 @cindex documentation group
13096 @cindex help group
13097
13098 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
13099 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
13100
13101 @table @code
13102 @cindex babyl
13103 @cindex rmail mbox
13104
13105 @item babyl
13106 The babyl (rmail) mail box.
13107 @cindex mbox
13108 @cindex Unix mbox
13109
13110 @item mbox
13111 The standard Unix mbox file.
13112
13113 @cindex MMDF mail box
13114 @item mmdf
13115 The MMDF mail box format.
13116
13117 @item news
13118 Several news articles appended into a file.
13119
13120 @item rnews
13121 @cindex rnews batch files
13122 The rnews batch transport format.
13123 @cindex forwarded messages
13124
13125 @item forward
13126 Forwarded articles.
13127
13128 @item nsmail
13129 Netscape mail boxes.
13130
13131 @item mime-parts
13132 MIME multipart messages.
13133
13134 @item standard-digest
13135 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
13136
13137 @item slack-digest
13138 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
13139 @end table
13140
13141 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
13142 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
13143 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
13144 file is.
13145
13146 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
13147 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
13148 group. And that's it.
13149
13150 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
13151 new & spiffy Gnus mail backend, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
13152 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
13153 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
13154 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
13155 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
13156 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
13157 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
13158 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
13159 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
13160
13161 Virtual server variables:
13162
13163 @table @code
13164 @item nndoc-article-type
13165 @vindex nndoc-article-type
13166 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
13167 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
13168 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
13169 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail} or @code{guess}.
13170
13171 @item nndoc-post-type
13172 @vindex nndoc-post-type
13173 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
13174 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
13175 and @code{news}.
13176 @end table
13177
13178 @menu
13179 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
13180 @end menu
13181
13182
13183 @node Document Server Internals
13184 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
13185
13186 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
13187 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
13188 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
13189 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
13190
13191 First, here's an example document type definition:
13192
13193 @example
13194 (mmdf
13195 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
13196 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
13197 @end example
13198
13199 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
13200 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
13201 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
13202 types can be defined with very few settings:
13203
13204 @table @code
13205 @item first-article
13206 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
13207 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
13208 totally ignored.
13209
13210 @item article-begin
13211 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
13212 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
13213
13214 @item head-begin-function
13215 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
13216 the article.
13217
13218 @item nndoc-head-begin
13219 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
13220 article.
13221
13222 @item nndoc-head-end
13223 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
13224 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
13225
13226 @item body-begin-function
13227 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
13228 of the article.
13229
13230 @item body-begin
13231 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
13232 to @samp{^\n}.
13233
13234 @item body-end-function
13235 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
13236 the article.
13237
13238 @item body-end
13239 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
13240
13241 @item file-end
13242 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
13243 regexp will be totally ignored.
13244
13245 @end table
13246
13247 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
13248 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
13249 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
13250 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
13251 something that's palatable for Gnus:
13252
13253 @table @code
13254 @item prepare-body-function
13255 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
13256 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
13257 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
13258
13259 @item article-transform-function
13260 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
13261 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
13262 body of the article.
13263
13264 @item generate-head-function
13265 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
13266 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
13267 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
13268 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
13269
13270 @end table
13271
13272 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
13273 digests:
13274
13275 @example
13276 (standard-digest
13277 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13278 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13279 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
13280 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
13281 (head-end . "^ ?$")
13282 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
13283 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
13284 (subtype digest guess))
13285 @end example
13286
13287 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
13288 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
13289 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
13290 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
13291 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
13292
13293 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
13294 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first is
13295 the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says where in
13296 the document type definition alist to put this definition. The alist is
13297 traversed sequentially, and @code{nndoc-TYPE-type-p} is called for a given type @code{TYPE}. So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document
13298 is of @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
13299 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it is
13300 of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
13301 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number means
13302 low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
13303
13304
13305 @node SOUP
13306 @subsection SOUP
13307 @cindex SOUP
13308 @cindex offline
13309
13310 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
13311 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
13312 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
13313
13314 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
13315 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
13316 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
13317 newsreaders.
13318
13319 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
13320 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
13321 that interested in doing things properly.
13322
13323 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
13324 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
13325 fiddly.
13326
13327 First some terminology:
13328
13329 @table @dfn
13330
13331 @item server
13332 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
13333 get news and/or mail from.
13334
13335 @item home machine
13336 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
13337 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
13338
13339 @item packet
13340 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
13341 of packets:
13342
13343 @table @dfn
13344 @item message packets
13345 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
13346 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
13347 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13348
13349 @item response packets
13350 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
13351 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
13352 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13353
13354 @end table
13355
13356 @end table
13357
13358
13359 @enumerate
13360
13361 @item
13362 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
13363 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
13364 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
13365 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
13366
13367 @item
13368 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
13369
13370 @item
13371 You put the packet in your home directory.
13372
13373 @item
13374 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} backend as
13375 the native or secondary server.
13376
13377 @item
13378 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
13379 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
13380
13381 @item
13382 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
13383 packet.
13384
13385 @item
13386 You transfer this packet to the server.
13387
13388 @item
13389 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
13390
13391 @item
13392 You then repeat until you die.
13393
13394 @end enumerate
13395
13396 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
13397 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
13398
13399 @menu
13400 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
13401 * SOUP Groups:: A backend for reading @sc{soup} packets.
13402 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
13403 @end menu
13404
13405
13406 @node SOUP Commands
13407 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
13408
13409 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
13410
13411 @table @kbd
13412 @item G s b
13413 @kindex G s b (Group)
13414 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
13415 Pack all unread articles in the current group
13416 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
13417 process/prefix convention.
13418
13419 @item G s w
13420 @kindex G s w (Group)
13421 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
13422 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
13423
13424 @item G s s
13425 @kindex G s s (Group)
13426 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
13427 Send all replies from the replies packet
13428 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
13429
13430 @item G s p
13431 @kindex G s p (Group)
13432 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
13433 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
13434
13435 @item G s r
13436 @kindex G s r (Group)
13437 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
13438 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
13439
13440 @item O s
13441 @kindex O s (Summary)
13442 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
13443 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
13444 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
13445 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
13446
13447 @end table
13448
13449
13450 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
13451 thingies:
13452
13453 @table @code
13454
13455 @item gnus-soup-directory
13456 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
13457 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
13458 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
13459
13460 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
13461 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
13462 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
13463 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
13464
13465 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
13466 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
13467 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
13468 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
13469
13470 @item gnus-soup-packer
13471 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
13472 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13473 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
13474
13475 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
13476 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
13477 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13478 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13479
13480 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
13481 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
13482 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
13483
13484 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13485 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13486 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
13487 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
13488
13489 @end table
13490
13491
13492 @node SOUP Groups
13493 @subsubsection @sc{soup} Groups
13494 @cindex nnsoup
13495
13496 @code{nnsoup} is the backend for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
13497 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
13498 you can read them at leisure.
13499
13500 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
13501
13502 @table @code
13503
13504 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
13505 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
13506 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
13507 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
13508
13509 @item nnsoup-directory
13510 @vindex nnsoup-directory
13511 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
13512 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
13513
13514 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
13515 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
13516 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
13517 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/"}.
13518
13519 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
13520 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
13521 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
13522 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
13523 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
13524
13525 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
13526 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
13527 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
13528 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
13529
13530 @item nnsoup-active-file
13531 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
13532 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
13533 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
13534 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
13535 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
13536
13537 @item nnsoup-packer
13538 @vindex nnsoup-packer
13539 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
13540 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
13541
13542 @item nnsoup-unpacker
13543 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
13544 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
13545 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13546
13547 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
13548 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
13549 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
13550 @file{~/}.
13551
13552 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
13553 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
13554 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
13555 @samp{Soupout}.
13556
13557 @item nnsoup-always-save
13558 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
13559 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
13560
13561 @end table
13562
13563
13564 @node SOUP Replies
13565 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
13566
13567 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
13568 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
13569 more for that to happen.
13570
13571 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
13572 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
13573 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
13574 @sc{soup} system.
13575
13576 In specific, this is what it does:
13577
13578 @lisp
13579 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
13580 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
13581 @end lisp
13582
13583 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
13584 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
13585 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
13586
13587
13588 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
13589 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
13590 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
13591 @cindex gateways
13592
13593 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
13594 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
13595 The @code{nngateway} backend provides the interface.
13596
13597 Note that you can't read anything from this backend---it can only be
13598 used to post with.
13599
13600 Server variables:
13601
13602 @table @code
13603 @item nngateway-address
13604 @vindex nngateway-address
13605 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
13606
13607 @item nngateway-header-transformation
13608 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
13609 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
13610 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
13611 transformation should be called, and defaults to
13612 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
13613 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
13614 gateway address.
13615
13616 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
13617 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
13618 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
13619
13620 @example
13621 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
13622 @end example
13623
13624 will get this @code{From} header inserted:
13625
13626 @example
13627 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
13628 @end example
13629
13630 The following pre-defined functions exist:
13631
13632 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13633 @table @code
13634
13635 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13636 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13637 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
13638
13639 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13640
13641 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13642 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13643 @code{nngateway-address}.
13644
13645 Here's an example:
13646
13647 @lisp
13648 (setq gnus-post-method
13649 '(nngateway "mail2news@@replay.com"
13650 (nngateway-header-transformation
13651 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
13652 @end lisp
13653
13654 @end table
13655
13656
13657 @end table
13658
13659 So, to use this, simply say something like:
13660
13661 @lisp
13662 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
13663 @end lisp
13664
13665
13666
13667 @node IMAP
13668 @subsection @sc{imap}
13669 @cindex nnimap
13670 @cindex @sc{imap}
13671
13672 @sc{imap} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or ...),
13673 think of it as a modernized @sc{nntp}. Connecting to a @sc{imap} server
13674 is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just specify the
13675 network address of the server.
13676
13677 A server configuration in @code{~/.gnus} with a few @sc{imap} servers
13678 might look something like this:
13679
13680 @lisp
13681 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
13682 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; no special configuration
13683 ; perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:
13684 (nnimap "dolk"
13685 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13686 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
13687 ; a UW server running on localhost
13688 (nnimap "barbar"
13689 (nnimap-server-port 143)
13690 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13691 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
13692 ; anonymous public cyrus server:
13693 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
13694 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
13695 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
13696 (nnimap-stream network))
13697 ; a ssl server on a non-standard port:
13698 (nnimap "vic20"
13699 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
13700 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
13701 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
13702 @end lisp
13703
13704 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
13705 server:
13706
13707 @table @code
13708
13709 @item nnimap-address
13710 @vindex nnimap-address
13711
13712 The address of the remote @sc{imap} server. Defaults to the virtual
13713 server name if not specified.
13714
13715 @item nnimap-server-port
13716 @vindex nnimap-server-port
13717 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for SSL.
13718
13719 Note that this should be a integer, example server specification:
13720
13721 @lisp
13722 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13723 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
13724 @end lisp
13725
13726 @item nnimap-list-pattern
13727 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
13728 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
13729 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
13730 interested in a few -- some servers export your home directory via
13731 @sc{imap}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
13732 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
13733
13734 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
13735 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
13736 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
13737 mailbox.
13738
13739 Example server specification:
13740
13741 @lisp
13742 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13743 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
13744 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
13745 @end lisp
13746
13747 @item nnimap-stream
13748 @vindex nnimap-stream
13749 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
13750 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
13751 of SSL. (SSL is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can be automatically
13752 detected, but it's not widely deployed yet).
13753
13754 Example server specification:
13755
13756 @lisp
13757 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13758 (nnimap-stream ssl))
13759 @end lisp
13760
13761 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
13762
13763 @itemize @bullet
13764 @item
13765 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5). Require the
13766 @samp{imtest} program.
13767 @item
13768 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with kerberos 4. Require the @samp{imtest} program.
13769 @item
13770 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
13771 SSL). Require the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
13772 @samp{starttls}.
13773 @item
13774 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through SSL. Require OpenSSL (the
13775 program @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
13776 @item
13777 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start IMAP connection.
13778 @item
13779 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
13780 @end itemize
13781
13782 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
13783 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD, nnimap support
13784 both @samp{imtest} version 1.5.x and version 1.6.x. The variable
13785 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
13786 program.
13787
13788 @vindex imap-ssl-program
13789 For SSL connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
13790 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
13791 and nnimap support it too - altough the most recent versions of
13792 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
13793 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
13794 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
13795 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
13796
13797 @vindex imap-shell-program
13798 @vindex imap-shell-host
13799 For IMAP connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
13800 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
13801
13802 @item nnimap-authenticator
13803 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
13804
13805 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
13806 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
13807
13808 Example server specification:
13809
13810 @lisp
13811 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13812 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
13813 @end lisp
13814
13815 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
13816
13817 @itemize @bullet
13818 @item
13819 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Require
13820 external program @code{imtest}.
13821 @item
13822 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos authentication. Require external program
13823 @code{imtest}.
13824 @item
13825 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Require
13826 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
13827 @item
13828 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
13829 @item
13830 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
13831 @item
13832 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as `anonymous', supplying your emailadress as password.
13833 @end itemize
13834
13835 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
13836 @cindex Expunging
13837 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
13838 Unlike Parmenides the @sc{imap} designers has decided that things that
13839 doesn't exist actually does exist. More specifically, @sc{imap} has
13840 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
13841 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
13842 nnimap does when you delete a article in Gnus (with @kbd{G DEL} or
13843 similar).
13844
13845 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
13846 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
13847 running in circles yet?
13848
13849 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
13850 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
13851 variable.
13852
13853 The possible options are:
13854
13855 @table @code
13856
13857 @item always
13858 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as "Deleted" when
13859 closing a mailbox.
13860 @item never
13861 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
13862 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @sc{imap} clients
13863 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
13864 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
13865 @item ask
13866 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
13867 articles or not.
13868
13869 @end table
13870
13871 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
13872 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
13873
13874 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format
13875 is (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See
13876 `nntp-authinfo-file' for exact syntax.
13877
13878 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
13879 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
13880 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
13881 @xref{NNTP}.
13882
13883 @end table
13884
13885 @menu
13886 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
13887 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
13888 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
13889 @end menu
13890
13891
13892
13893 @node Splitting in IMAP
13894 @subsubsection Splitting in @sc{imap}
13895 @cindex splitting imap mail
13896
13897 Splitting is something Gnus users has loved and used for years, and now
13898 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
13899 @sc{imap} server has server side splitting and those that have splitting
13900 seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that @sc{imap}
13901 support for Gnus has to do it's own splitting.
13902
13903 And it does.
13904
13905 Here are the variables of interest:
13906
13907 @table @code
13908
13909 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
13910 @cindex splitting, crosspost
13911 @cindex crosspost
13912 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
13913
13914 If non-nil, do crossposting if several split methods match the mail. If
13915 nil, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule} found will be used.
13916
13917 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
13918
13919 @item nnimap-split-inbox
13920 @cindex splitting, inbox
13921 @cindex inbox
13922 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
13923
13924 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @sc{imap}
13925 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to nil, which means that splitting is
13926 disabled!
13927
13928 @lisp
13929 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
13930 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
13931 @end lisp
13932
13933 No nnmail equivalent.
13934
13935 @item nnimap-split-rule
13936 @cindex Splitting, rules
13937 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
13938
13939 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
13940 this variable.
13941
13942 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
13943 sublist gives the name of the @sc{imap} mailbox to move articles
13944 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
13945 Neither did I, we need examples.
13946
13947 @lisp
13948 (setq nnimap-split-rule
13949 '(("INBOX.nnimap" "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
13950 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
13951 ("INBOX.private" "")))
13952 @end lisp
13953
13954 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
13955 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
13956 into INBOX.spam and everything else in INBOX.private.
13957
13958 The first string may contain `\\1' forms, like the ones used by
13959 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
13960 instance:
13961
13962 @lisp
13963 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
13964 @end lisp
13965
13966 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13967 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
13968 containing the headers of the article. It should return a non-nil value
13969 if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
13970
13971 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
13972 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
13973 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
13974 of your inbox. (This might might affect performance if you keep lots of
13975 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
13976 them every time you fetch new mail.)
13977
13978 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
13979 end. The first rule to make a match will "win", unless you have
13980 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will "win".
13981
13982 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
13983 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group to where
13984 it thinks the article should be split. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
13985
13986 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it need too.
13987
13988 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
13989 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
13990 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
13991
13992 @lisp
13993 (setq nnimap-split-rule
13994 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
13995 ("junk" "From:.*Simon")))
13996 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
13997 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
13998 ("junk" my-junk-func)))))
13999 @end lisp
14000
14001 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
14002 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
14003 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
14004 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
14005 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
14006 group/function elements.
14007
14008 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
14009
14010 @item nnimap-split-predicate
14011 @cindex splitting
14012 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
14013
14014 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
14015 split; it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
14016
14017 This might be useful if you use another @sc{imap} client to read mail in
14018 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
14019 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
14020 @samp{UNDELETED}.
14021
14022 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14023 @cindex splitting, fancy
14024 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
14025 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
14026
14027 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14028 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
14029 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14030
14031 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
14032 nnimap backends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14033 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
14034 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
14035
14036 Example:
14037
14038 @lisp
14039 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
14040 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
14041 @end lisp
14042
14043 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14044
14045 @end table
14046
14047 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
14048 @subsubsection Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14049 @cindex editing imap acls
14050 @cindex Access Control Lists
14051 @cindex Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14052 @kindex G l
14053 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
14054
14055 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @sc{imap} for
14056 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
14057 @sc{imap} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
14058 doesn't.
14059
14060 To edit a ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
14061 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with a ACL
14062 editing window with detailed instructions.
14063
14064 Some possible uses:
14065
14066 @itemize @bullet
14067 @item
14068 Giving "anyone" the "lrs" rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
14069 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
14070 follow the list without subscribing to it.
14071 @item
14072 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
14073 "anyone" posting ("p") capabilities to have "plussing" work (that is,
14074 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @sc{imap} mailbox
14075 INBOX.mailbox).
14076 @end itemize
14077
14078 @node Expunging mailboxes
14079 @subsubsection Expunging mailboxes
14080 @cindex expunging
14081
14082 @cindex Expunge
14083 @cindex Manual expunging
14084 @kindex G x
14085 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
14086
14087 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-close},
14088 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
14089 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
14090
14091 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
14092 delete them.
14093
14094
14095
14096 @node Combined Groups
14097 @section Combined Groups
14098
14099 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
14100 groups.
14101
14102 @menu
14103 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
14104 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
14105 @end menu
14106
14107
14108 @node Virtual Groups
14109 @subsection Virtual Groups
14110 @cindex nnvirtual
14111 @cindex virtual groups
14112 @cindex merging groups
14113
14114 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
14115 other groups.
14116
14117 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
14118 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
14119 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
14120
14121 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
14122 regexp to match component groups.
14123
14124 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
14125 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
14126 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it came.
14127 (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be shown in
14128 the virtual group.)
14129
14130 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
14131 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
14132
14133 @lisp
14134 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
14135 @end lisp
14136
14137 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
14138 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
14139
14140 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
14141 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
14142 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
14143 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
14144
14145 @example
14146 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
14147 @end example
14148
14149 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
14150 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
14151 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
14152
14153 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
14154 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
14155 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
14156 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
14157 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
14158
14159 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
14160 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
14161 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
14162
14163 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
14164 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
14165 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
14166 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
14167 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
14168 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
14169 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
14170 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
14171 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
14172 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
14173 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
14174
14175 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
14176 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
14177 has to ask the backend of the component group the article comes from
14178 whether it is a news or mail backend. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
14179 there is typically no sure way for the component backend to know this,
14180 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
14181 not-news backend. (Just to be on the safe side.)
14182
14183 @kbd{C-c C-t} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
14184 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
14185
14186
14187
14188 @node Kibozed Groups
14189 @subsection Kibozed Groups
14190 @cindex nnkiboze
14191 @cindex kibozing
14192
14193 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by @sc{oed} as ``grepping through (parts of)
14194 the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a backend that will do this for
14195 you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @sc{nntp} server down to a halt
14196 with useless requests! Oh happiness!
14197
14198 @kindex G k (Group)
14199 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
14200 buffer.
14201
14202 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
14203 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
14204 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between @code{nnkiboze}
14205 and @code{nnvirtual} end.
14206
14207 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an @code{nnkiboze} group
14208 must have a score file to say what articles are to be included in
14209 the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
14210
14211 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
14212 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
14213 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
14214 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time. Lots of
14215 time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the headers from
14216 all the articles in all the component groups and run them through the
14217 scoring process to determine if there are any articles in the groups
14218 that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
14219
14220 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
14221 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
14222 @sc{nntp} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
14223 Stranger things have happened.
14224
14225 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
14226 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
14227
14228 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
14229 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
14230 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/} by default. One
14231 contains the @sc{nov} header lines for all the articles in the group,
14232 and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store information
14233 on what groups have been searched through to find component articles.
14234
14235 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
14236 their @sc{nov} lines removed from the @sc{nov} file.
14237
14238
14239 @node Gnus Unplugged
14240 @section Gnus Unplugged
14241 @cindex offline
14242 @cindex unplugged
14243 @cindex Agent
14244 @cindex Gnus Agent
14245 @cindex Gnus Unplugged
14246
14247 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
14248 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
14249 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
14250 read news. Believe it or not.
14251
14252 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
14253 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
14254 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
14255 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
14256 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
14257
14258 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
14259 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
14260 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
14261 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
14262 reading news on a machine.
14263
14264 Using Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple.
14265
14266 @itemize @bullet
14267 @item
14268 First, set up Gnus as you would do if you were running it on a machine
14269 that has full connection to the net. Go ahead. I'll still be waiting
14270 here.
14271
14272 @item
14273 Then, put the following magical incantation at the end of your
14274 @file{.gnus.el} file:
14275
14276 @lisp
14277 (gnus-agentize)
14278 @end lisp
14279 @end itemize
14280
14281 That's it. Gnus is now an ``offline'' newsreader.
14282
14283 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
14284
14285 @menu
14286 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
14287 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
14288 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
14289 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
14290 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
14291 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
14292 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
14293 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
14294 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
14295 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
14296 @end menu
14297
14298
14299 @node Agent Basics
14300 @subsection Agent Basics
14301
14302 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
14303
14304 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
14305 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
14306 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
14307 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
14308
14309 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
14310 connected to the net continuously.
14311
14312 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
14313 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
14314
14315 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
14316
14317 @itemize @bullet
14318
14319 @item
14320 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
14321 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
14322 already fetched while in this mode.
14323
14324 @item
14325 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
14326 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
14327 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
14328 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode, see (@pxref{Mail
14329 Source Specifiers}).
14330
14331 @item
14332 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the news
14333 onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press @kbd{g}
14334 to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J
14335 s} to fetch all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus
14336 know which articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}.)
14337
14338 @item
14339 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
14340 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
14341 then you read the news offline.
14342
14343 @item
14344 And then you go to step 2.
14345 @end itemize
14346
14347 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
14348 the Agent.
14349
14350 @itemize @bullet
14351
14352 @item
14353 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
14354 backend, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
14355 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
14356 @kbd{J a} the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
14357 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}). This will typically be only the
14358 primary select method, which is listed on the bottom in the buffer.
14359
14360 @item
14361 Decide on download policy. @xref{Agent Categories}.
14362
14363 @item
14364 Uhm... that's it.
14365 @end itemize
14366
14367
14368 @node Agent Categories
14369 @subsection Agent Categories
14370
14371 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
14372 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
14373 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
14374 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
14375 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
14376 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
14377 you're interested in the articles anyway.
14378
14379 The main way to control what is to be downloaded is to create a
14380 @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all) groups to this category.
14381 Groups that do not belong in any other category belong to the
14382 @code{default} category. Gnus has its own buffer for creating and
14383 managing categories.
14384
14385 @menu
14386 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
14387 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
14388 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
14389 @end menu
14390
14391
14392 @node Category Syntax
14393 @subsubsection Category Syntax
14394
14395 A category consists of two things.
14396
14397 @enumerate
14398 @item
14399 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
14400 are eligible for downloading; and
14401
14402 @item
14403 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
14404 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
14405 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
14406 @end enumerate
14407
14408 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
14409 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
14410 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
14411 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
14412
14413 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
14414 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
14415 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
14416
14417 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
14418 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
14419 operators sprinkled in between.
14420
14421 Perhaps some examples are in order.
14422
14423 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
14424 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
14425
14426 @lisp
14427 short
14428 @end lisp
14429
14430 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
14431 short (for some value of ``short'').
14432
14433 Here's a more complex predicate:
14434
14435 @lisp
14436 (or high
14437 (and
14438 (not low)
14439 (not long)))
14440 @end lisp
14441
14442 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
14443 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
14444 drift.
14445
14446 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
14447 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
14448 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
14449
14450 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
14451 you want to do, you can write your own.
14452
14453 @table @code
14454 @item short
14455 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
14456 lines; default 100.
14457
14458 @item long
14459 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
14460 lines; default 200.
14461
14462 @item low
14463 True iff the article has a download score less than
14464 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
14465
14466 @item high
14467 True iff the article has a download score greater than
14468 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
14469
14470 @item spam
14471 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
14472 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
14473 checksum and sees whether articles match.
14474
14475 @item true
14476 Always true.
14477
14478 @item false
14479 Always false.
14480 @end table
14481
14482 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
14483 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
14484 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
14485 useful values.
14486
14487 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
14488 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
14489 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
14490 something along the lines of the following:
14491
14492 @lisp
14493 (defun my-article-old-p ()
14494 "Say whether an article is old."
14495 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
14496 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
14497 @end lisp
14498
14499 with the predicate then defined as:
14500
14501 @lisp
14502 (not my-article-old-p)
14503 @end lisp
14504
14505 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
14506 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
14507 wherever. (Note: this would have to be at a point *after*
14508 @code{gnus-agent} has been loaded via @code{(gnus-agentize)})
14509
14510 @lisp
14511 (defvar gnus-category-predicate-alist
14512 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
14513 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
14514 @end lisp
14515
14516 and simply specify your predicate as:
14517
14518 @lisp
14519 (not old)
14520 @end lisp
14521
14522 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
14523 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
14524 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
14525 just don't give a damn.
14526
14527 The above predicates apply to *all* the groups which belong to the
14528 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
14529 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
14530 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in it's group
14531 parameters like so:
14532
14533 @lisp
14534 (agent-predicate . short)
14535 @end lisp
14536
14537 This is the group parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
14538 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
14539 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
14540
14541 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
14542
14543 @lisp
14544 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
14545 @end lisp
14546
14547 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
14548 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
14549 predicate is assumed to be a list.
14550
14551
14552 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
14553 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
14554 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
14555 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
14556 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
14557 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
14558
14559 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
14560 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
14561 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
14562 if it's to be specific to that group.
14563
14564 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
14565 three forms:
14566
14567 @enumerate
14568 @item
14569 Score rule
14570
14571 This has the same syntax as a normal gnus score file except only a
14572 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
14573
14574 example:
14575
14576 @itemize @bullet
14577 @item
14578 Category specification
14579
14580 @lisp
14581 (("from"
14582 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14583 ("lines"
14584 (500 -100 nil <)))
14585 @end lisp
14586
14587 @item
14588 Group Parameter specification
14589
14590 @lisp
14591 (agent-score ("from"
14592 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14593 ("lines"
14594 (500 -100 nil <)))
14595 @end lisp
14596
14597 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
14598 @end itemize
14599
14600 @item
14601 Agent score file
14602
14603 These score files must *only* contain the permitted scoring keywords
14604 stated above.
14605
14606 example:
14607
14608 @itemize @bullet
14609 @item
14610 Category specification
14611
14612 @lisp
14613 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
14614 @end lisp
14615
14616 or perhaps
14617
14618 @lisp
14619 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
14620 @end lisp
14621
14622 @item
14623 Group Parameter specification
14624
14625 @lisp
14626 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
14627 @end lisp
14628
14629 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
14630 about parenthesis?
14631 @end itemize
14632
14633 @item
14634 Use @code{normal} score files
14635
14636 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
14637 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
14638 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
14639 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
14640
14641 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
14642 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
14643 files for a group, *filtering out* those those sections that do not
14644 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
14645
14646 @itemize @bullet
14647 @item
14648 Category Specification
14649
14650 @lisp
14651 file
14652 @end lisp
14653
14654 @item
14655 Group Parameter specification
14656
14657 @lisp
14658 (agent-score . file)
14659 @end lisp
14660 @end itemize
14661 @end enumerate
14662
14663 @node The Category Buffer
14664 @subsubsection The Category Buffer
14665
14666 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
14667 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
14668 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
14669
14670 The following commands are available in this buffer:
14671
14672 @table @kbd
14673 @item q
14674 @kindex q (Category)
14675 @findex gnus-category-exit
14676 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
14677
14678 @item k
14679 @kindex k (Category)
14680 @findex gnus-category-kill
14681 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
14682
14683 @item c
14684 @kindex c (Category)
14685 @findex gnus-category-copy
14686 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
14687
14688 @item a
14689 @kindex a (Category)
14690 @findex gnus-category-add
14691 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
14692
14693 @item p
14694 @kindex p (Category)
14695 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
14696 Edit the predicate of the current category
14697 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
14698
14699 @item g
14700 @kindex g (Category)
14701 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
14702 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
14703 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
14704
14705 @item s
14706 @kindex s (Category)
14707 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
14708 Edit the download score rule of the current category
14709 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
14710
14711 @item l
14712 @kindex l (Category)
14713 @findex gnus-category-list
14714 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
14715 @end table
14716
14717
14718 @node Category Variables
14719 @subsubsection Category Variables
14720
14721 @table @code
14722 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
14723 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
14724 Hook run in category buffers.
14725
14726 @item gnus-category-line-format
14727 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
14728 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
14729 Variables}). Valid elements are:
14730
14731 @table @samp
14732 @item c
14733 The name of the category.
14734
14735 @item g
14736 The number of groups in the category.
14737 @end table
14738
14739 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
14740 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
14741 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
14742
14743 @item gnus-agent-short-article
14744 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
14745 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
14746
14747 @item gnus-agent-long-article
14748 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
14749 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
14750
14751 @item gnus-agent-low-score
14752 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
14753 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
14754 0.
14755
14756 @item gnus-agent-high-score
14757 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
14758 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
14759 0.
14760
14761 @end table
14762
14763
14764 @node Agent Commands
14765 @subsection Agent Commands
14766
14767 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
14768 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged} command works in all modes, and
14769 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
14770
14771
14772 @menu
14773 * Group Agent Commands::
14774 * Summary Agent Commands::
14775 * Server Agent Commands::
14776 @end menu
14777
14778 You can run a complete batch fetch from the command line with the
14779 following incantation:
14780
14781 @cindex gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14782 @example
14783 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14784 @end example
14785
14786
14787
14788 @node Group Agent Commands
14789 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
14790
14791 @table @kbd
14792 @item J u
14793 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
14794 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
14795 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
14796 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
14797
14798 @item J c
14799 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
14800 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
14801 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
14802
14803 @item J s
14804 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
14805 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
14806 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
14807 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
14808
14809 @item J S
14810 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
14811 @findex gnus-group-send-drafts
14812 Send all sendable messages in the draft group
14813 (@code{gnus-group-send-drafts}). @xref{Drafts}.
14814
14815 @item J a
14816 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
14817 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
14818 Add the current group to an Agent category
14819 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
14820 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14821
14822 @item J r
14823 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
14824 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
14825 Remove the current group from its category, if any
14826 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
14827 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14828
14829 @item J Y
14830 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
14831 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
14832 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
14833
14834
14835 @end table
14836
14837
14838 @node Summary Agent Commands
14839 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
14840
14841 @table @kbd
14842 @item J #
14843 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
14844 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
14845 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
14846
14847 @item J M-#
14848 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
14849 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
14850 Remove the downloading mark from the article
14851 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
14852
14853 @item @@
14854 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
14855 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
14856 Toggle whether to download the article (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}).
14857
14858 @item J c
14859 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
14860 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
14861 Mark all undownloaded articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}).
14862
14863 @end table
14864
14865
14866 @node Server Agent Commands
14867 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
14868
14869 @table @kbd
14870 @item J a
14871 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
14872 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
14873 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
14874 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
14875
14876 @item J r
14877 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
14878 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
14879 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
14880 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
14881
14882 @end table
14883
14884
14885 @node Agent Expiry
14886 @subsection Agent Expiry
14887
14888 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
14889 @findex gnus-agent-expire
14890 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
14891 @cindex Agent expiry
14892 @cindex Gnus Agent expiry
14893 @cindex expiry
14894
14895 @code{nnagent} doesn't handle expiry. Instead, there's a special
14896 @code{gnus-agent-expire} command that will expire all read articles that
14897 are older than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. It can be run
14898 whenever you feel that you're running out of space. It's not
14899 particularly fast or efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to
14900 interrupt it (with @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started it.
14901
14902 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
14903 if @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, this command will
14904 expire all articles---unread, read, ticked and dormant. If @code{nil}
14905 (which is the default), only read articles are eligible for expiry, and
14906 unread, ticked and dormant articles will be kept indefinitely.
14907
14908
14909 @node Agent and IMAP
14910 @subsection Agent and IMAP
14911
14912 The Agent work with any Gnus backend, including nnimap. However, since
14913 there are some conceptual differences between NNTP and IMAP, this
14914 section (should) provide you with some information to make Gnus Agent
14915 work smoother as a IMAP Disconnected Mode client.
14916
14917 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
14918 are kept on the IMAP server, rather than in @code{.newsrc} as is the
14919 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
14920 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
14921
14922 Gnus keep track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
14923 Agent by default. When you plug back in, by default Gnus will check if
14924 you have any changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these
14925 with the server. This behaviour is customizable with
14926 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
14927
14928 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
14929 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
14930 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, the
14931 default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so ask if
14932 you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has any other
14933 value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
14934
14935 If you do not wish to automatically synchronize flags when you
14936 re-connect, this can be done manually with the
14937 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
14938 in the group buffer by default.
14939
14940 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
14941 expect from a disconnected IMAP client, including:
14942
14943 @itemize @bullet
14944
14945 @item
14946 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
14947
14948 @item
14949 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
14950
14951 @end itemize
14952
14953 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by "pushing"
14954 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
14955 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
14956 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on a article, quit the group and
14957 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
14958 removed from the server when you "synchronize". The queued flag
14959 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
14960 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
14961
14962
14963 @node Outgoing Messages
14964 @subsection Outgoing Messages
14965
14966 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
14967 stored in the draft groups (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view them there
14968 after posting, and edit them at will.
14969
14970 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
14971 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
14972 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
14973 messages in the draft group.
14974
14975
14976
14977 @node Agent Variables
14978 @subsection Agent Variables
14979
14980 @table @code
14981 @item gnus-agent-directory
14982 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
14983 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
14984 @file{~/News/agent/}.
14985
14986 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
14987 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
14988 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
14989 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
14990 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
14991 by default.
14992
14993 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
14994 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
14995 Hook run when connecting to the network.
14996
14997 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
14998 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
14999 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
15000
15001 @end table
15002
15003
15004 @node Example Setup
15005 @subsection Example Setup
15006
15007 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
15008 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
15009 @file{.gnus.el} file to get started.
15010
15011 @lisp
15012 ;;; Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @sc{nntp}
15013 ;;; from your ISP's server.
15014 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
15015
15016 ;;; Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from
15017 ;;; your ISP's POP server.
15018 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
15019
15020 ;;; Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.
15021 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
15022
15023 ;;; Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.
15024 (gnus-agentize)
15025 @end lisp
15026
15027 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
15028 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
15029 gnus}.
15030
15031 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
15032 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
15033 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
15034 @sc{nntp} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
15035 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
15036 once.
15037
15038 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
15039 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
15040 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
15041 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
15042 back all the killed groups.)
15043
15044 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
15045 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
15046 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
15047
15048
15049 @node Batching Agents
15050 @subsection Batching Agents
15051
15052 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
15053 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
15054 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
15055
15056 @example
15057 #!/bin/sh
15058 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null
15059 @end example
15060
15061
15062 @node Agent Caveats
15063 @subsection Agent Caveats
15064
15065 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
15066 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
15067 may ask:
15068
15069 @table @dfn
15070 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the
15071 Agent?
15072
15073 @strong{No.}
15074
15075 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists
15076 in the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
15077
15078 @strong{Yes.}
15079
15080 @end table
15081
15082 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
15083 articles; when it's plugged, it only talks to your ISP.
15084
15085
15086 @node Scoring
15087 @chapter Scoring
15088 @cindex scoring
15089
15090 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
15091 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
15092 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
15093 attention!
15094
15095 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
15096 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
15097 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
15098 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
15099 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
15100
15101 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
15102 before generating the summary buffer.
15103
15104 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
15105 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
15106 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
15107
15108 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
15109 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
15110 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
15111 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
15112
15113 @menu
15114 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
15115 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
15116 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
15117 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
15118 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
15119 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
15120 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
15121 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
15122 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
15123 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
15124 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
15125 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
15126 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
15127 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
15128 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
15129 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
15130 @end menu
15131
15132
15133 @node Summary Score Commands
15134 @section Summary Score Commands
15135 @cindex score commands
15136
15137 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
15138 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
15139 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
15140 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
15141 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
15142
15143 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
15144 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
15145 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
15146 score file the current one.
15147
15148 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
15149
15150 @table @kbd
15151
15152 @item V s
15153 @kindex V s (Summary)
15154 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
15155 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
15156
15157 @item V S
15158 @kindex V S (Summary)
15159 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
15160 Display the score of the current article
15161 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
15162
15163 @item V t
15164 @kindex V t (Summary)
15165 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
15166 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
15167 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}).
15168
15169 @item V R
15170 @kindex V R (Summary)
15171 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
15172 Run the current summary through the scoring process
15173 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
15174 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
15175 effect you're having.
15176
15177 @item V c
15178 @kindex V c (Summary)
15179 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
15180 Make a different score file the current
15181 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
15182
15183 @item V e
15184 @kindex V e (Summary)
15185 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
15186 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
15187 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
15188 File Editing}).
15189
15190 @item V f
15191 @kindex V f (Summary)
15192 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
15193 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
15194 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
15195
15196 @item V F
15197 @kindex V F (Summary)
15198 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15199 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
15200 after editing score files.
15201
15202 @item V C
15203 @kindex V C (Summary)
15204 @findex gnus-score-customize
15205 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
15206 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
15207
15208 @end table
15209
15210 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
15211
15212 @table @kbd
15213
15214 @item V m
15215 @kindex V m (Summary)
15216 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
15217 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
15218 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
15219
15220 @item V x
15221 @kindex V x (Summary)
15222 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
15223 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
15224 expunge all articles below this score
15225 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
15226 @end table
15227
15228 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
15229 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
15230 them.)
15231
15232 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
15233 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
15234
15235 @enumerate
15236 @item
15237 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
15238 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
15239 @item
15240 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
15241 keys are available:
15242 @table @kbd
15243
15244 @item a
15245 Score on the author name.
15246
15247 @item s
15248 Score on the subject line.
15249
15250 @item x
15251 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
15252
15253 @item r
15254 Score on the @code{References} line.
15255
15256 @item d
15257 Score on the date.
15258
15259 @item l
15260 Score on the number of lines.
15261
15262 @item i
15263 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
15264
15265 @item f
15266 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
15267 the followups to this author.
15268
15269 @item b
15270 Score on the body.
15271
15272 @item h
15273 Score on the head.
15274
15275 @item t
15276 Score on thread.
15277
15278 @end table
15279
15280 @item
15281 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
15282 what headers you are scoring on.
15283
15284 @table @code
15285
15286 @item strings
15287
15288 @table @kbd
15289
15290 @item e
15291 Exact matching.
15292
15293 @item s
15294 Substring matching.
15295
15296 @item f
15297 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
15298
15299 @item r
15300 Regexp matching
15301 @end table
15302
15303 @item date
15304 @table @kbd
15305
15306 @item b
15307 Before date.
15308
15309 @item a
15310 After date.
15311
15312 @item n
15313 This date.
15314 @end table
15315
15316 @item number
15317 @table @kbd
15318
15319 @item <
15320 Less than number.
15321
15322 @item =
15323 Equal to number.
15324
15325 @item >
15326 Greater than number.
15327 @end table
15328 @end table
15329
15330 @item
15331 The fourth and final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e., expiring)
15332 score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry, or whether
15333 it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score file.
15334 @table @kbd
15335
15336 @item t
15337 Temporary score entry.
15338
15339 @item p
15340 Permanent score entry.
15341
15342 @item i
15343 Immediately scoring.
15344 @end table
15345
15346 @end enumerate
15347
15348 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
15349 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
15350 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
15351 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
15352
15353 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
15354 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
15355 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
15356 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
15357 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
15358
15359 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
15360 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
15361 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
15362 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
15363 current score file.
15364
15365 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
15366 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
15367 pretend they are keymaps or not.
15368
15369
15370 @node Group Score Commands
15371 @section Group Score Commands
15372 @cindex group score commands
15373
15374 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
15375
15376 @table @kbd
15377
15378 @item W f
15379 @kindex W f (Group)
15380 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15381 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
15382 all the time. This command will flush the cache
15383 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
15384
15385 @end table
15386
15387 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
15388
15389 @findex gnus-batch-score
15390 @cindex batch scoring
15391 @example
15392 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
15393 @end example
15394
15395
15396 @node Score Variables
15397 @section Score Variables
15398 @cindex score variables
15399
15400 @table @code
15401
15402 @item gnus-use-scoring
15403 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
15404 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
15405 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
15406
15407 @item gnus-kill-killed
15408 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
15409 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
15410 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
15411 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
15412 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
15413 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
15414 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
15415
15416 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
15417 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
15418 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
15419 initialized from the @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
15420 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
15421
15422 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
15423 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
15424 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
15425 (@samp{SCORE} by default.)
15426
15427 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15428 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15429 @cindex score cache
15430 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
15431 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
15432 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
15433 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
15434 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
15435 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
15436 be cached.
15437
15438 @item gnus-save-score
15439 @vindex gnus-save-score
15440 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
15441 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
15442 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
15443
15444 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
15445 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
15446 across group visits.
15447
15448 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15449 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15450 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
15451 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
15452 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
15453 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
15454 manually entered data.
15455
15456 @item gnus-summary-default-score
15457 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
15458 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
15459
15460 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
15461 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
15462 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
15463 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
15464 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
15465 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
15466
15467 @item gnus-score-over-mark
15468 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
15469 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
15470 default. Default is @samp{+}.
15471
15472 @item gnus-score-below-mark
15473 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
15474 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
15475 default. Default is @samp{-}.
15476
15477 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15478 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15479 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
15480 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
15481
15482 Predefined functions available are:
15483 @table @code
15484
15485 @item gnus-score-find-single
15486 @findex gnus-score-find-single
15487 Only apply the group's own score file.
15488
15489 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
15490 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
15491 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
15492 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
15493 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
15494 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
15495 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
15496 then a regexp match is done.
15497
15498 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
15499 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
15500
15501 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
15502 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
15503 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
15504 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
15505
15506 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15507 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15508 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
15509 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
15510 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
15511 server.
15512
15513 @end table
15514 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all these
15515 functions will be called with the group name as argument, and all the
15516 returned lists of score files will be applied. These functions can also
15517 return lists of score alists directly. In that case, the functions that
15518 return these non-file score alists should probably be placed before the
15519 ``real'' score file functions, to ensure that the last score file
15520 returned is the local score file. Phu.
15521
15522 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
15523 overall score file, you could use the value
15524 @example
15525 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE")) 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
15526 @end example
15527
15528 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
15529 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
15530 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
15531 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
15532 are expired. It's 7 by default.
15533
15534 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15535 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15536 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, matching score entries will have
15537 their dates updated. (This is how Gnus controls expiry---all
15538 non-matching entries will become too old while matching entries will
15539 stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this variable to @code{nil},
15540 even matching entries will grow old and will have to face that oh-so
15541 grim reaper.
15542
15543 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15544 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15545 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
15546
15547 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
15548 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
15549 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be simplified
15550 for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
15551 threading---according to the current value of
15552 gnus-simplify-subject-functions. If the scoring entry uses
15553 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
15554 simplified in this manner.
15555
15556 @end table
15557
15558
15559 @node Score File Format
15560 @section Score File Format
15561 @cindex score file format
15562
15563 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
15564 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
15565 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
15566
15567 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
15568
15569 @lisp
15570 (("from"
15571 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
15572 ("Per Abrahamsen")
15573 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
15574 ("subject"
15575 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
15576 ("xref"
15577 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
15578 ("lines"
15579 (2 -100 nil <))
15580 (mark 0)
15581 (expunge -1000)
15582 (mark-and-expunge -10)
15583 (read-only nil)
15584 (orphan -10)
15585 (adapt t)
15586 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
15587 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
15588 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
15589 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
15590 (eval (ding)))
15591 @end lisp
15592
15593 This example demonstrates most score file elements. For a different
15594 approach, see @pxref{Advanced Scoring}.
15595
15596 Even though this looks much like lisp code, nothing here is actually
15597 @code{eval}ed. The lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
15598 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
15599
15600 Six keys are supported by this alist:
15601
15602 @table @code
15603
15604 @item STRING
15605 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
15606 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
15607 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
15608 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
15609 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
15610 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
15611 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
15612 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
15613 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
15614 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
15615 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
15616 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
15617 to articles that matches these score entries.
15618
15619 Following this key is a arbitrary number of score entries, where each
15620 score entry has one to four elements.
15621 @enumerate
15622
15623 @item
15624 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
15625 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
15626 integer.
15627
15628 @item
15629 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
15630 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
15631 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
15632 is successful. If this element is not present, the
15633 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
15634 instead. This is 1000 by default.
15635
15636 @item
15637 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
15638 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
15639 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
15640 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
15641 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
15642
15643 @item
15644 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
15645 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
15646 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
15647 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
15648 @table @dfn
15649
15650 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
15651 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
15652 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
15653 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
15654 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
15655 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
15656 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
15657 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
15658 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
15659 instead, if you feel like.
15660
15661 @item Lines, Chars
15662 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
15663 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
15664
15665 These predicates are true if
15666
15667 @example
15668 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
15669 @end example
15670
15671 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
15672 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
15673 following form:
15674
15675 @lisp
15676 (< header-value 4)
15677 @end lisp
15678
15679 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
15680 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
15681 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
15682 it's not. I think.)
15683
15684 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some backends (like
15685 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
15686 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
15687 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
15688
15689 @item Date
15690 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
15691 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
15692 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
15693 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
15694 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
15695 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
15696 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
15697
15698 @cindex ISO8601
15699 @cindex date
15700 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
15701 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
15702 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
15703 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
15704 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
15705 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
15706 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
15707 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
15708 whole family, eh?)
15709
15710 @item Head, Body, All
15711 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
15712 header uses.
15713
15714 @item Followup
15715 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
15716 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
15717 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
15718 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
15719 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
15720 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
15721 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
15722 files.)
15723
15724 @item Thread
15725 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
15726 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
15727 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
15728 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
15729 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
15730 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
15731 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
15732 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
15733 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
15734 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
15735 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
15736 @end table
15737 @end enumerate
15738
15739 @cindex Score File Atoms
15740 @item mark
15741 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15742 lower than this number will be marked as read.
15743
15744 @item expunge
15745 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15746 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
15747
15748 @item mark-and-expunge
15749 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15750 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
15751 summary buffer.
15752
15753 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
15754 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
15755 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
15756 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
15757 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
15758
15759 @item files
15760 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
15761 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
15762 this one was.
15763
15764 @item exclude-files
15765 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
15766 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
15767 other.
15768
15769 @item eval
15770 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
15771 ignored when handling global score files.
15772
15773 @item read-only
15774 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
15775 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
15776 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
15777 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
15778
15779 @item orphan
15780 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
15781 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
15782 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
15783 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
15784
15785 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
15786
15787 @example
15788 (orphan -500)
15789 (mark-and-expunge -100)
15790 @end example
15791
15792 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
15793 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
15794 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
15795 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
15796 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
15797
15798 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where there
15799 exist a few interesting threads which can't be found automatically by
15800 ordinary scoring rules.
15801
15802 @item adapt
15803 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
15804 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
15805 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
15806 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
15807 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
15808 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
15809 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15810 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
15811 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
15812 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
15813 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
15814 it.
15815
15816 @item adapt-file
15817 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
15818 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
15819 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
15820 file for a number of groups.
15821
15822 @item local
15823 @cindex local variables
15824 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(VAR VALUE)} pairs.
15825 Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the current summary buffer,
15826 and set to the value specified. This is a convenient, if somewhat
15827 strange, way of setting variables in some groups if you don't like hooks
15828 much. Note that the @var{value} won't be evaluated.
15829 @end table
15830
15831
15832 @node Score File Editing
15833 @section Score File Editing
15834
15835 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
15836 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
15837 with a mode for that.
15838
15839 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
15840 additional commands:
15841
15842 @table @kbd
15843
15844 @item C-c C-c
15845 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
15846 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
15847 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
15848 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
15849
15850 @item C-c C-d
15851 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
15852 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
15853 Insert the current date in numerical format
15854 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
15855 you were wondering.
15856
15857 @item C-c C-p
15858 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
15859 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
15860 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
15861 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
15862 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
15863 you.
15864
15865 @end table
15866
15867 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
15868
15869 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
15870 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
15871
15872 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f} and @kbd{V
15873 e} to begin editing score files.
15874
15875
15876 @node Adaptive Scoring
15877 @section Adaptive Scoring
15878 @cindex adaptive scoring
15879
15880 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
15881 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
15882 stupidity, to be precise.
15883
15884 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
15885 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
15886 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
15887 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
15888 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15889 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
15890 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
15891 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
15892 variable to @code{(word line)}.
15893
15894 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15895 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
15896 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
15897 might look something like this:
15898
15899 @lisp
15900 (defvar gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15901 '((gnus-unread-mark)
15902 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
15903 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
15904 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
15905 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
15906 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
15907 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
15908 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
15909 (gnus-ancient-mark)
15910 (gnus-low-score-mark)
15911 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
15912 @end lisp
15913
15914 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
15915 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
15916 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
15917 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
15918 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
15919 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
15920 entries.
15921
15922 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
15923 will be applied to each article.
15924
15925 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
15926 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{D}) will have a
15927 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
15928 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
15929
15930 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
15931 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
15932 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
15933 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
15934
15935 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
15936 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
15937 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
15938 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
15939
15940 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
15941 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
15942 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
15943 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
15944 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
15945 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
15946
15947 You can also score on @code{thread}, which will try to score all
15948 articles that appear in a thread. @code{thread} matches uses a
15949 @code{Message-ID} to match on the @code{References} header of the
15950 article. If the match is made, the @code{Message-ID} of the article is
15951 added to the @code{thread} rule. (Think about it. I'd recommend two
15952 aspirins afterwards.)
15953
15954 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
15955 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
15956 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
15957
15958 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
15959 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
15960 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
15961
15962 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
15963 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
15964 let you use different rules in different groups.
15965
15966 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
15967 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
15968 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
15969 is @samp{ADAPT}.
15970
15971 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
15972 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
15973 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
15974 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
15975 the length of the match is less than
15976 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
15977 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
15978 this problem.
15979
15980 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
15981 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
15982 headers. If you adapt on words, the
15983 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
15984 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
15985
15986 @lisp
15987 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
15988 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
15989 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
15990 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
15991 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
15992 @end lisp
15993
15994 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
15995 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
15996 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
15997 score with 30 points.
15998
15999 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
16000 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
16001 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
16002 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
16003 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
16004
16005 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
16006 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
16007 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
16008 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
16009
16010 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
16011 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
16012 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
16013 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
16014
16015 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
16016 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
16017 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
16018 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
16019 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
16020
16021 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
16022 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
16023 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
16024
16025 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
16026 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
16027 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
16028 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
16029
16030
16031 @node Home Score File
16032 @section Home Score File
16033
16034 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
16035 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
16036 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
16037 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
16038
16039 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
16040 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
16041 could perhaps use the same home score file.
16042
16043 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
16044 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
16045 be:
16046
16047 @enumerate
16048 @item
16049 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
16050 groups.
16051
16052 @item
16053 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
16054 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
16055 parameter.
16056
16057 @item
16058 A list. The elements in this list can be:
16059
16060 @enumerate
16061 @item
16062 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
16063 group name, the @var{file-name} will will be used as the home score file.
16064
16065 @item
16066 A function. If the function returns non-nil, the result will be used as
16067 the home score file.
16068
16069 @item
16070 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
16071 @end enumerate
16072
16073 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
16074 for matches.
16075
16076 @end enumerate
16077
16078 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
16079
16080 @lisp
16081 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16082 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
16083 @end lisp
16084
16085 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
16086 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
16087
16088 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
16089 @lisp
16090 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16091 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
16092 @end lisp
16093
16094 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
16095 Other functions include
16096
16097 @table @code
16098 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
16099 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
16100 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
16101 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
16102
16103 @end table
16104
16105 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
16106 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
16107 their own home score files:
16108
16109 @lisp
16110 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16111 ;; All groups that match the regexp "\\.emacs"
16112 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
16113 ;; All the comp groups in one score file
16114 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
16115 @end lisp
16116
16117 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
16118 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
16119 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
16120 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
16121 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
16122
16123 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
16124 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
16125 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
16126 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
16127 precedence over this variable.
16128
16129
16130 @node Followups To Yourself
16131 @section Followups To Yourself
16132
16133 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
16134 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
16135 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
16136 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
16137 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
16138 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
16139
16140 @table @code
16141
16142 @item gnus-score-followup-article
16143 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
16144 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
16145 article.
16146
16147 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
16148 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
16149 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
16150 your own article.
16151 @end table
16152
16153 @vindex message-sent-hook
16154 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
16155 @code{message-sent-hook}.
16156
16157 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
16158 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
16159 mine:
16160
16161 @example
16162 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16163 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16164 @end example
16165
16166 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
16167 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
16168 myself:
16169
16170 @lisp
16171 ("references"
16172 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore.no>"
16173 1000 nil r))
16174 @end lisp
16175
16176 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
16177 is system-dependent.
16178
16179
16180 @node Scoring Tips
16181 @section Scoring Tips
16182 @cindex scoring tips
16183
16184 @table @dfn
16185
16186 @item Crossposts
16187 @cindex crossposts
16188 @cindex scoring crossposts
16189 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
16190 the @code{Xref} header.
16191 @lisp
16192 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
16193 @end lisp
16194
16195 @item Multiple crossposts
16196 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
16197 more than, say, 3 groups:
16198 @lisp
16199 ("xref" ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+" -1000 nil r))
16200 @end lisp
16201
16202 @item Matching on the body
16203 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
16204 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
16205 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
16206 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
16207 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
16208 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
16209 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
16210 the matches.
16211
16212 @item Marking as read
16213 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
16214 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
16215 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
16216 @lisp
16217 ((mark -100))
16218 @end lisp
16219 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
16220
16221 @item Negated character classes
16222 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
16223 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
16224 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
16225 @end table
16226
16227
16228 @node Reverse Scoring
16229 @section Reverse Scoring
16230 @cindex reverse scoring
16231
16232 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
16233 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
16234 like this in your score file:
16235
16236 @lisp
16237 (("subject"
16238 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
16239 (mark 1)
16240 (expunge 1))
16241 @end lisp
16242
16243 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
16244 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
16245
16246
16247 @node Global Score Files
16248 @section Global Score Files
16249 @cindex global score files
16250
16251 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
16252 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
16253 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
16254
16255 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
16256 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
16257 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
16258
16259 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
16260 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
16261 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
16262 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
16263 files are applicable to which group.
16264
16265 Say you want to use the score file
16266 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
16267 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory:
16268
16269 @lisp
16270 (setq gnus-global-score-files
16271 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
16272 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
16273 @end lisp
16274
16275 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
16276 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
16277 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
16278 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
16279 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
16280
16281 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
16282 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
16283
16284 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
16285 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
16286 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
16287 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
16288 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
16289 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
16290
16291 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
16292 head:
16293
16294 @itemize @bullet
16295
16296 @item
16297 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
16298 @item
16299 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
16300 @item
16301 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
16302 @item
16303 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
16304 lowered out of existence.
16305 @item
16306 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
16307 articles completely.
16308
16309 @item
16310 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
16311 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
16312 old articles for a long time.
16313 @end itemize
16314
16315 ... I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
16316 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
16317 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
16318 holding our breath yet?
16319
16320
16321 @node Kill Files
16322 @section Kill Files
16323 @cindex kill files
16324
16325 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
16326 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
16327 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
16328
16329 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
16330 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
16331 files into score files.
16332
16333 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
16334 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
16335 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
16336 that isn't a very good idea.
16337
16338 Normal kill files look like this:
16339
16340 @lisp
16341 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16342 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
16343 (gnus-expunge "X")
16344 @end lisp
16345
16346 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
16347 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
16348
16349 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
16350 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
16351 interpreting it.
16352
16353 Two summary functions for editing a GNUS kill file:
16354
16355 @table @kbd
16356
16357 @item M-k
16358 @kindex M-k (Summary)
16359 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
16360 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
16361
16362 @item M-K
16363 @kindex M-K (Summary)
16364 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
16365 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
16366 @end table
16367
16368 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
16369
16370 @table @kbd
16371
16372 @item M-k
16373 @kindex M-k (Group)
16374 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
16375 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
16376
16377 @item M-K
16378 @kindex M-K (Group)
16379 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
16380 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
16381 @end table
16382
16383 Kill file variables:
16384
16385 @table @code
16386 @item gnus-kill-file-name
16387 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
16388 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
16389 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
16390 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
16391 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
16392 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
16393
16394 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16395 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16396 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
16397 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
16398 kills.
16399
16400 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
16401 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
16402 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
16403 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
16404 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
16405 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
16406 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
16407 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
16408 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
16409
16410 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16411 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16412 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
16413
16414 @end table
16415
16416
16417 @node Converting Kill Files
16418 @section Converting Kill Files
16419 @cindex kill files
16420 @cindex converting kill files
16421
16422 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
16423 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
16424 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
16425 by hand.
16426
16427 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
16428 You can fetch it from
16429 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
16430
16431 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
16432 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
16433 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
16434 before.
16435
16436
16437 @node GroupLens
16438 @section GroupLens
16439 @cindex GroupLens
16440
16441 GroupLens is a collaborative filtering system that helps you work
16442 together with other people to find the quality news articles out of the
16443 huge volume of news articles generated every day.
16444
16445 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
16446 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
16447 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
16448 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
16449 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
16450 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
16451 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
16452 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
16453 article.
16454
16455 @menu
16456 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
16457 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
16458 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
16459 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
16460 @end menu
16461
16462
16463 @node Using GroupLens
16464 @subsection Using GroupLens
16465
16466 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local Better
16467 Bit Bureau (BBB).
16468 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html} is the only
16469 better bit in town at the moment.
16470
16471 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
16472
16473 @table @code
16474
16475 @item gnus-use-grouplens
16476 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
16477 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
16478 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
16479
16480 @item grouplens-pseudonym
16481 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
16482 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
16483 with the Better Bit Bureau.
16484
16485 @item grouplens-newsgroups
16486 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
16487 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
16488
16489 @end table
16490
16491 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
16492 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
16493 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
16494 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
16495 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
16496 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
16497
16498
16499 @node Rating Articles
16500 @subsection Rating Articles
16501
16502 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
16503 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
16504 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
16505 yourself is, "on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
16506 like this one?"
16507
16508 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
16509
16510 @table @kbd
16511
16512 @item r
16513 @kindex r (GroupLens)
16514 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
16515 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
16516
16517 @item k
16518 @kindex k (GroupLens)
16519 @findex grouplens-score-thread
16520 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
16521 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
16522 threads in rec.humor.
16523
16524 @end table
16525
16526 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
16527 the score of the article you're reading.
16528
16529 @table @kbd
16530
16531 @item 1-5 n
16532 @kindex n (GroupLens)
16533 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
16534 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
16535
16536 @item 1-5 ,
16537 @kindex , (GroupLens)
16538 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
16539 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
16540
16541 @end table
16542
16543 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
16544 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
16545
16546
16547 @node Displaying Predictions
16548 @subsection Displaying Predictions
16549
16550 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
16551 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
16552 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
16553 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
16554 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
16555
16556 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
16557 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
16558 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
16559 regular gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
16560 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
16561 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
16562 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
16563 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
16564 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
16565 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
16566 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
16567 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
16568 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
16569
16570 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
16571 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
16572 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
16573 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
16574
16575 The following are valid values for that variable.
16576
16577 @table @code
16578 @item prediction-spot
16579 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
16580 displayed.
16581
16582 @item confidence-interval
16583 A numeric confidence interval.
16584
16585 @item prediction-bar
16586 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
16587
16588 @item confidence-bar
16589 Numerical confidence.
16590
16591 @item confidence-spot
16592 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
16593
16594 @item prediction-num
16595 Plain-old numeric value.
16596
16597 @item confidence-plus-minus
16598 Prediction +/- confidence.
16599
16600 @end table
16601
16602
16603 @node GroupLens Variables
16604 @subsection GroupLens Variables
16605
16606 @table @code
16607
16608 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
16609 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
16610 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
16611 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%)
16612 %s\n}.
16613
16614 @item grouplens-bbb-host
16615 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
16616 default.
16617
16618 @item grouplens-bbb-port
16619 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
16620
16621 @item grouplens-score-offset
16622 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
16623 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
16624 default is 0.
16625
16626 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
16627 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
16628 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
16629
16630 @end table
16631
16632
16633 @node Advanced Scoring
16634 @section Advanced Scoring
16635
16636 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
16637 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
16638 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
16639 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
16640 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
16641
16642 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
16643 scoring patterns.
16644
16645 @menu
16646 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
16647 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
16648 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
16649 @end menu
16650
16651
16652 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
16653 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
16654
16655 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
16656 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
16657 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
16658 non-@code{nil} value.
16659
16660 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
16661 operator, and various match operators.
16662
16663 Logical operators:
16664
16665 @table @code
16666 @item &
16667 @itemx and
16668 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16669 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
16670 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
16671 @code{true}.
16672
16673 @item |
16674 @itemx or
16675 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16676 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
16677 then this operator will return @code{false}.
16678
16679 @item !
16680 @itemx not
16681 @itemx ¬
16682 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
16683 logical negation of the value of its argument.
16684
16685 @end table
16686
16687 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
16688 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
16689 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
16690 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
16691 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
16692 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
16693 the ancestry you want to go.
16694
16695 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
16696 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
16697 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
16698 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
16699 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
16700
16701
16702 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
16703 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
16704
16705 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
16706 when he's talking about Gnus:
16707
16708 @example
16709 ((&
16710 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16711 ("subject" "Gnus"))
16712 1000)
16713 @end example
16714
16715 Quite simple, huh?
16716
16717 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
16718
16719 @example
16720 ((&
16721 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16722 (|
16723 ("subject" "Gnus")
16724 ("lines" 100 >)))
16725 1000)
16726 @end example
16727
16728 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
16729 really don't want to read what he's written:
16730
16731 @example
16732 ((&
16733 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16734 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
16735 -100000)
16736 @end example
16737
16738 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
16739 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
16740 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
16741 very interesting:
16742
16743 @example
16744 ((&
16745 (1-
16746 (&
16747 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
16748 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
16749 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
16750 ("body" "white.*socks"))
16751 1000)
16752 @end example
16753
16754 The possibilities are endless.
16755
16756
16757 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
16758 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
16759
16760 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
16761 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
16762 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
16763 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
16764 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
16765 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
16766 @samp{subject}) first.
16767
16768 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
16769 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
16770 something like:
16771
16772 @example
16773 ...
16774 (1-
16775 (1-
16776 ("from" "lars")))
16777 ...
16778 @end example
16779
16780 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
16781 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
16782
16783 @example
16784 (1-
16785 (&
16786 ("from" "Lars")
16787 ("subject" "Gnus")))
16788 @end example
16789
16790 than it is to say:
16791
16792 @example
16793 (&
16794 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
16795 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
16796 @end example
16797
16798
16799 @node Score Decays
16800 @section Score Decays
16801 @cindex score decays
16802 @cindex decays
16803
16804 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
16805 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
16806 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
16807 use them in any sensible way.
16808
16809 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
16810 @findex gnus-decay-score
16811 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
16812 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
16813 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
16814 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
16815 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
16816 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
16817 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
16818 definition of that function:
16819
16820 @lisp
16821 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
16822 "Decay SCORE.
16823 This is done according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
16824 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
16825 (floor
16826 (- score
16827 (* (if (< score 0) 1 -1)
16828 (min (abs score)
16829 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
16830 (* (abs score)
16831 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
16832 @end lisp
16833
16834 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
16835 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
16836 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
16837 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
16838
16839 @enumerate
16840 @item
16841 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
16842
16843 @item
16844 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
16845
16846 @item
16847 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
16848 score.
16849 @end enumerate
16850
16851 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
16852 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
16853 the new score, which should be an integer.
16854
16855 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
16856 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
16857
16858
16859 @node Various
16860 @chapter Various
16861
16862 @menu
16863 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
16864 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
16865 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
16866 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
16867 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
16868 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
16869 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
16870 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
16871 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
16872 * Buttons:: Get tendonitis in ten easy steps!
16873 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
16874 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
16875 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
16876 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
16877 * Emacs Enhancements:: There can be more pictures and stuff under
16878 Emacs 21.
16879 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
16880 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
16881 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
16882 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
16883 @end menu
16884
16885
16886 @node Process/Prefix
16887 @section Process/Prefix
16888 @cindex process/prefix convention
16889
16890 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
16891 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
16892
16893 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
16894 command to be performed on.
16895
16896 It goes like this:
16897
16898 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
16899 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
16900 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
16901 with the current one.
16902
16903 @vindex transient-mark-mode
16904 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
16905 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
16906
16907 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
16908 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
16909 the process mark.
16910
16911 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
16912 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
16913
16914 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
16915 are avoided.
16916
16917 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
16918 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
16919 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
16920 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
16921
16922 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
16923 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
16924 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
16925 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
16926 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
16927 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
16928 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
16929 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
16930
16931 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
16932 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
16933 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
16934 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
16935 expirable, you could say `M P b M-& E'.
16936
16937
16938 @node Interactive
16939 @section Interactive
16940 @cindex interaction
16941
16942 @table @code
16943
16944 @item gnus-novice-user
16945 @vindex gnus-novice-user
16946 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
16947 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
16948 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
16949 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
16950 default.
16951
16952 @item gnus-expert-user
16953 @vindex gnus-expert-user
16954 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
16955 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
16956 matter how strange.
16957
16958 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
16959 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
16960 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
16961 is @code{t} by default.
16962
16963 @item gnus-interactive-exit
16964 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
16965 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
16966 default.
16967 @end table
16968
16969
16970 @node Symbolic Prefixes
16971 @section Symbolic Prefixes
16972 @cindex symbolic prefixes
16973
16974 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
16975 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
16976 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
16977 rule of 900 to the current article.
16978
16979 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
16980 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
16981 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
16982 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
16983 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
16984 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
16985 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
16986
16987 @kindex M-i (Summary)
16988 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
16989 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
16990 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
16991 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
16992 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a M-C-u} means ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u}
16993 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b M-C-u} means
16994 ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
16995 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
16996
16997 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
16998 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
16999 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
17000
17001 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
17002 Interactive}.
17003
17004
17005 @node Formatting Variables
17006 @section Formatting Variables
17007 @cindex formatting variables
17008
17009 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
17010 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
17011 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
17012 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
17013 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
17014 be annoyed by.
17015
17016 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
17017 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
17018 lots of percentages everywhere.
17019
17020 @menu
17021 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
17022 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
17023 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
17024 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
17025 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
17026 @end menu
17027
17028 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
17029 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
17030 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
17031 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
17032 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
17033 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
17034 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
17035 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
17036
17037 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
17038 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
17039
17040 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
17041 @findex gnus-update-format
17042 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
17043 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
17044 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
17045 examine the resulting lisp code to be run to generate the line.
17046
17047
17048
17049 @node Formatting Basics
17050 @subsection Formatting Basics
17051
17052 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
17053 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
17054 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
17055
17056 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
17057 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
17058 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
17059 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
17060 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
17061 the right instead.
17062
17063 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
17064 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
17065 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
17066 less than 4 characters wide.
17067
17068
17069 @node Mode Line Formatting
17070 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
17071
17072 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
17073 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
17074 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
17075 with the following two differences:
17076
17077 @enumerate
17078
17079 @item
17080 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
17081
17082 @item
17083 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
17084 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
17085 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
17086 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
17087 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
17088 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
17089 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
17090
17091 @end enumerate
17092
17093
17094 @node Advanced Formatting
17095 @subsection Advanced Formatting
17096
17097 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
17098 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
17099 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
17100 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
17101
17102 These are the valid modifiers:
17103
17104 @table @code
17105 @item pad
17106 @itemx pad-left
17107 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
17108 length.
17109
17110 @item pad-right
17111 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
17112 length.
17113
17114 @item max
17115 @itemx max-left
17116 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
17117
17118 @item max-right
17119 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
17120 length.
17121
17122 @item cut
17123 @itemx cut-left
17124 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
17125
17126 @item cut-right
17127 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
17128
17129 @item ignore
17130 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
17131
17132 @item form
17133 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
17134 used.
17135 @end table
17136
17137 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
17138 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
17139 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
17140 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
17141 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
17142 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
17143 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
17144
17145 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
17146 last operation, padding.
17147
17148 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
17149 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
17150 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
17151 @xref{Compilation}.
17152
17153
17154 @node User-Defined Specs
17155 @subsection User-Defined Specs
17156
17157 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
17158 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
17159 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
17160 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
17161 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
17162 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
17163 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
17164 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
17165 should protect against that.
17166
17167 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
17168 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
17169 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
17170 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
17171 inserted.
17172
17173
17174 @node Formatting Fonts
17175 @subsection Formatting Fonts
17176
17177 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
17178 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
17179 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
17180 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
17181 over it.
17182
17183 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
17184 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
17185 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
17186 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
17187 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
17188 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
17189
17190 Text inside the @samp{%<} and @samp{%>} specifiers will get the special
17191 @code{balloon-help} property set to @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you
17192 say @samp{%1<}, you'll get @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The
17193 @code{gnus-balloon-face-*} variables should be either strings or symbols
17194 naming functions that return a string. Under @code{balloon-help-mode},
17195 when the mouse passes over text with this property set, a balloon window
17196 will appear and display the string. Please refer to the doc string of
17197 @code{balloon-help-mode} for more information on this.
17198
17199 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
17200
17201 @lisp
17202 ;; Create three face types.
17203 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
17204 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
17205
17206 ;; We want the article count to be in
17207 ;; a bold and green face. So we create
17208 ;; a new face called `my-green-bold'.
17209 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
17210 ;; Set the color.
17211 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
17212 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
17213
17214 ;; Set the new & fancy format.
17215 (setq gnus-group-line-format
17216 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
17217 @end lisp
17218
17219 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
17220 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
17221
17222 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
17223 mode-line variables.
17224
17225
17226 @node Windows Configuration
17227 @section Windows Configuration
17228 @cindex windows configuration
17229
17230 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
17231
17232 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
17233 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
17234 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
17235 @code{t} by default.
17236
17237 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
17238 glitches. Use at your own peril.
17239
17240 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
17241 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
17242 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
17243
17244 @lisp
17245 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
17246 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
17247 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17248 (article 1.0))))
17249 @end lisp
17250
17251 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
17252 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
17253 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
17254 possible names is listed below.
17255
17256 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
17257 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
17258
17259 @lisp
17260 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17261 (article 1.0)))
17262 @end lisp
17263
17264 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
17265 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
17266 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
17267 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
17268 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
17269 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
17270 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
17271 size spec per split.
17272
17273 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
17274 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
17275 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
17276 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
17277 present) gets focus.
17278
17279 Here's a more complicated example:
17280
17281 @lisp
17282 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
17283 (summary 0.25 point)
17284 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
17285 (article 1.0)))
17286 @end lisp
17287
17288 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
17289 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
17290 occupy, not a percentage.
17291
17292 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
17293 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
17294 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
17295 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
17296 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
17297 is non-@code{nil}.
17298
17299 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
17300
17301 @lisp
17302 (article (horizontal 1.0
17303 (vertical 0.5
17304 (group 1.0)
17305 (gnus-carpal 4))
17306 (vertical 1.0
17307 (summary 0.25 point)
17308 (summary-carpal 4)
17309 (article 1.0))))
17310 @end lisp
17311
17312 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
17313 @code{horizontal} thingie?
17314
17315 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
17316 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
17317 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
17318 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
17319 the screen is to be given to this strip.
17320
17321 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
17322 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
17323 lines from the splits.
17324
17325 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
17326 may look like:
17327
17328 @example
17329 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
17330 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
17331 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
17332 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
17333 buffer = "(" buffer-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
17334 size = number | frame-params
17335 buffer-name = group | article | summary ...
17336 @end example
17337
17338 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
17339 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
17340 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
17341 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
17342
17343 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
17344 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
17345 @cindex window height
17346 @cindex window width
17347 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
17348 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
17349 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
17350 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
17351 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
17352 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
17353
17354 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
17355 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
17356 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
17357 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
17358
17359 @findex gnus-configure-frame
17360 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
17361 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
17362 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
17363 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
17364 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
17365 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
17366 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
17367 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
17368 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
17369 configuration list.
17370
17371 @lisp
17372 (gnus-configure-frame
17373 '(horizontal 1.0
17374 (vertical 10
17375 (group 1.0)
17376 (article 0.3 point))
17377 (vertical 1.0
17378 (article 1.0)
17379 (horizontal 4
17380 (group 1.0)
17381 (article 10)))))
17382 @end lisp
17383
17384 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
17385 @code{frame} split:
17386
17387 @lisp
17388 (gnus-configure-frame
17389 '(frame 1.0
17390 (vertical 1.0
17391 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
17392 (article 1.0))
17393 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
17394 (user-position . t)
17395 (left . -1) (top . 1))
17396 (picon 1.0))))
17397
17398 @end lisp
17399
17400 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
17401 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
17402 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
17403 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
17404 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
17405 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
17406 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
17407 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
17408 is such a plist.
17409 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
17410 be found in its default value.
17411
17412 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
17413 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
17414 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
17415 might be used:
17416
17417 @lisp
17418 (message (horizontal 1.0
17419 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
17420 (vertical 0.24
17421 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
17422 '(summary 0.5))
17423 (group 1.0)))))
17424 @end lisp
17425
17426 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
17427 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
17428 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
17429
17430 @lisp
17431 (message (frame 1.0
17432 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
17433 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
17434 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
17435 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
17436 (name . "Message"))
17437 (message 1.0 point))))
17438 @end lisp
17439
17440 @findex gnus-add-configuration
17441 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
17442 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
17443 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
17444 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
17445
17446 @lisp
17447 (gnus-add-configuration
17448 '(article (vertical 1.0
17449 (group 4)
17450 (summary .25 point)
17451 (article 1.0))))
17452 @end lisp
17453
17454 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
17455 @file{.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
17456 Gnus has been loaded.
17457
17458 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
17459 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
17460 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
17461 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
17462 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
17463
17464 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
17465 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
17466 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
17467 windows resized.
17468
17469 @subsection Example Window Configurations
17470
17471 @itemize @bullet
17472 @item
17473 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
17474 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
17475
17476 @ifinfo
17477 @example
17478 +---+---------+
17479 | G | Summary |
17480 | r +---------+
17481 | o | |
17482 | u | Article |
17483 | p | |
17484 +---+---------+
17485 @end example
17486 @end ifinfo
17487
17488 @lisp
17489 (gnus-add-configuration
17490 '(article
17491 (horizontal 1.0
17492 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17493 (vertical 1.0
17494 (summary 0.16 point)
17495 (article 1.0)))))
17496
17497 (gnus-add-configuration
17498 '(summary
17499 (horizontal 1.0
17500 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17501 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
17502 @end lisp
17503
17504 @end itemize
17505
17506
17507 @node Faces and Fonts
17508 @section Faces and Fonts
17509 @cindex faces
17510 @cindex fonts
17511 @cindex colors
17512
17513 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
17514 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
17515 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
17516 interface.
17517
17518
17519 @node Compilation
17520 @section Compilation
17521 @cindex compilation
17522 @cindex byte-compilation
17523
17524 @findex gnus-compile
17525
17526 Remember all those line format specification variables?
17527 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
17528 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
17529 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
17530 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
17531 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
17532 course.)
17533
17534 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
17535 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
17536 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
17537 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
17538 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
17539 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
17540 them into the @code{.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
17541
17542
17543 @node Mode Lines
17544 @section Mode Lines
17545 @cindex mode lines
17546
17547 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
17548 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
17549 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
17550 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
17551 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
17552 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
17553 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
17554 quicker.
17555
17556 @cindex display-time
17557
17558 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
17559 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
17560 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
17561 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
17562 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
17563 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
17564 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
17565 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
17566 this variable:
17567
17568 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
17569 @lisp
17570 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
17571 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
17572 (+ 21
17573 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
17574 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
17575 (length display-time-string)))))
17576 @end lisp
17577
17578 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
17579 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
17580 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
17581 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
17582 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
17583
17584
17585 @node Highlighting and Menus
17586 @section Highlighting and Menus
17587 @cindex visual
17588 @cindex highlighting
17589 @cindex menus
17590
17591 @vindex gnus-visual
17592 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
17593 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
17594 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
17595 file.
17596
17597 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
17598 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
17599
17600 @table @code
17601 @item group-highlight
17602 Do highlights in the group buffer.
17603 @item summary-highlight
17604 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
17605 @item article-highlight
17606 Do highlights in the article buffer.
17607 @item highlight
17608 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
17609 @item group-menu
17610 Create menus in the group buffer.
17611 @item summary-menu
17612 Create menus in the summary buffers.
17613 @item article-menu
17614 Create menus in the article buffer.
17615 @item browse-menu
17616 Create menus in the browse buffer.
17617 @item server-menu
17618 Create menus in the server buffer.
17619 @item score-menu
17620 Create menus in the score buffers.
17621 @item menu
17622 Create menus in all buffers.
17623 @end table
17624
17625 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
17626 buffers, you could say something like:
17627
17628 @lisp
17629 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
17630 @end lisp
17631
17632 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
17633
17634 @lisp
17635 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
17636 @end lisp
17637
17638 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
17639 in all Gnus buffers.
17640
17641 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
17642
17643 @table @code
17644 @item gnus-mouse-face
17645 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
17646 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
17647 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
17648
17649 @end table
17650
17651 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
17652
17653 @table @code
17654
17655 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
17656 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
17657 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
17658
17659 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
17660 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
17661 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
17662
17663 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
17664 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
17665 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
17666
17667 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
17668 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
17669 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
17670
17671 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
17672 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
17673 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
17674
17675 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
17676 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
17677 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
17678
17679 @end table
17680
17681
17682 @node Buttons
17683 @section Buttons
17684 @cindex buttons
17685 @cindex mouse
17686 @cindex click
17687
17688 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
17689 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
17690 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
17691 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
17692 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
17693
17694 Right.
17695
17696 @vindex gnus-carpal
17697 Well, you can make Gnus display buffers full of buttons you can click to
17698 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
17699 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
17700
17701
17702 @table @code
17703
17704 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17705 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17706 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
17707
17708 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
17709 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
17710 Face used on buttons.
17711
17712 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
17713 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
17714 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
17715
17716 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17717 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17718 Buttons in the group buffer.
17719
17720 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17721 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17722 Buttons in the summary buffer.
17723
17724 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17725 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17726 Buttons in the server buffer.
17727
17728 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17729 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17730 Buttons in the browse buffer.
17731 @end table
17732
17733 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
17734 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
17735 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
17736
17737
17738 @node Daemons
17739 @section Daemons
17740 @cindex demons
17741 @cindex daemons
17742
17743 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
17744 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
17745 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
17746 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
17747 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
17748
17749 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
17750 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
17751 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
17752
17753 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
17754 been idle for thirty minutes:
17755
17756 @lisp
17757 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
17758 @end lisp
17759
17760 Here's a handler that scans for PGP headers every hour when Emacs is
17761 idle:
17762
17763 @lisp
17764 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
17765 @end lisp
17766
17767 This @var{time} parameter and than @var{idle} parameter work together
17768 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
17769 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17770
17771 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
17772 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
17773 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
17774 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17775
17776 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
17777 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
17778 @var{idle} minutes.
17779
17780 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
17781 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
17782 minutes.
17783
17784 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
17785 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
17786 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
17787
17788 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
17789 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
17790 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
17791 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
17792
17793 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
17794 your @file{.gnus} file:
17795
17796 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
17797 @lisp
17798 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
17799 @end lisp
17800
17801 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
17802 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
17803 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
17804 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
17805 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
17806 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
17807 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
17808 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
17809 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
17810 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
17811 @file{.gnus} if you want those abilities.
17812
17813 @findex gnus-demon-init
17814 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
17815 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
17816 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
17817 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
17818 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
17819
17820 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
17821 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
17822 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
17823 behave.
17824
17825
17826 @node NoCeM
17827 @section NoCeM
17828 @cindex nocem
17829 @cindex spam
17830
17831 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
17832 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
17833
17834 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
17835 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
17836 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
17837 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
17838 away.
17839
17840 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
17841 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
17842 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
17843 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
17844
17845 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
17846 this will make spam disappear.
17847
17848 There are some variables to customize, of course:
17849
17850 @table @code
17851 @item gnus-use-nocem
17852 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
17853 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
17854 by default.
17855
17856 @item gnus-nocem-groups
17857 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
17858 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
17859 default is @code{("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
17860 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")}.
17861
17862 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
17863 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
17864 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
17865 people you want to listen to. The default is @code{("Automoose-1"
17866 "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo"
17867 "hweede@@snafu.de")}; fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
17868
17869 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at
17870 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
17871
17872 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
17873 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
17874 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
17875 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
17876 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
17877 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
17878 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
17879 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
17880 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
17881 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
17882
17883 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
17884 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
17885
17886 @lisp
17887 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
17888 @end lisp
17889
17890 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
17891 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
17892
17893 @lisp
17894 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
17895 @end lisp
17896
17897 The specs are applied left-to-right.
17898
17899
17900 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
17901 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
17902 @findex mc-verify
17903 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
17904 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
17905 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
17906 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
17907
17908 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
17909 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
17910
17911 @lisp
17912 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
17913
17914 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
17915 (not (eq 'forged
17916 (ignore-errors
17917 (if (mc-verify)
17918 t
17919 'forged)))))
17920 @end lisp
17921
17922 This might be dangerous, though.
17923
17924 @item gnus-nocem-directory
17925 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
17926 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is
17927 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
17928
17929 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
17930 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
17931 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
17932 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
17933 might then see old spam.
17934
17935 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
17936 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
17937 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
17938 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
17939 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
17940 issuers.
17941
17942 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
17943 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
17944 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
17945 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
17946
17947 @end table
17948
17949 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
17950 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
17951 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
17952 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
17953
17954
17955 @node Undo
17956 @section Undo
17957 @cindex undo
17958
17959 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
17960 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
17961 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
17962
17963 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
17964 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
17965 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
17966 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
17967 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
17968 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
17969 @code{undo} function.
17970
17971 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
17972 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
17973 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
17974 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
17975 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
17976 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
17977 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
17978 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
17979 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
17980 never be totally undoable.
17981
17982 @findex gnus-undo-mode
17983 @vindex gnus-use-undo
17984 @findex gnus-undo
17985 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
17986 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
17987 default. The @kbd{M-C-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo} command
17988 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
17989 command.
17990
17991
17992 @node Moderation
17993 @section Moderation
17994 @cindex moderation
17995
17996 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
17997 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
17998 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
17999 get a copy.
18000
18001 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
18002 buffers. Put
18003
18004 @lisp
18005 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
18006 @end lisp
18007
18008 in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
18009
18010 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
18011 supposed to work:
18012
18013 @enumerate
18014 @item
18015 You split your incoming mail by matching on
18016 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
18017 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
18018
18019 @item
18020 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
18021 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
18022
18023 @item
18024 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
18025 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
18026 @kbd{c} command.
18027 @end enumerate
18028
18029 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
18030
18031 @lisp
18032 (setq gnus-moderated-list
18033 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
18034 @end lisp
18035
18036 @node Emacs Enhancements
18037 @section Emacs Enhancements
18038 @cindex Emacs 21
18039
18040 Starting with version 21, Emacs is able to display pictures and stuff,
18041 so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
18042
18043 Gnus-specific tool bars will be used if Tool Bar mode is on. Currently
18044 the group, summary and message buffers have tool bars defined.
18045
18046 MIME image types may be displayed internally if Emacs was built with
18047 appropriate support (see variable @code{image-types}). `X-Face' headers
18048 may be rendered as images internally if you have appropriate support
18049 programs (@pxref{X-Face}). You can play sounds internally if Emacs was
18050 built with suitable audio support; otherwise Gnus will attempt to play
18051 sounds externally.
18052
18053 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
18054 A simplified version of the XEmacs Smiley support for @dfn{emoticons}
18055 (@pxref{Smileys}) is available on graphical displays under the control
18056 of @code{gnus-treat-display-smileys}. Text `smiley' faces---@samp{:-)},
18057 @samp{:-/}, @samp{:-(} and the like---are mapped to pictures which are
18058 displayed instead. The mapping is controlled by a list of regexps
18059 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
18060 @code{smiley-regexp-alist} mapping matched text to image file names. It
18061 contains matches for `smiley', `wry' and `frowny' by default.
18062
18063 There is currently no Emacs support for `Picons' (@pxref{Picons}), but
18064 there is no reason why it couldn't be added.
18065
18066 @node XEmacs Enhancements
18067 @section XEmacs Enhancements
18068 @cindex XEmacs
18069
18070 XEmacs is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has taken
18071 advantage of that.
18072
18073 @menu
18074 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
18075 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
18076 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
18077 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
18078 @end menu
18079
18080
18081 @node Picons
18082 @subsection Picons
18083
18084 @iftex
18085 @iflatex
18086 \include{picons}
18087 @end iflatex
18088 @end iftex
18089
18090 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
18091 good way to do so. Its also a great way to impress people staring
18092 over your shoulder as you read news.
18093
18094 @menu
18095 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
18096 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
18097 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
18098 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
18099 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
18100 @end menu
18101
18102
18103 @node Picon Basics
18104 @subsubsection Picon Basics
18105
18106 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
18107
18108 @iftex
18109 @iflatex
18110 \margindex{}
18111 @end iflatex
18112 @end iftex
18113
18114 @quotation
18115 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
18116 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
18117 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
18118 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
18119 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
18120 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
18121 @code{GIF} formats.
18122 @end quotation
18123
18124 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18125 If you have a permanent connection to the Internet you can use Steve
18126 Kinzler's Picons Search engine by setting
18127 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} to the string @*
18128 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/search.html}.
18129
18130 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18131 Otherwise you need a local copy of his database. For instructions on
18132 obtaining and installing the picons databases, point your Web browser at @*
18133 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}. Gnus expects
18134 picons to be installed into a location pointed to by
18135 @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18136
18137
18138 @node Picon Requirements
18139 @subsubsection Picon Requirements
18140
18141 To have Gnus display Picons for you, you must be running XEmacs
18142 19.13 or greater since all other versions of Emacs aren't yet able to
18143 display images.
18144
18145 Additionally, you must have @code{x} support compiled into XEmacs. To
18146 display color picons which are much nicer than the black & white one,
18147 you also need one of @code{xpm} or @code{gif} compiled into XEmacs.
18148
18149 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18150 If you want to display faces from @code{X-Face} headers, you should have
18151 the @code{xface} support compiled into XEmacs. Otherwise you must have
18152 the @code{netpbm} utilities installed, or munge the
18153 @code{gnus-picons-convert-x-face} variable to use something else.
18154
18155
18156 @node Easy Picons
18157 @subsubsection Easy Picons
18158
18159 To enable displaying picons, simply put the following line in your
18160 @file{~/.gnus} file and start Gnus.
18161
18162 @lisp
18163 (setq gnus-use-picons t)
18164 (setq gnus-treat-display-picons t)
18165 @end lisp
18166
18167 and make sure @code{gnus-picons-database} points to the directory
18168 containing the Picons databases.
18169
18170 Alternatively if you want to use the web piconsearch engine add this:
18171
18172 @lisp
18173 (setq gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18174 "http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch")
18175 @end lisp
18176
18177
18178 @node Hard Picons
18179 @subsubsection Hard Picons
18180
18181 @iftex
18182 @iflatex
18183 \margindex{}
18184 @end iflatex
18185 @end iftex
18186
18187 Gnus can display picons for you as you enter and leave groups and
18188 articles. It knows how to interact with three sections of the picons
18189 database. Namely, it can display the picons newsgroup pictures,
18190 author's face picture(s), and the authors domain. To enable this
18191 feature, you need to select where to get the picons from, and where to
18192 display them.
18193
18194 @table @code
18195
18196 @item gnus-picons-database
18197 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18198 The location of the picons database. Should point to a directory
18199 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
18200 subdirectories. This is only useful if
18201 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} is @code{nil}. Defaults to
18202 @file{/usr/local/faces/}.
18203
18204 @item gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18205 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18206 The URL for the web picons search engine. The only currently known
18207 engine is @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch}. To
18208 workaround network delays, icons will be fetched in the background. If
18209 this is @code{nil} 'the default), then picons are fetched from local
18210 database indicated by @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18211
18212 @item gnus-picons-display-where
18213 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18214 Where the picon images should be displayed. It is @code{picons} by
18215 default (which by default maps to the buffer @samp{*Picons*}). Other
18216 valid places could be @code{article}, @code{summary}, or
18217 @samp{*scratch*} for all I care. Just make sure that you've made the
18218 buffer visible using the standard Gnus window configuration
18219 routines---@pxref{Windows Configuration}.
18220
18221 @item gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18222 @vindex gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18223 Groups that are matched by this regexp won't have their group icons
18224 displayed.
18225
18226 @end table
18227
18228 Note: If you set @code{gnus-use-picons} to @code{t}, it will set up your
18229 window configuration for you to include the @code{picons} buffer.
18230
18231 Now that you've made those decision, you need to add the following
18232 functions to the appropriate hooks so these pictures will get displayed
18233 at the right time.
18234
18235 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18236 @table @code
18237 @item gnus-article-display-picons
18238 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18239 Looks up and displays the picons for the author and the author's domain
18240 in the @code{gnus-picons-display-where} buffer.
18241
18242 @item gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
18243 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18244 Decodes and displays the X-Face header if present.
18245
18246 @end table
18247
18248
18249
18250 @node Picon Useless Configuration
18251 @subsubsection Picon Useless Configuration
18252
18253 @iftex
18254 @iflatex
18255 \margindex{}
18256 @end iflatex
18257 @end iftex
18258
18259 The following variables offer further control over how things are
18260 done, where things are located, and other useless stuff you really
18261 don't need to worry about.
18262
18263 @table @code
18264
18265 @item gnus-picons-news-directories
18266 @vindex gnus-picons-news-directories
18267 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18268 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
18269
18270 @item gnus-picons-user-directories
18271 @vindex gnus-picons-user-directories
18272 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for user
18273 faces. @code{("local" "users" "usenix" "misc")} is the default.
18274
18275 @item gnus-picons-domain-directories
18276 @vindex gnus-picons-domain-directories
18277 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18278 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
18279 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
18280
18281 @item gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18282 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18283 If you don't have @code{xface} support builtin XEmacs, this is the
18284 command to use to convert the @code{X-Face} header to an X bitmap
18285 (@code{xbm}). Defaults to @code{(format "@{ echo '/* Width=48,
18286 Height=48 */'; uncompface; @} | icontopbm | pbmtoxbm > %s"
18287 gnus-picons-x-face-file-name)}
18288
18289 @item gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18290 @vindex gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18291 Names a temporary file to store the @code{X-Face} bitmap in. Defaults
18292 to @code{(format "/tmp/picon-xface.%s.xbm" (user-login-name))}.
18293
18294 @item gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18295 @vindex gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18296 If you have set @code{gnus-picons-display-where} to @code{picons}, your
18297 XEmacs frame will become really cluttered. To alleviate this a bit you
18298 can set @code{gnus-picons-has-modeline-p} to @code{nil}; this will
18299 remove the mode line from the Picons buffer. This is only useful if
18300 @code{gnus-picons-display-where} is @code{picons}.
18301
18302 @item gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18303 @vindex gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18304 If non-nil, display the article buffer before computing the picons.
18305 Defaults to @code{nil}.
18306
18307 @item gnus-picons-display-as-address
18308 @vindex gnus-picons-display-as-address
18309 If @code{t} display textual email addresses along with pictures.
18310 Defaults to @code{t}.
18311
18312 @item gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18313 @vindex gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18314 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
18315 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not builtin your XEmacs.
18316
18317 @item gnus-picons-setup-hook
18318 @vindex gnus-picons-setup-hook
18319 Hook run in the picon buffer, if that is displayed.
18320
18321 @item gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18322 @vindex gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18323 Whether to move point to first empty line when displaying picons. This
18324 has only an effect if `gnus-picons-display-where' has value `article'.
18325
18326 If @code{nil}, display the picons in the @code{From} and
18327 @code{Newsgroups} lines. This is the default.
18328
18329 @item gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18330 @vindex gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18331 Whether to clear the picons cache when exiting gnus. Gnus caches every
18332 picons it finds while it is running. This saves some time in the search
18333 process but eats some memory. If this variable is set to @code{nil},
18334 Gnus will never clear the cache itself; you will have to manually call
18335 @code{gnus-picons-clear-cache} to clear it. Otherwise the cache will be
18336 cleared every time you exit Gnus. Defaults to @code{t}.
18337
18338 @iftex
18339 @iflatex
18340 \margindex{}
18341 @end iflatex
18342 @end iftex
18343
18344 @end table
18345
18346 @node Smileys
18347 @subsection Smileys
18348 @cindex smileys
18349
18350 @iftex
18351 @iflatex
18352 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/BigFace.ps,height=20cm}}
18353 \input{smiley}
18354 @end iflatex
18355 @end iftex
18356
18357 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
18358 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
18359
18360 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
18361 @file{.gnus.el} file:
18362
18363 @lisp
18364 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
18365 @end lisp
18366
18367 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{:-=}, @samp{:-(} and
18368 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
18369 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
18370 text and maps that to file names.
18371
18372 @vindex smiley-nosey-regexp-alist
18373 @vindex smiley-deformed-regexp-alist
18374 Smiley supplies two example conversion alists by default:
18375 @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist} (which matches @samp{:)}, @samp{:(}
18376 and so on), and @code{smiley-nosey-regexp-alist} (which matches
18377 @samp{:-)}, @samp{:-(} and so on).
18378
18379 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist} variable,
18380 which defaults to the value of @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist}.
18381
18382 The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched; the second
18383 element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by the picture;
18384 and the third element is the name of the file to be displayed.
18385
18386 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
18387 files, as well as the color to be used and stuff:
18388
18389 @table @code
18390
18391 @item smiley-data-directory
18392 @vindex smiley-data-directory
18393 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
18394
18395 @item smiley-flesh-color
18396 @vindex smiley-flesh-color
18397 Skin color. The default is @samp{yellow}, which is really racist.
18398
18399 @item smiley-features-color
18400 @vindex smiley-features-color
18401 Color of the features of the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18402
18403 @item smiley-tongue-color
18404 @vindex smiley-tongue-color
18405 Color of the tongue. The default is @samp{red}.
18406
18407 @item smiley-circle-color
18408 @vindex smiley-circle-color
18409 Color of the circle around the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18410
18411 @item smiley-mouse-face
18412 @vindex smiley-mouse-face
18413 Face used for mouse highlighting over the smiley face.
18414
18415 @end table
18416
18417
18418 @node Toolbar
18419 @subsection Toolbar
18420
18421 @table @code
18422
18423 @iftex
18424 @iflatex
18425 \margindex{}
18426 @end iflatex
18427 @end iftex
18428
18429 @item gnus-use-toolbar
18430 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
18431 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
18432 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
18433 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
18434
18435 @item gnus-group-toolbar
18436 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
18437 The toolbar in the group buffer.
18438
18439 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
18440 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
18441 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
18442
18443 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18444 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18445 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
18446
18447 @end table
18448
18449
18450 @node XVarious
18451 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
18452
18453 @table @code
18454 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18455 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18456 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
18457 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
18458 unusual directory structure.
18459
18460 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18461 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18462 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
18463 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
18464
18465 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18466 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18467 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
18468 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
18469 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
18470 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
18471
18472 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18473 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18474 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
18475 default.
18476
18477 @iftex
18478 @iflatex
18479 \margindex{}
18480 @end iflatex
18481 @end iftex
18482
18483 @end table
18484
18485
18486
18487
18488 @node Fuzzy Matching
18489 @section Fuzzy Matching
18490 @cindex fuzzy matching
18491
18492 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
18493 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
18494
18495 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
18496 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
18497 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
18498
18499 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
18500 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
18501 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
18502 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
18503 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
18504
18505
18506 @node Thwarting Email Spam
18507 @section Thwarting Email Spam
18508 @cindex email spam
18509 @cindex spam
18510 @cindex UCE
18511 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
18512
18513 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
18514 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
18515 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
18516 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
18517 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
18518 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
18519 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
18520 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
18521 in the end.
18522
18523 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
18524 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
18525 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
18526 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
18527 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
18528 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
18529
18530 This is annoying.
18531
18532 The way to deal with this is having Gnus split out all spam into a
18533 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
18534
18535 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
18536 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
18537 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
18538 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
18539 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
18540 part of the mail address.)
18541
18542 @lisp
18543 (setq message-default-news-headers
18544 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
18545 @end lisp
18546
18547 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
18548 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
18549
18550 @lisp
18551 (
18552 ...
18553 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
18554 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
18555 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
18556 "spam"))
18557 ...
18558 )
18559 @end lisp
18560
18561 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
18562 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
18563 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
18564 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
18565
18566 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @code{smtp} server
18567 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
18568 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
18569 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
18570 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
18571 your fancy split rule in this way:
18572
18573 @lisp
18574 (
18575 ...
18576 (to "larsi" "misc")
18577 "spam")
18578 @end lisp
18579
18580 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
18581 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
18582 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
18583 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
18584 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
18585
18586 If you are also a lazy net citizen, you will probably prefer complaining
18587 automatically with the @file{gnus-junk.el} package, available FOR FREE
18588 at @* @uref{http://stud2.tuwien.ac.at/~e9426626/gnus-junk.html}.
18589 Since most e-mail spam is sent automatically, this may reconcile the
18590 cosmic balance somewhat.
18591
18592 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
18593 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
18594 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
18595 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
18596
18597
18598 @node Various Various
18599 @section Various Various
18600 @cindex mode lines
18601 @cindex highlights
18602
18603 @table @code
18604
18605 @item gnus-home-directory
18606 All Gnus path variables will be initialized from this variable, which
18607 defaults to @file{~/}.
18608
18609 @item gnus-directory
18610 @vindex gnus-directory
18611 Most Gnus storage path variables will be initialized from this variable,
18612 which defaults to the @samp{SAVEDIR} environment variable, or
18613 @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
18614
18615 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{.gnus.el} file is read.
18616 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
18617 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
18618 @file{.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
18619
18620 @item gnus-default-directory
18621 @vindex gnus-default-directory
18622 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
18623 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
18624 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
18625 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
18626 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
18627 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
18628
18629 @item gnus-verbose
18630 @vindex gnus-verbose
18631 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
18632 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
18633 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
18634 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
18635 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
18636
18637 @item gnus-verbose-backends
18638 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
18639 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
18640 to the Gnus backends instead of Gnus proper.
18641
18642 @item nnheader-max-head-length
18643 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
18644 When the backends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
18645 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
18646 the absolute max length the backends will try to read before giving up
18647 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
18648 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
18649 @code{t}, the backends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
18650 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
18651 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
18652
18653 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
18654 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
18655 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
18656 read when doing the operation described above.
18657
18658 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18659 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18660 @cindex file names
18661 @cindex invalid characters in file names
18662 @cindex characters in file names
18663 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
18664 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
18665 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
18666
18667 @lisp
18668 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18669 '((?: . ?_)))
18670 @end lisp
18671
18672 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
18673 Windows (phooey) systems.
18674
18675 @item gnus-hidden-properties
18676 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
18677 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
18678 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
18679 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
18680
18681 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
18682 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
18683 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
18684 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
18685 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
18686
18687 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
18688 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
18689 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
18690
18691 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18692 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18693
18694 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
18695 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
18696 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
18697 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
18698 group).
18699
18700 IMAP users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
18701
18702
18703 @end table
18704
18705
18706 @node The End
18707 @chapter The End
18708
18709 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
18710 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
18711
18712 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
18713
18714 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
18715
18716 @quotation
18717 @strong{Te Deum}
18718
18719 @sp 1
18720 Not because of victories @*
18721 I sing,@*
18722 having none,@*
18723 but for the common sunshine,@*
18724 the breeze,@*
18725 the largess of the spring.
18726
18727 @sp 1
18728 Not for victory@*
18729 but for the day's work done@*
18730 as well as I was able;@*
18731 not for a seat upon the dais@*
18732 but at the common table.@*
18733 @end quotation
18734
18735
18736 @node Appendices
18737 @chapter Appendices
18738
18739 @menu
18740 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
18741 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
18742 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
18743 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
18744 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
18745 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
18746 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
18747 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
18748 @end menu
18749
18750
18751 @node History
18752 @section History
18753
18754 @cindex history
18755 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
18756 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
18757
18758 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
18759 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
18760 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
18761 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
18762 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
18763
18764 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
18765 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
18766 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
18767 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
18768 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
18769 appropriate name, don't you think?)
18770
18771 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
18772 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
18773 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
18774 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
18775
18776 @menu
18777 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
18778 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
18779 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
18780 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
18781 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
18782 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
18783 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
18784 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
18785 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
18786 * Newest Features:: Features so new that they haven't been written yet.
18787 @end menu
18788
18789
18790 @node Gnus Versions
18791 @subsection Gnus Versions
18792 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
18793 @cindex ding Gnus
18794 @cindex September Gnus
18795 @cindex Quassia Gnus
18796
18797 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
18798 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
18799 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
18800
18801 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
18802 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
18803
18804 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
18805 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
18806
18807 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
18808 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
18809
18810 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
18811 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
18812 1999.
18813
18814 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
18815 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'' --
18816 don't panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away.
18817 Slowly. Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're
18818 out of its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up
18819 to that instead.
18820
18821
18822 @node Other Gnus Versions
18823 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
18824 @cindex Semi-gnus
18825
18826 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
18827 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
18828 Japan. It's based on a library called @sc{semi}, which provides
18829 @sc{mime} capabilities.
18830
18831 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
18832 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
18833 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
18834 @sc{mime} and multilingualization things, especially important for
18835 Japanese users.
18836
18837
18838 @node Why?
18839 @subsection Why?
18840
18841 What's the point of Gnus?
18842
18843 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
18844 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
18845 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
18846 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
18847 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
18848 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
18849 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
18850 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
18851 keep track of millions of people who post?
18852
18853 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
18854 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
18855 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
18856 to separate the newsreader from the backends, Gnus now offers a simple
18857 interface for anybody who wants to write new backends for fetching mail
18858 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
18859 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
18860 every one of you to explore and invent.
18861
18862 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
18863 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
18864
18865
18866 @node Compatibility
18867 @subsection Compatibility
18868
18869 @cindex compatibility
18870 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
18871 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
18872 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
18873
18874 Our motto is:
18875 @quotation
18876 @cartouche
18877 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
18878 @end cartouche
18879 @end quotation
18880
18881 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
18882 their names.
18883
18884 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
18885 Articles}.
18886
18887 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
18888 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
18889 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
18890 important variables have their values copied into their global
18891 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
18892 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
18893
18894 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
18895 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
18896 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
18897 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
18898 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
18899 peculiar results.
18900
18901 @cindex hilit19
18902 @cindex highlighting
18903 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
18904 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
18905 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
18906 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
18907 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
18908 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
18909 Away!
18910
18911 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
18912 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
18913 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
18914 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
18915
18916 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
18917 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
18918 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
18919 to stop doing it the old way.
18920
18921 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
18922
18923 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
18924 @findex gnus-bug
18925 @cindex reporting bugs
18926 @cindex bugs
18927 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
18928 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
18929 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
18930
18931 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
18932 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
18933 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
18934 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
18935 up at you.
18936
18937
18938 @node Conformity
18939 @subsection Conformity
18940
18941 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
18942 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
18943 with, of course.
18944
18945 @table @strong
18946
18947 @item RFC 822
18948 @cindex RFC 822
18949 There are no known breaches of this standard.
18950
18951 @item RFC 1036
18952 @cindex RFC 1036
18953 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
18954
18955 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
18956 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
18957 We do have some breaches to this one.
18958
18959 @table @emph
18960
18961 @item X-Newsreader
18962 @itemx User-Agent
18963 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
18964 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
18965 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
18966 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
18967 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
18968 @end table
18969
18970 @item USEFOR
18971 @cindex USEFOR
18972 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
18973 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
18974 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
18975 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
18976
18977 @end table
18978
18979 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
18980 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
18981 know.
18982
18983
18984 @node Emacsen
18985 @subsection Emacsen
18986 @cindex Emacsen
18987 @cindex XEmacs
18988 @cindex Mule
18989 @cindex Emacs
18990
18991 Gnus should work on :
18992
18993 @itemize @bullet
18994
18995 @item
18996 Emacs 20.3 and up.
18997
18998 @item
18999 XEmacs 20.4 and up.
19000
19001 @end itemize
19002
19003 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
19004 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
19005 Emacs versions.
19006
19007 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
19008 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
19009 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
19010 Emacsen.
19011
19012
19013 @node Gnus Development
19014 @subsection Gnus Development
19015
19016 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
19017 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
19018 propose changes and new features, post patches and new backends. This
19019 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
19020 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
19021 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
19022 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
19023 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
19024
19025 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
19026 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
19027 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
19028 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
19029 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
19030
19031 @cindex Incoming*
19032 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
19033 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
19034 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
19035 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
19036 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
19037
19038 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
19039 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
19040 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
19041 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
19042 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
19043 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
19044 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
19045 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
19046 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
19047 can't be assumed to do so.
19048
19049
19050
19051 @node Contributors
19052 @subsection Contributors
19053 @cindex contributors
19054
19055 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
19056 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
19057 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
19058 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
19059 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
19060 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
19061 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
19062 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
19063 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
19064 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
19065
19066 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for... oops,
19067 wrong show.
19068
19069 @itemize @bullet
19070
19071 @item
19072 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
19073
19074 @item
19075 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
19076 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @sc{mime} and
19077 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
19078 functionality and stuff.
19079
19080 @item
19081 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
19082 well as numerous other things).
19083
19084 @item
19085 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
19086
19087 @item
19088 Justin Sheehy--the FAQ maintainer.
19089
19090 @item
19091 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
19092
19093 @item
19094 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
19095 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
19096
19097 @item
19098 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
19099
19100 @item
19101 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
19102 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19103
19104 @item
19105 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
19106
19107 @item
19108 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
19109
19110 @item
19111 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
19112
19113 @item
19114 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
19115
19116 @item
19117 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
19118 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
19119
19120 @item
19121 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
19122
19123 @item
19124 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
19125
19126 @item
19127 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
19128
19129 @item
19130 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
19131 .newsrc files.
19132
19133 @item
19134 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
19135
19136 @item
19137 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
19138
19139 @item
19140 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
19141
19142 @item
19143 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
19144 well as autoconf support.
19145
19146 @end itemize
19147
19148 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
19149 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
19150
19151 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
19152
19153 Christopher Davis,
19154 Andrew Eskilsson,
19155 Kai Grossjohann,
19156 David KÃ¥gedal,
19157 Richard Pieri,
19158 Fabrice Popineau,
19159 Daniel Quinlan,
19160 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
19161 and
19162 Jack Vinson.
19163
19164 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
19165
19166 Jari Aalto,
19167 Adrian Aichner,
19168 Vladimir Alexiev,
19169 Russ Allbery,
19170 Peter Arius,
19171 Matt Armstrong,
19172 Marc Auslander,
19173 Miles Bader,
19174 Alexei V. Barantsev,
19175 Frank Bennett,
19176 Robert Bihlmeyer,
19177 Chris Bone,
19178 Mark Borges,
19179 Mark Boyns,
19180 Lance A. Brown,
19181 Rob Browning,
19182 Kees de Bruin,
19183 Martin Buchholz,
19184 Joe Buehler,
19185 Kevin Buhr,
19186 Alastair Burt,
19187 Joao Cachopo,
19188 Zlatko Calusic,
19189 Massimo Campostrini,
19190 Castor,
19191 David Charlap,
19192 Dan Christensen,
19193 Kevin Christian,
19194 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
19195 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
19196 Laura Conrad,
19197 Michael R. Cook,
19198 Glenn Coombs,
19199 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
19200 Neil Crellin,
19201 Frank D. Cringle,
19202 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
19203 Andre Deparade,
19204 Ulrik Dickow,
19205 Dave Disser,
19206 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
19207 Joev Dubach,
19208 Michael Welsh Duggan,
19209 Dave Edmondson,
19210 Paul Eggert,
19211 Mark W. Eichin,
19212 Karl Eichwalder,
19213 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
19214 Michael Ernst,
19215 Luc Van Eycken,
19216 Sam Falkner,
19217 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
19218 Sigbjorn Finne,
19219 Sven Fischer,
19220 Paul Fisher,
19221 Decklin Foster,
19222 Gary D. Foster,
19223 Paul Franklin,
19224 Guy Geens,
19225 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
19226 David S. Goldberg,
19227 Michelangelo Grigni,
19228 Dale Hagglund,
19229 D. Hall,
19230 Magnus Hammerin,
19231 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
19232 Raja R. Harinath,
19233 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c ?
19234 P. E. Jareth Hein,
19235 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
19236 Scott Hofmann,
19237 Marc Horowitz,
19238 Gunnar Horrigmo,
19239 Richard Hoskins,
19240 Brad Howes,
19241 Miguel de Icaza,
19242 François Felix Ingrand,
19243 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c ?
19244 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
19245 Lee Iverson,
19246 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
19247 Rajappa Iyer,
19248 Andreas Jaeger,
19249 Adam P. Jenkins,
19250 Randell Jesup,
19251 Fred Johansen,
19252 Gareth Jones,
19253 Simon Josefsson,
19254 Greg Klanderman,
19255 Karl Kleinpaste,
19256 Michael Klingbeil,
19257 Peter Skov Knudsen,
19258 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
19259 Petr Konecny,
19260 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
19261 Thor Kristoffersen,
19262 Jens Lautenbacher,
19263 Martin Larose,
19264 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
19265 Joerg Lenneis,
19266 Carsten Leonhardt,
19267 James LewisMoss,
19268 Christian Limpach,
19269 Markus Linnala,
19270 Dave Love,
19271 Mike McEwan,
19272 Tonny Madsen,
19273 Shlomo Mahlab,
19274 Nat Makarevitch,
19275 Istvan Marko,
19276 David Martin,
19277 Jason R. Mastaler,
19278 Gordon Matzigkeit,
19279 Timo Metzemakers,
19280 Richard Mlynarik,
19281 Lantz Moore,
19282 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
19283 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
19284 Hrvoje Niksic,
19285 Andy Norman,
19286 Fred Oberhauser,
19287 C. R. Oldham,
19288 Alexandre Oliva,
19289 Ken Olstad,
19290 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
19291 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
19292 Ettore Perazzoli,
19293 William Perry,
19294 Stephen Peters,
19295 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
19296 Ulrich Pfeifer,
19297 Matt Pharr,
19298 Andy Piper,
19299 John McClary Prevost,
19300 Bill Pringlemeir,
19301 Mike Pullen,
19302 Jim Radford,
19303 Colin Rafferty,
19304 Lasse Rasinen,
19305 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
19306 Joe Reiss,
19307 Renaud Rioboo,
19308 Roland B. Roberts,
19309 Bart Robinson,
19310 Christian von Roques,
19311 Markus Rost,
19312 Jason Rumney,
19313 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
19314 Jay Sachs,
19315 Dewey M. Sasser,
19316 Conrad Sauerwald,
19317 Loren Schall,
19318 Dan Schmidt,
19319 Ralph Schleicher,
19320 Philippe Schnoebelen,
19321 Andreas Schwab,
19322 Randal L. Schwartz,
19323 Danny Siu,
19324 Matt Simmons,
19325 Paul D. Smith,
19326 Jeff Sparkes,
19327 Toby Speight,
19328 Michael Sperber,
19329 Darren Stalder,
19330 Richard Stallman,
19331 Greg Stark,
19332 Sam Steingold,
19333 Paul Stevenson,
19334 Jonas Steverud,
19335 Paul Stodghill,
19336 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
19337 Kurt Swanson,
19338 Samuel Tardieu,
19339 Teddy,
19340 Chuck Thompson,
19341 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
19342 Philippe Troin,
19343 James Troup,
19344 Trung Tran-Duc,
19345 Jack Twilley,
19346 Aaron M. Ucko,
19347 Aki Vehtari,
19348 Didier Verna,
19349 Vladimir Volovich,
19350 Jan Vroonhof,
19351 Stefan Waldherr,
19352 Pete Ware,
19353 Barry A. Warsaw,
19354 Christoph Wedler,
19355 Joe Wells,
19356 Lee Willis,
19357 Katsumi Yamaoka @c Yamaoka
19358 and
19359 Lloyd Zusman.
19360
19361
19362 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
19363 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
19364 (550kB and counting).
19365
19366 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
19367 sure.
19368
19369 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
19370 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
19371
19372
19373 @node New Features
19374 @subsection New Features
19375 @cindex new features
19376
19377 @menu
19378 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
19379 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.3/5.3.
19380 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
19381 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
19382 @end menu
19383
19384 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
19385 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
19386 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
19387
19388
19389 @node ding Gnus
19390 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
19391
19392 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
19393
19394 @itemize @bullet
19395
19396 @item
19397 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
19398 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
19399
19400 @item
19401 Local spool and several @sc{nntp} servers can be used at once
19402 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
19403
19404 @item
19405 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
19406
19407 @item
19408 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
19409 All the mail backends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
19410 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
19411
19412 @item
19413 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
19414 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
19415 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
19416 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19417
19418 @item
19419 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
19420 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19421
19422 @item
19423 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
19424 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
19425 (@pxref{The Active File}).
19426
19427 @item
19428 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
19429 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
19430
19431 @item
19432 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
19433 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
19434 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19435
19436 @item
19437 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
19438 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
19439 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
19440
19441 @item
19442 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{.gnus}) to avoid cluttering up
19443 the @file{.emacs} file.
19444
19445 @item
19446 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
19447 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19448
19449 @item
19450 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
19451 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
19452
19453 @item
19454 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
19455 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19456
19457 @item
19458 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
19459 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
19460
19461 @item
19462 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
19463 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19464
19465 @item
19466 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
19467
19468 @item
19469 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
19470 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
19471
19472 @item
19473 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
19474 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
19475
19476 @item
19477 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
19478 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
19479
19480 @item
19481 Gnus can fetch FAQs and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
19482
19483 @item
19484 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
19485 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19486
19487 @item
19488 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
19489 Articles}).
19490
19491 @item
19492 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
19493 Buttons}).
19494
19495 @item
19496 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
19497 configuration (@pxref{Windows Configuration}).
19498
19499 @item
19500 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
19501 (@pxref{Buttons}).
19502
19503 @end itemize
19504
19505
19506 @node September Gnus
19507 @subsubsection September Gnus
19508
19509 @iftex
19510 @iflatex
19511 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/september.ps,height=20cm}}
19512 @end iflatex
19513 @end iftex
19514
19515 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
19516
19517 @itemize @bullet
19518
19519 @item
19520 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
19521 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
19522 now obsolete.
19523
19524 @item
19525 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
19526 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
19527 Threading}).
19528
19529 @lisp
19530 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
19531 @end lisp
19532
19533 @item
19534 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
19535 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
19536
19537 @item
19538 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
19539 referred.
19540
19541 @item
19542 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19543
19544 @item
19545 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
19546
19547 @item
19548 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
19549
19550 @lisp
19551 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
19552 @end lisp
19553
19554 @item
19555 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
19556 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
19557
19558 @lisp
19559 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
19560 @end lisp
19561
19562 @item
19563 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
19564 Groups}).
19565
19566 @item
19567 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
19568 Topics}).
19569
19570 @lisp
19571 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
19572 @end lisp
19573
19574 @item
19575 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
19576
19577 @item
19578 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
19579 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
19580
19581 @lisp
19582 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
19583 @end lisp
19584
19585 @item
19586 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
19587 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
19588
19589 @item
19590 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
19591
19592 @item
19593 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
19594 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
19595 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19596
19597 @item
19598 Gnus has a new backend (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
19599 (@pxref{SOUP}).
19600
19601 @item
19602 The Gnus cache is much faster.
19603
19604 @item
19605 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
19606 Groups}).
19607
19608 @item
19609 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
19610 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19611
19612 @item
19613 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
19614 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
19615
19616 @item
19617 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
19618 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
19619
19620 @item
19621 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
19622 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
19623 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
19624
19625 @item
19626 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
19627 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
19628
19629 @item
19630 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
19631
19632 @item
19633 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19634
19635 @item
19636 All mail backends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
19637
19638 @item
19639 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
19640
19641 @item
19642 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
19643 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
19644
19645 @item
19646 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Windows
19647 Configuration}).
19648
19649 @item
19650 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
19651 @iftex
19652 @iflatex
19653 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}}
19654 @end iflatex
19655 @end iftex
19656
19657 @item
19658 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
19659
19660 @lisp
19661 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
19662 @end lisp
19663
19664 @item
19665 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19666
19667 @lisp
19668 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
19669 @end lisp
19670
19671 @item
19672 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
19673
19674 @item
19675 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
19676
19677 @item
19678 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
19679 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19680
19681 @lisp
19682 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
19683 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
19684 @end lisp
19685
19686 @item
19687 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
19688 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
19689
19690 @lisp
19691 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
19692 @end lisp
19693
19694 @item
19695 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
19696 buffer to allow easier treatment.
19697
19698 @item
19699 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
19700
19701 @item
19702 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
19703 Articles}).
19704
19705 @lisp
19706 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
19707 @end lisp
19708
19709 @item
19710 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
19711 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
19712
19713 @lisp
19714 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
19715 @end lisp
19716
19717 @item
19718 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
19719 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19720
19721 @item
19722 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
19723 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19724
19725 @lisp
19726 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
19727 @end lisp
19728
19729 @item
19730 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19731
19732 @item
19733 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
19734
19735 @item
19736 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
19737
19738 @end itemize
19739
19740
19741 @node Red Gnus
19742 @subsubsection Red Gnus
19743
19744 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
19745
19746 @iftex
19747 @iflatex
19748 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/red.ps,height=20cm}}
19749 @end iflatex
19750 @end iftex
19751
19752 @itemize @bullet
19753
19754 @item
19755 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
19756
19757 @item
19758 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
19759 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19760
19761 @item
19762 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
19763 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
19764 Scoring}).
19765
19766 @item
19767 Article washing status can be displayed in the
19768 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
19769
19770 @item
19771 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
19772
19773 @item
19774 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
19775 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
19776
19777 @lisp
19778 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
19779 @end lisp
19780
19781 @item
19782 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
19783 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
19784 been added.
19785
19786 @item
19787 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
19788 Server Internals}).
19789
19790 @item
19791 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
19792 Parameters}).
19793
19794 @item
19795 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
19796
19797 @item
19798 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
19799 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
19800
19801 @item
19802 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
19803 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
19804 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
19805
19806 @item
19807 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
19808 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19809
19810 @item
19811 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
19812 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
19813
19814 @item
19815 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{M-C-_}
19816 (@pxref{Undo}).
19817
19818 @item
19819 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
19820 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19821
19822 @item
19823 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
19824 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19825
19826 @lisp
19827 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
19828 @end lisp
19829
19830 @item
19831 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
19832
19833 @lisp
19834 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
19835 @end lisp
19836
19837 @item
19838 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
19839 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19840
19841 @item
19842 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
19843 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19844
19845 @item
19846 A new command for reading collections of documents
19847 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{M-C-d}
19848 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
19849
19850 @item
19851 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
19852 Marks}).
19853
19854 @item
19855 A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post even when the @sc{nntp}
19856 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
19857
19858 @item
19859 A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
19860 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
19861 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
19862
19863 @item
19864 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
19865 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
19866 Sorting}).
19867
19868 @item
19869 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
19870 Groups}).
19871
19872 @item
19873 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
19874 Commands}).
19875 @iftex
19876 @iflatex
19877 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}}
19878 @end iflatex
19879 @end iftex
19880
19881 @item
19882 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
19883 Variables}).
19884
19885 @item
19886 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
19887 Mail}).
19888
19889 @item
19890 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
19891 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
19892
19893 @item
19894 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
19895
19896 @end itemize
19897
19898
19899 @node Quassia Gnus
19900 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
19901
19902 New features in Gnus 5.6:
19903
19904 @itemize @bullet
19905
19906 @item
19907 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
19908 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See
19909 @pxref{Gnus Unplugged} for the full story.
19910
19911 @item
19912 The @code{nndraft} backend has returned, but works differently than
19913 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
19914 group, which is created automatically.
19915
19916 @item
19917 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
19918 values.
19919
19920 @item
19921 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
19922
19923 @item
19924 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
19925 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
19926
19927 @item
19928 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
19929 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
19930
19931 @item
19932 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
19933
19934 @item
19935 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
19936 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
19937
19938 @item
19939 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
19940
19941 @item
19942 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
19943 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
19944
19945 @item
19946 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
19947 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
19948
19949 @item
19950 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
19951 control over simplification.
19952
19953 @item
19954 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
19955
19956 @item
19957 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
19958 limit.
19959
19960 @item
19961 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
19962
19963 @item
19964 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
19965
19966 @item
19967 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
19968 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
19969 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
19970
19971 @item
19972 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
19973 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
19974
19975 @item
19976 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
19977 text---@kbd{W d}.
19978
19979 @item
19980 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
19981 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
19982
19983 @item
19984 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
19985 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @sc{nntp} servers.
19986
19987 @item
19988 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
19989 has been added.
19990
19991 @item
19992 A history of where mails have been split is available.
19993
19994 @item
19995 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
19996
19997 @item
19998 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
19999 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
20000
20001 @item
20002 A new function for citing in Message has been
20003 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
20004
20005 @item
20006 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
20007
20008 @item
20009 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
20010 been added.
20011
20012 @item
20013 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
20014 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
20015
20016 @item
20017 The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
20018 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
20019
20020 @item
20021 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} backend.
20022
20023 @item
20024 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
20025
20026 @end itemize
20027
20028
20029 @node Newest Features
20030 @subsection Newest Features
20031 @cindex todo
20032
20033 Also known as the @dfn{todo list}. Sure to be implemented before the
20034 next millennium.
20035
20036 Be afraid. Be very afraid.
20037
20038 (That a feature appears in this list doesn't necessarily mean that I've
20039 decided to actually implement it. It just means that I think it sounds
20040 interesting.)
20041
20042 (Yes, this is the actual, up-to-the-second todo list.)
20043
20044 @itemize @bullet
20045
20046 @item
20047 I would like the zombie-page to contain an URL to the source of the
20048 latest version of gnus or some explanation on where to find it.
20049
20050 @item
20051 A way to continue editing the latest Message composition.
20052
20053 @item
20054 @uref{http://www.sonicnet.com/feature/ari3/}
20055
20056 @item
20057 facep is not declared.
20058
20059 @item
20060 Include a section in the manual on why the number of articles
20061 isn't the same in the group buffer and on the SPC prompt.
20062
20063 @item
20064 Interacting with rmail fcc isn't easy.
20065
20066 @item
20067 @example
20068 Hypermail:
20069 <URL:http://www.falch.no/people/pepper/DSSSL-Lite/archives/>
20070 <URL:http://www.eit.com/software/hypermail/hypermail.html>
20071 <URL:http://homer.ncm.com/>
20072 <URL:http://www.yahoo.com/Computers_and_Internet/Internet/World_Wide_Web/HTML_Converters/>
20073 http://www.uwsg.indiana.edu/hypermail/linux/kernel/9610/index.html
20074 <URL:http://union.ncsa.uiuc.edu/HyperNews/get/www/html/converters.html>
20075 http://www.miranova.com/gnus-list/
20076
20077 @end example
20078
20079 @item
20080 @samp{^-- } is made into - in LaTeX.
20081
20082 @item
20083 gnus-kill is much slower than it was in GNUS 4.1.3.
20084
20085 @item
20086 when expunging articles on low score, the sparse nodes keep hanging on?
20087 @item
20088 starting the first time seems to hang Gnus on some systems. Does
20089 NEWGROUPS answer too fast?
20090 @item
20091 nndir doesn't read gzipped files.
20092 @item
20093 FAQ doesn't have an up node?
20094 @item
20095 when moving mail from a procmail spool to the crash-box,
20096 the crash-box is only appropriate to one specific group.
20097 @item
20098 `t' `t' makes X-Faces disappear.
20099 @item
20100 nnmh-be-safe means that crossposted articles will
20101 be marked as unread.
20102 @item
20103 Orphan score entries don't show on "V t" score trace
20104 @item
20105 when clearing out data, the cache data should also be reset.
20106 @item
20107 rewrite gnus-summary-limit-children to be non-recursive
20108 to avoid exceeding lisp nesting on huge groups.
20109 @item
20110 expunged articles are counted when computing scores.
20111 @item
20112 implement gnus-batch-brew-soup
20113 @item
20114 ticked articles aren't easy to read in pick mode -- `n' and
20115 stuff just skips past them. Read articles are the same.
20116 @item
20117 topics that contain just groups with ticked
20118 articles aren't displayed.
20119 @item
20120 nndoc should always allocate unique Message-IDs.
20121 @item
20122 If there are mail groups the first time you use Gnus, Gnus'll
20123 make the mail groups killed.
20124 @item
20125 no "no news is good news" when using topics.
20126 @item
20127 when doing crosspost marking, the cache has to be consulted
20128 and articles have to be removed.
20129 @item
20130 nnweb should fetch complete articles when they are split into several
20131 parts.
20132 @item
20133 scoring on head immediate doesn't work.
20134 @item
20135 finding short score file names takes forever.
20136 @item
20137 canceling articles in foreign groups.
20138 @item
20139 nntp-open-rlogin no longer works.
20140 @item
20141 C-u C-x C-s (Summary) switches to the group buffer.
20142 @item
20143 move nnmail-split-history out to the backends.
20144 @item
20145 nnweb doesn't work properly.
20146 @item
20147 using a virtual server name as `gnus-select-method' doesn't work?
20148 @item
20149 when killing/yanking a group from one topic to another in a slave, the
20150 master will yank it first to one topic and then add it to another.
20151 Perhaps.
20152
20153 @item
20154 warn user about `=' redirection of a group in the active file?
20155 @item
20156 take over the XEmacs menubar and offer a toggle between the XEmacs
20157 bar and the Gnus bar.
20158 @item
20159 @example
20160 push active file and NOV file parsing down into C code.
20161 `(canonize-message-id id)'
20162 `(mail-parent-message-id references n)'
20163 `(parse-news-nov-line &optional dependency-hashtb)'
20164 `(parse-news-nov-region beg end &optional dependency-hashtb fullp)'
20165 `(parse-news-active-region beg end hashtb)'
20166
20167 @end example
20168
20169 @item
20170 nnml .overview directory with splits.
20171 @item
20172 asynchronous cache
20173 @item
20174 postponed commands.
20175 @item
20176 the selected article show have its Subject displayed in its summary line.
20177 @item
20178 when entering groups, get the real number of unread articles from
20179 the server?
20180 @item
20181 sort after gathering threads -- make false roots have the
20182 headers of the oldest orphan with a 0 article number?
20183 @item
20184 nndoc groups should inherit the score files of their parents? Also
20185 inherit copy prompts and save files.
20186 @item
20187 command to start up Gnus (if not running) and enter a mail mode buffer.
20188 @item
20189 allow editing the group description from the group buffer
20190 for backends that support that.
20191 @item
20192 gnus-hide,show-all-topics
20193 @item
20194 groups and sub-topics should be allowed to mingle inside each topic,
20195 and not just list all subtopics at the end.
20196 @item
20197 a command to remove all read articles that are not needed to connect
20198 threads -- `gnus-summary-limit-to-sparse-unread'?
20199 @item
20200 a variable to turn off limiting/cutting of threads in the tree buffer.
20201 @item
20202 a variable to limit how many files are uudecoded.
20203 @item
20204 add zombie groups to a special "New Groups" topic.
20205 @item
20206 server mode command: close/open all connections
20207 @item
20208 put a file date in gnus-score-alist and check whether the file
20209 has been changed before using it.
20210 @item
20211 on exit from a digest group, go to the next article in the parent group.
20212 @item
20213 hide (sub)threads with low score.
20214 @item
20215 when expiring, remove all marks from expired articles.
20216 @item
20217 gnus-summary-limit-to-body
20218 @item
20219 a regexp alist that says what level groups are to be subscribed
20220 on. Eg. -- `(("nnml:" . 1))'.
20221 @item
20222 easier interface to nnkiboze to create ephemeral groups that
20223 contain groups that match a regexp.
20224 @item
20225 allow newlines in <URL:> urls, but remove them before using
20226 the URL.
20227 @item
20228 If there is no From line, the mail backends should fudge one from the
20229 "From " line.
20230 @item
20231 fuzzy simplifying should strip all non-alpha-numerical info
20232 from subject lines.
20233 @item
20234 gnus-soup-brew-soup-with-high-scores.
20235 @item
20236 nntp-ping-before-connect
20237 @item
20238 command to check whether NOV is evil. "list overview.fmt".
20239 @item
20240 when entering a group, Gnus should look through the score
20241 files very early for `local' atoms and set those local variables.
20242 @item
20243 message annotations.
20244 @item
20245 topics are always yanked before groups, and that's not good.
20246 @item
20247 (set-extent-property extent 'help-echo "String to display in minibuf")
20248 to display help in the minibuffer on buttons under XEmacs.
20249 @item
20250 allow group line format spec to say how many articles there
20251 are in the cache.
20252 @item
20253 AUTHINFO GENERIC
20254 @item
20255 `run-with-idle-timer' in gnus-demon.
20256 @item
20257 stop using invisible text properties and start using overlays instead
20258 @item
20259 C-c C-f C-e to add an Expires header.
20260 @item
20261 go from one group to the next; everything is expunged; go to the
20262 next group instead of going to the group buffer.
20263 @item
20264 gnus-renumber-cache -- to renumber the cache using "low" numbers.
20265 @item
20266 record topic changes in the dribble buffer.
20267 @item
20268 `nnfolder-generate-active-file' should look at the folders it
20269 finds and generate proper active ranges.
20270 @item
20271 nneething-look-in-files-for-article-heads variable to control
20272 whether nneething should sniff all files in the directories.
20273 @item
20274 gnus-fetch-article -- start Gnus, enter group, display article
20275 @item
20276 gnus-dont-move-articles-to-same-group variable when respooling.
20277 @item
20278 when messages are crossposted between several auto-expirable groups,
20279 articles aren't properly marked as expirable.
20280 @item
20281 nneething should allow deletion/moving.
20282 @item
20283 TAB on the last button should go to the first button.
20284 @item
20285 if the car of an element in `mail-split-methods' is a function,
20286 and the function returns non-nil, use that as the name of the group(s) to
20287 save mail in.
20288 @item
20289 command for listing all score files that have been applied.
20290 @item
20291 a command in the article buffer to return to `summary' config.
20292 @item
20293 `gnus-always-post-using-current-server' -- variable to override
20294 `C-c C-c' when posting.
20295 @item
20296 nnmail-group-spool-alist -- says where each group should use
20297 as a spool file.
20298 @item
20299 when an article is crossposted to an auto-expirable group, the article
20300 should be marker as expirable.
20301 @item
20302 article mode command/menu for "send region as URL to browser".
20303 @item
20304 on errors, jump to info nodes that explain the error. For instance,
20305 on invalid From headers, or on error messages from the nntp server.
20306 @item
20307 when gathering threads, make the article that has no "Re: " the parent.
20308 Also consult Date headers.
20309 @item
20310 a token in splits to call shrink-window-if-larger-than-buffer
20311 @item
20312 `1 0 A M' to do matches on the active hashtb.
20313 @item
20314 duplicates -- command to remove Gnus-Warning header, use the read
20315 Message-ID, delete the "original".
20316 @item
20317 when replying to several messages at once, put the "other" message-ids
20318 into a See-Also header.
20319 @item
20320 support setext: @url{http://www.bsdi.com/setext/}
20321 @item
20322 support ProleText: @url{http://proletext.clari.net/prole/proletext.html}
20323 @item
20324 when browsing a foreign server, the groups that are already subscribed
20325 should be listed as such and not as "K".
20326 @item
20327 generate font names dynamically.
20328 @item
20329 score file mode auto-alist.
20330 @item
20331 allow nndoc to change/add/delete things from documents. Implement
20332 methods for each format for adding an article to the document.
20333 @item
20334 `gnus-fetch-old-headers' `all' value to incorporate
20335 absolutely all headers there is.
20336 @item
20337 function like `|', but concatenate all marked articles
20338 and pipe them to the process.
20339 @item
20340 cache the list of killed (or active) groups in a separate file. Update
20341 the file whenever we read the active file or the list
20342 of killed groups in the .eld file reaches a certain length.
20343 @item
20344 function for starting to edit a file to put into
20345 the current mail group.
20346 @item
20347 score-find-trace should display the total score of the article.
20348 @item
20349 "ghettozie" -- score on Xref header and nix it out after using it
20350 to avoid marking as read in other groups it has been crossposted to.
20351 @item
20352 look at procmail splitting. The backends should create
20353 the groups automatically if a spool file exists for that group.
20354 @item
20355 function for backends to register themselves with Gnus.
20356 @item
20357 when replying to several process-marked articles,
20358 have all the From end up in Cc headers? Variable to toggle.
20359 @item
20360 command to delete a crossposted mail article from all
20361 groups it has been mailed to.
20362 @item
20363 `B c' and `B m' should be crosspost aware.
20364 @item
20365 hide-pgp should also hide PGP public key blocks.
20366 @item
20367 Command in the group buffer to respool process-marked groups.
20368 @item
20369 `gnus-summary-find-matching' should accept
20370 pseudo-"headers" like "body", "head" and "all"
20371 @item
20372 When buttifying <URL: > things, all white space (including
20373 newlines) should be ignored.
20374 @item
20375 Process-marking all groups in a topic should process-mark
20376 groups in subtopics as well.
20377 @item
20378 Add non-native groups to the list of killed groups when killing them.
20379 @item
20380 nntp-suggest-kewl-config to probe the nntp server and suggest
20381 variable settings.
20382 @item
20383 add edit and forward secondary marks.
20384 @item
20385 nnml shouldn't visit its .overview files.
20386 @item
20387 allow customizing sorting within gathered threads.
20388 @item
20389 `B q' shouldn't select the current article.
20390 @item
20391 nnmbox should support a newsgroups file for descriptions.
20392 @item
20393 allow fetching mail from several pop servers.
20394 @item
20395 Be able to specify whether the saving commands save the original
20396 or the formatted article.
20397 @item
20398 a command to reparent with the child process-marked (cf. `T ^'.).
20399 @item
20400 I think the possibility to send a password with nntp-open-rlogin
20401 should be a feature in Red Gnus.
20402 @item
20403 The `Z n' command should be possible to execute from a mouse click.
20404 @item
20405 more limiting functions -- date, etc.
20406 @item
20407 be able to limit on a random header; on body; using reverse matches.
20408 @item
20409 a group parameter (`absofucking-total-expiry') that will make Gnus expire
20410 even unread articles.
20411 @item
20412 a command to print the article buffer as postscript.
20413 @item
20414 variable to disable password fetching when opening by nntp-open-telnet.
20415 @item
20416 manual: more example servers -- nntp with rlogin, telnet
20417 @item
20418 checking for bogus groups should clean topic alists as well.
20419 @item
20420 canceling articles in foreign groups.
20421 @item
20422 article number in folded topics isn't properly updated by
20423 Xref handling.
20424 @item
20425 Movement in the group buffer to the next unread group should go to the
20426 next closed topic with unread messages if no group can be found.
20427 @item
20428 Extensive info pages generated on the fly with help everywhere --
20429 in the "*Gnus edit*" buffers, for instance.
20430 @item
20431 Topic movement commands -- like thread movement. Up, down, forward, next.
20432 @item
20433 a way to tick/mark as read Gcc'd articles.
20434 @item
20435 a way to say that all groups within a specific topic comes
20436 from a particular server? Hm.
20437 @item
20438 `gnus-article-fill-if-long-lines' -- a function to fill
20439 the article buffer if there are any looong lines there.
20440 @item
20441 `T h' should jump to the parent topic and fold it.
20442 @item
20443 a command to create an ephemeral nndoc group out of a file,
20444 and then splitting it/moving it to some other group/backend.
20445 @item
20446 a group parameter for nnkiboze groups that says that
20447 all kibozed articles should be entered into the cache.
20448 @item
20449 It should also probably be possible to delimit what
20450 `gnus-jog-cache' does -- for instance, work on just some groups, or on
20451 some levels, and entering just articles that have a score higher than
20452 a certain number.
20453 @item
20454 nnfolder should append to the folder instead of re-writing
20455 the entire folder to disk when accepting new messages.
20456 @item
20457 allow all backends to do the proper thing with .gz files.
20458 @item
20459 a backend for reading collections of babyl files nnbabylfolder?
20460 @item
20461 a command for making the native groups into foreign groups.
20462 @item
20463 server mode command for clearing read marks from all groups
20464 from a server.
20465 @item
20466 when following up multiple articles, include all To, Cc, etc headers
20467 from all articles.
20468 @item
20469 a command for deciding what the total score of the current
20470 thread is. Also a way to highlight based on this.
20471 @item
20472 command to show and edit group scores
20473 @item
20474 a gnus-tree-minimize-horizontal to minimize tree buffers
20475 horizontally.
20476 @item
20477 command to generate nnml overview file for one group.
20478 @item
20479 `C-u C-u a' -- prompt for many crossposted groups.
20480 @item
20481 keep track of which mail groups have received new articles (in this session).
20482 Be able to generate a report and perhaps do some marking in the group
20483 buffer.
20484 @item
20485 gnus-build-sparse-threads to a number -- build only sparse threads
20486 that are of that length.
20487 @item
20488 have nnmh respect mh's unseen sequence in .mh_profile.
20489 @item
20490 cache the newsgroups descriptions locally.
20491 @item
20492 asynchronous posting under nntp.
20493 @item
20494 be able to control word adaptive scoring from the score files.
20495 @item
20496 a variable to make `C-c C-c' post using the "current" select method.
20497 @item
20498 `limit-exclude-low-scored-articles'.
20499 @item
20500 if `gnus-summary-show-thread' is a number, hide threads that have
20501 a score lower than this number.
20502 @item
20503 split newsgroup subscription variable up into "order" and "method".
20504 @item
20505 buttonize ange-ftp file names.
20506 @item
20507 a command to make a duplicate copy of the current article
20508 so that each copy can be edited separately.
20509 @item
20510 nnweb should allow fetching from the local nntp server.
20511 @item
20512 record the sorting done in the summary buffer so that
20513 it can be repeated when limiting/regenerating the buffer.
20514 @item
20515 nnml-generate-nov-databses should generate for
20516 all nnml servers.
20517 @item
20518 when the user does commands in the group buffer, check
20519 the modification time of the .newsrc.eld file and use
20520 ask-user-about-supersession-threat. Also warn when trying
20521 to save .newsrc.eld and it has changed.
20522 @item
20523 M-g on a topic will display all groups with 0 articles in
20524 the topic.
20525 @item
20526 command to remove all topic stuff.
20527 @item
20528 allow exploding incoming digests when reading incoming mail
20529 and splitting the resulting digests.
20530 @item
20531 nnsoup shouldn't set the `message-' variables.
20532 @item
20533 command to nix out all nnoo state information.
20534 @item
20535 nnmail-process-alist that calls functions if group names
20536 matches an alist -- before saving.
20537 @item
20538 use buffer-invisibility-spec everywhere for hiding text.
20539 @item
20540 variable to activate each group before entering them
20541 to get the (new) number of articles. `gnus-activate-before-entering'.
20542 @item
20543 command to fetch a Message-ID from any buffer, even
20544 starting Gnus first if necessary.
20545 @item
20546 when posting and checking whether a group exists or not, just
20547 ask the nntp server instead of relying on the active hashtb.
20548 @item
20549 buttonize the output of `C-c C-a' in an apropos-like way.
20550 @item
20551 `G p' should understand process/prefix, and allow editing
20552 of several groups at once.
20553 @item
20554 command to create an ephemeral nnvirtual group that
20555 matches some regexp(s).
20556 @item
20557 nndoc should understand "Content-Type: message/rfc822" forwarded messages.
20558 @item
20559 it should be possible to score "thread" on the From header.
20560 @item
20561 hitting RET on a "gnus-uu-archive" pseudo article should unpack it.
20562 @item
20563 `B i' should display the article at once in the summary buffer.
20564 @item
20565 remove the "*" mark at once when unticking an article.
20566 @item
20567 `M-s' should highlight the matching text.
20568 @item
20569 when checking for duplicated mails, use Resent-Message-ID if present.
20570 @item
20571 killing and yanking groups in topics should be better. If killing one copy
20572 of a group that exists in multiple topics, only that copy should
20573 be removed. Yanking should insert the copy, and yanking topics
20574 should be possible to be interspersed with the other yankings.
20575 @item
20576 command for enter a group just to read the cached articles. A way to say
20577 "ignore the nntp connection; just read from the cache."
20578 @item
20579 `X u' should decode base64 articles.
20580 @item
20581 a way to hide all "inner" cited text, leaving just the most
20582 recently cited text.
20583 @item
20584 nnvirtual should be asynchronous.
20585 @item
20586 after editing an article, gnus-original-article-buffer should
20587 be invalidated.
20588 @item
20589 there should probably be a way to make Gnus not connect to the
20590 server and just read the articles in the server
20591 @item
20592 allow a `set-default' (or something) to change the default
20593 value of nnoo variables.
20594 @item
20595 a command to import group infos from a .newsrc.eld file.
20596 @item
20597 groups from secondary servers have the entire select method
20598 listed in each group info.
20599 @item
20600 a command for just switching from the summary buffer to the group
20601 buffer.
20602 @item
20603 a way to specify that some incoming mail washing functions
20604 should only be applied to some groups.
20605 @item
20606 Message `C-f C-t' should ask the user whether to heed
20607 mail-copies-to: never.
20608 @item
20609 new group parameter -- `post-to-server' that says to post
20610 using the current server. Also a variable to do the same.
20611 @item
20612 the slave dribble files should auto-save to the slave file names.
20613 @item
20614 a group parameter that says what articles to display on group entry, based
20615 on article marks.
20616 @item
20617 a way to visually distinguish slave Gnusae from masters. (Whip instead
20618 of normal logo?)
20619 @item
20620 Use DJ Bernstein "From " quoting/dequoting, where applicable.
20621 @item
20622 Why is hide-citation-maybe and hide-citation different? Also
20623 clear up info.
20624 @item
20625 group user-defined meta-parameters.
20626
20627
20628
20629 From: John Griffith <griffith@@sfs.nphil.uni-tuebingen.de>
20630 @item
20631 I like the option for trying to retrieve the FAQ for a group and I was
20632 thinking it would be great if for those newsgroups that had archives
20633 you could also try to read the archive for that group. Part of the
20634 problem is that archives are spread all over the net, unlike FAQs.
20635 What would be best I suppose is to find the one closest to your site.
20636
20637 In any case, there is a list of general news group archives at @*
20638 @uref{ftp://ftp.neosoft.com/pub/users/claird/news.lists/newsgroup_archives.html}
20639
20640
20641
20642
20643 @item
20644 @example
20645 From: Jason L Tibbitts III <tibbs@@hpc.uh.edu>
20646 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
20647 (lambda ()
20648 (gnus-group-add-parameter group
20649 (cons 'gnus-group-date-last-entered (list (current-time-string))))))
20650
20651 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
20652 "Return the date the group was last read."
20653 (cond ((car (gnus-group-get-parameter gnus-tmp-group 'gnus-group-date-last-entered)))
20654 (t "")))
20655 @end example
20656
20657 @item
20658 tanken var at når du bruker `gnus-startup-file' som prefix (FOO) til å lete
20659 opp en fil FOO-SERVER, FOO-SERVER.el, FOO-SERVER.eld, kan du la den være en
20660 liste hvor du bruker hvert element i listen som FOO, istedet. da kunne man
20661 hatt forskjellige serveres startup-filer forskjellige steder.
20662
20663
20664 @item
20665 LMI> Well, nnbabyl could alter the group info to heed labels like
20666 LMI> answered and read, I guess.
20667
20668 It could also keep them updated (the same for the Status: header of
20669 unix mbox files).
20670
20671 They could be used like this:
20672
20673
20674 @example
20675 `M l <name> RET' add label <name> to current message.
20676 `M u <name> RET' remove label <name> from current message.
20677 `/ l <expr> RET' limit summary buffer according to <expr>.
20678
20679 <expr> would be a boolean expression on the labels, e.g.
20680
20681 `/ l bug & !fixed RET'
20682 @end example
20683
20684 would show all the messages which are labeled `bug' but not labeled
20685 `fixed'.
20686
20687 One could also imagine the labels being used for highlighting, or
20688 affect the summary line format.
20689
20690
20691 @item
20692 Sender: abraham@@dina.kvl.dk
20693
20694 I'd like a gnus-find-file which work like find file, except that it
20695 would recognize things that looks like messages or folders:
20696
20697 - If it is a directory containing numbered files, create an nndir
20698 summary buffer.
20699
20700 - For other directories, create a nneething summary buffer.
20701
20702 - For files matching "\\`From ", create a nndoc/mbox summary.
20703
20704 - For files matching "\\`BABYL OPTIONS:", create a nndoc/baby summary.
20705
20706 - For files matching "\\`[^ \t\n]+:", create an *Article* buffer.
20707
20708 - For other files, just find them normally.
20709
20710 I'd like `nneething' to use this function, so it would work on a
20711 directory potentially containing mboxes or babyl files.
20712
20713 @item
20714 Please send a mail to bwarsaw@@cnri.reston.va.us (Barry A. Warsaw) and
20715 tell him what you are doing.
20716
20717 @item
20718 Currently, I get prompted:
20719
20720 decend into sci?
20721 - type y
20722 decend into sci.something ?
20723 - type n
20724 decend into ucd?
20725
20726 The problem above is that since there is really only one subsection of
20727 science, shouldn't it prompt you for only descending sci.something? If
20728 there was a sci.somethingelse group or section, then it should prompt
20729 for sci? first the sci.something? then sci.somethingelse?...
20730
20731 @item
20732 Ja, det burde være en måte å si slikt. Kanskje en ny variabel?
20733 `gnus-use-few-score-files'? SÃ¥ kunne score-regler legges til den
20734 "mest" lokale score-fila. F. eks. ville no-gruppene betjenes av
20735 "no.all.SCORE", osv.
20736
20737 @item
20738 What i want is for Gnus to treat any sequence or combination of the following
20739 as a single spoiler warning and hide it all, replacing it with a "Next Page"
20740 button:
20741
20742
20743 ^L's
20744
20745 more than n blank lines
20746
20747 more than m identical lines
20748 (which should be replaced with button to show them)
20749
20750 any whitespace surrounding any of the above
20751
20752
20753 @item
20754 Well, we could allow a new value to `gnus-thread-ignore-subject' --
20755 `spaces', or something. (We could even default to that.) And then
20756 subjects that differ in white space only could be considered the
20757 "same" subject for threading purposes.
20758
20759 @item
20760 Modes to preprocess the contents (e.g. jka-compr) use the second form
20761 "(REGEXP FUNCTION NON-NIL)" while ordinary modes (e.g. tex) use the first
20762 form "(REGEXP . FUNCTION)", so you could use it to distinguish between
20763 those two types of modes. (auto-modes-alist, insert-file-contents-literally.)
20764
20765 @item
20766 Under XEmacs -- do funny article marks:
20767 tick - thumb tack
20768 killed - skull
20769 soup - bowl of soup
20770 score below - dim light bulb
20771 score over - bright light bulb
20772
20773 @item
20774 Yes. I think the algorithm is as follows:
20775
20776 @example
20777 Group-mode
20778
20779 show-list-of-articles-in-group
20780 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
20781 if (no-more-articles-in-group-to-select)
20782 if (articles-selected)
20783 start-reading-selected-articles;
20784 junk-unread-articles;
20785 next-group;
20786 else
20787 show-next-page;
20788
20789 else if (key-pressed = '.')
20790 if (consolidated-menus) # same as hide-thread in Gnus
20791 select-thread-under-cursor;
20792 else
20793 select-article-under-cursor;
20794
20795
20796 Article-mode
20797 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
20798 if (more-pages-in-article)
20799 next-page;
20800 else if (more-selected-articles-to-read)
20801 next-article;
20802 else
20803 next-group;
20804 @end example
20805
20806 @item
20807 My precise need here would have been to limit files to Incoming*.
20808 One could think of some `nneething-only-files' variable, but I guess
20809 it would have been unacceptable if one was using many unrelated such
20810 nneething groups.
20811
20812 A more useful approach would be to, in response to the `G D' prompt, be
20813 allowed to say something like: `~/.mail/Incoming*', somewhat limiting
20814 the top-level directory only (in case directories would be matched by
20815 the wildcard expression).
20816
20817 @item
20818 It would be nice if it also handled
20819
20820 <URL:news://sunsite.auc.dk/>
20821
20822 which should correspond to `B nntp RET sunsite.auc.dk' in *Group*.
20823
20824
20825 @item
20826
20827 Take a look at w3-menu.el in the Emacs-W3 distribution - this works out
20828 really well. Each menu is 'named' by a symbol that would be on a
20829 gnus-*-menus (where * would be whatever, but at least group, summary, and
20830 article versions) variable.
20831
20832 So for gnus-summary-menus, I would set to '(sort mark dispose ...)
20833
20834 A value of '1' would just put _all_ the menus in a single 'GNUS' menu in
20835 the main menubar. This approach works really well for Emacs-W3 and VM.
20836
20837
20838 @item
20839 nndoc should take care to create unique Message-IDs for all its
20840 articles.
20841 @item
20842 gnus-score-followup-article only works when you have a summary buffer
20843 active. Make it work when posting from the group buffer as well.
20844 (message-sent-hook).
20845 @item
20846 rewrite gnus-demon to use run-with-idle-timers.
20847
20848 @item
20849 * Enhancements to Gnus:
20850
20851 Add two commands:
20852
20853 * gnus-servers (gnus-start-server-buffer?)--enters Gnus and goes
20854 straight to the server buffer, without opening any connections to
20855 servers first.
20856
20857 * gnus-server-read-server-newsrc--produces a buffer very similar to
20858 the group buffer, but with only groups from that server listed;
20859 quitting this buffer returns to the server buffer.
20860
20861 @item
20862 add a command to check the integrity of an nnfolder folder --
20863 go through the article numbers and see that there are no duplicates,
20864 and stuff.
20865
20866 @item
20867 `unsmileyfy-buffer' to undo smileification.
20868
20869 @item
20870 a command to give all relevant info on an article, including all
20871 secondary marks.
20872
20873 @item
20874 when doing `-request-accept-article', the backends should do
20875 the nnmail duplicate checking.
20876
20877 @item
20878 allow `message-signature-file' to be a function to return the
20879 value of the signature file.
20880
20881 @item
20882 In addition, I would love it if I could configure message-tab so that it
20883 could call `bbdb-complete-name' in other headers. So, some sort of
20884 interface like
20885
20886 (setq message-tab-alist
20887 '((message-header-regexp message-expand-group)
20888 ("^\\(To\\|[cC]c\\|[bB]cc\\)" bbdb-complete-name)))
20889
20890 then you could run the relevant function to complete the information in
20891 the header
20892
20893 @item
20894 cache the newsgroups file locally to avoid reloading it all the time.
20895
20896 @item
20897 a command to import a buffer into a group.
20898
20899 @item
20900 nnweb should allow fetching by Message-ID from servers.
20901
20902 @item
20903 point in the article buffer doesn't always go to the
20904 beginning of the buffer when selecting new articles.
20905
20906 @item
20907 a command to process mark all unread articles.
20908
20909 @item
20910 `gnus-gather-threads-by-references-and-subject' -- first
20911 do gathering by references, and then go through the dummy roots and
20912 do more gathering by subject.
20913
20914 @item
20915 gnus-uu-mark-in-numerical-order -- process mark articles in
20916 article numerical order.
20917
20918 @item
20919 (gnus-thread-total-score
20920 (gnus-id-to-thread (mail-header-id (gnus-summary-article-header))))
20921 bind to a key.
20922
20923 @item
20924 sorting by score is wrong when using sparse threads.
20925
20926 @item
20927 a command to fetch an arbitrary article -- without having to be
20928 in the summary buffer.
20929
20930 @item
20931 a new nncvs backend. Each group would show an article, using
20932 version branches as threading, checkin date as the date, etc.
20933
20934 @item
20935 @url{http://www.dejanews.com/forms/dnsetfilter_exp.html}?
20936 This filter allows one to construct advance queries on the Dejanews
20937 database such as specifying start and end dates, subject, author,
20938 and/or newsgroup name.
20939
20940 @item
20941 new Date header scoring type -- older, newer
20942
20943 @item
20944 use the summary toolbar in the article buffer.
20945
20946 @item
20947 a command to fetch all articles that are less than X days old.
20948
20949 @item
20950 in pick mode, `q' should save the list of selected articles in the
20951 group info. The next time the group is selected, these articles
20952 will automatically get the process mark.
20953
20954 @item
20955 Isn't it possible to (also?) allow M-^ to automatically try the
20956 default server if it fails on the current server? (controlled by a
20957 user variable, (nil, t, 'ask)).
20958
20959 @item
20960 make it possible to cancel articles using the select method for the
20961 current group.
20962
20963 @item
20964 `gnus-summary-select-article-on-entry' or something. It'll default
20965 to t and will select whatever article decided by `gnus-auto-select-first'.
20966
20967 @item
20968 a new variable to control which selection commands should be unselecting.
20969 `first', `best', `next', `prev', `next-unread', `prev-unread' are
20970 candidates.
20971
20972 @item
20973 be able to select groups that have no articles in them
20974 to be able to post in them (using the current select method).
20975
20976 @item
20977 be able to post via DejaNews.
20978
20979 @item
20980 `x' should retain any sortings that have been performed.
20981
20982 @item
20983 allow the user to specify the precedence of the secondary marks. Also
20984 allow them to be displayed separately.
20985
20986 @item
20987 gnus-summary-save-in-pipe should concatenate the results from
20988 the processes when doing a process marked pipe.
20989
20990 @item
20991 a new match type, like Followup, but which adds Thread matches on all
20992 articles that match a certain From header.
20993
20994 @item
20995 a function that can be read from kill-emacs-query-functions to offer
20996 saving living summary buffers.
20997
20998 @item
20999 a function for selecting a particular group which will contain
21000 the articles listed in a list of article numbers/id's.
21001
21002 @item
21003 a battery of character translation functions to translate common
21004 Mac, MS (etc) characters into ISO 8859-1.
21005
21006 @example
21007 (defun article-fix-m$word ()
21008 "Fix M$Word smartquotes in an article."
21009 (interactive)
21010 (save-excursion
21011 (let ((buffer-read-only nil))
21012 (goto-char (point-min))
21013 (while (search-forward "\221" nil t)
21014 (replace-match "`" t t))
21015 (goto-char (point-min))
21016 (while (search-forward "\222" nil t)
21017 (replace-match "'" t t))
21018 (goto-char (point-min))
21019 (while (search-forward "\223" nil t)
21020 (replace-match "\"" t t))
21021 (goto-char (point-min))
21022 (while (search-forward "\224" nil t)
21023 (replace-match "\"" t t)))))
21024 @end example
21025
21026 @item
21027 @example
21028 (add-hook 'gnus-exit-query-functions
21029 (lambda ()
21030 (if (and (file-exists-p nnmail-spool-file)
21031 (> (nnheader-file-size nnmail-spool-file) 0))
21032 (yes-or-no-p "New mail has arrived. Quit Gnus anyways? ")
21033 (y-or-n-p "Are you sure you want to quit Gnus? "))))
21034 @end example
21035
21036 @item
21037 allow message-default-headers to be a function.
21038
21039 @item
21040 new Date score match types -- < > = (etc) that take floating point
21041 numbers and match on the age of the article.
21042
21043 @item
21044 @example
21045 > > > If so, I've got one gripe: It seems that when I fire up gnus 5.2.25
21046 > > > under xemacs-19.14, it's creating a new frame, but is erasing the
21047 > > > buffer in the frame that it was called from =:-O
21048 >
21049 > > Hm. How do you start up Gnus? From the toolbar or with
21050 > > `M-x gnus-other-frame'?
21051 >
21052 > I normally start it up from the toolbar; at
21053 > least that's the way I've caught it doing the
21054 > deed before.
21055 @end example
21056
21057 @item
21058 all commands that react to the process mark should push
21059 the current process mark set onto the stack.
21060
21061 @item
21062 gnus-article-hide-pgp
21063 Selv ville jeg nok ha valgt å slette den dersom teksten matcher
21064 @example
21065 "\\(This\s+\\)?[^ ]+ has been automatically signed by"
21066 @end example
21067 og det er maks hundre tegn mellom match-end og ----linja. Men -det-
21068 er min type heuristikk og langt fra alles.
21069
21070 @item
21071 `gnus-subscribe-sorted' -- insert new groups where they would have been
21072 sorted to if `gnus-group-sort-function' were run.
21073
21074 @item
21075 gnus-(group,summary)-highlight should respect any `face' text props set
21076 on the lines.
21077
21078 @item
21079 use run-with-idle-timer for gnus-demon instead of the
21080 home-brewed stuff for better reliability.
21081
21082 @item
21083 add a way to select which NoCeM type to apply -- spam, troll, etc.
21084
21085 @item
21086 nndraft-request-group should tally auto-save files.
21087
21088 @item
21089 implement nntp-retry-on-break and nntp-command-timeout.
21090
21091 @item
21092 gnus-article-highlight-limit that says when not to highlight (long)
21093 articles.
21094
21095 @item
21096 (nnoo-set SERVER VARIABLE VALUE)
21097
21098 @item
21099 nn*-spool-methods
21100
21101 @item
21102 interrupitng agent fetching of articles should save articles.
21103
21104 @item
21105 command to open a digest group, and copy all the articles there to the
21106 current group.
21107
21108 @item
21109 a variable to disable article body highlights if there's more than
21110 X characters in the body.
21111
21112 @item
21113 handle 480/381 authinfo requests separately.
21114
21115 @item
21116 include the texi/dir file in the distribution.
21117
21118 @item
21119 format spec to "tab" to a position.
21120
21121 @item
21122 Move all prompting to the new `M-n' default style.
21123
21124 @item
21125 command to display all dormant articles.
21126
21127 @item
21128 gnus-auto-select-next makeover -- list of things it should do.
21129
21130 @item
21131 a score match type that adds scores matching on From if From has replied
21132 to something someone else has said.
21133
21134 @item
21135 Read Netscape discussion groups:
21136 snews://secnews.netscape.com/netscape.communicator.unix
21137
21138 @item
21139 One command to edit the original version if an article, and one to edit
21140 the displayed version.
21141
21142 @item
21143 @kbd{T v} -- make all process-marked articles the children of the
21144 current article.
21145
21146 @item
21147 Switch from initial text to the new default text mechanism.
21148
21149 @item
21150 How about making it possible to expire local articles? Will it be
21151 possible to make various constraints on when an article can be
21152 expired, e.g. (read), (age > 14 days), or the more interesting (read
21153 & age > 14 days)?
21154
21155 @item
21156 New limit command---limit to articles that have a certain string
21157 in the head or body.
21158
21159 @item
21160 Allow breaking lengthy @sc{nntp} commands.
21161
21162 @item
21163 gnus-article-highlight-limit, to disable highlighting in big articles.
21164
21165 @item
21166 Editing an article should put the article to be edited
21167 in a special, unique buffer.
21168
21169 @item
21170 A command to send a mail to the admin-address group param.
21171
21172 @item
21173 A Date scoring type that will match if the article
21174 is less than a certain number of days old.
21175
21176 @item
21177 New spec: %~(tab 56) to put point on column 56
21178
21179 @item
21180 Allow Gnus Agent scoring to use normal score files.
21181
21182 @item
21183 Rething the Agent active file thing. `M-g' doesn't update the active
21184 file, for instance.
21185
21186 @item
21187 With dummy roots, `^' and then selecing the first article
21188 in any other dummy thread will make Gnus highlight the
21189 dummy root instead of the first article.
21190
21191 @item
21192 Propagate all group properties (marks, article numbers, etc) up to the
21193 topics for displaying.
21194
21195 @item
21196 `n' in the group buffer with topics should go to the next group
21197 with unread articles, even if that group is hidden in a topic.
21198
21199 @item
21200 gnus-posting-styles doesn't work in drafts.
21201
21202 @item
21203 gnus-summary-limit-include-cached is slow when there are
21204 many articles in the cache, since it regenerates big parts of the
21205 summary buffer for each article.
21206
21207 @item
21208 Implement gnus-batch-brew-soup.
21209
21210 @item
21211 Group parameters and summary commands for un/subscribing to mailing
21212 lists.
21213
21214 @item
21215 Introduce nnmail-home-directory.
21216
21217 @item
21218 gnus-fetch-group and friends should exit Gnus when the user
21219 exits the group.
21220
21221 @item
21222 The jingle is only played on the second invocation of Gnus.
21223
21224 @item
21225 Bouncing articles should do MIME.
21226
21227 @item
21228 Crossposted articles should "inherit" the % or @ mark from the other
21229 groups it has been crossposted to, or something. (Agent.)
21230
21231 @item
21232 If point is on a group that appears multiple times in topics, and
21233 you press `l', point will move to the first instance of the group.
21234
21235 @item
21236 A spec for the group line format to display the number of
21237 agent-downloaded articles in the group.
21238
21239 @item
21240 Some nntp servers never respond when posting, so there should be a
21241 timeout for all commands.
21242
21243 @item
21244 When stading on a topic line and `t'-ing, point goes to the last line.
21245 It should go somewhere else.
21246
21247 @item
21248 I'm having trouble accessing a newsgroup with a "+" in its name with
21249 Gnus. There is a new newsgroup on msnews.microsoft.com named
21250 "microsoft.public.multimedia.directx.html+time" that I'm trying to
21251 access as
21252 "nntp+msnews.microsoft.com:microsoft.public.multimedia.directx.html+time"
21253 but it gives an error that it cant access the group.
21254
21255 Is the "+" character illegal in newsgroup names? Is there any way in
21256 Gnus to work around this? (gnus 5.6.45 - XEmacs 20.4)
21257
21258 @item
21259
21260 When `#F', do:
21261
21262 @example
21263 Subject: Answer to your mails 01.01.1999-01.05.1999
21264 --text follows this line--
21265 Sorry I killfiled you...
21266
21267 Under the subject "foo", you wrote on 01.01.1999:
21268 > bar
21269 Under the subject "foo1", you wrote on 01.01.1999:
21270 > bar 1
21271 @end example
21272
21273 @item
21274 Allow "orphan" scores in the Agent scoring.
21275
21276 @item
21277 @example
21278 - Edit article's summary line.
21279 - End edit
21280 - Sort lines in buffer by subject
21281
21282 --> the old subject line appears in Summary buffer, not the one that was
21283 just changed to.
21284 @end example
21285
21286
21287 @item
21288 Remove list identifiers from the subject in the summary when doing `^'
21289 and the like.
21290
21291 @item
21292 Have the Agent write out articles, one by one, as it retrieves them,
21293 to avoid having to re-fetch them all if Emacs should crash while
21294 fetching.
21295
21296 @item
21297 Be able to forward groups of messages as MIME digests.
21298
21299 @item
21300 nnweb should include the "get whole article" article when getting articles.
21301
21302 @item
21303 When I type W W c (gnus-article-hide-citation) in the summary
21304 buffer, the citations are revealed, but the [+] buttons don't turn
21305 into [-] buttons. (If I click on one of the [+] buttons, it does
21306 turn into a [-] button.)
21307
21308 @item
21309 Perhaps there should be a command to "attach" a buffer of comments to
21310 a message? That is, `B WHATEVER', you're popped into a buffer, write
21311 something, end with `C-c C-c', and then the thing you've written gets
21312 to be the child of the message you're commenting.
21313
21314 @item
21315 Handle external-body parts.
21316
21317 @item
21318 When renaming a group name, nnmail-split-history does not get the group
21319 name renamed.
21320
21321 @item
21322 Allow mail splitting on bodies when using advanced mail splitting.
21323
21324 @lisp
21325 (body "whatever.text")
21326 @end lisp
21327
21328 @item
21329 Be able to run `J u' from summary buffers.
21330
21331 @item
21332 Solve the halting problem.
21333
21334 @c TODO
21335 @end itemize
21336
21337 @iftex
21338
21339 @page
21340 @node The Manual
21341 @section The Manual
21342 @cindex colophon
21343 @cindex manual
21344
21345 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
21346 either @code{texi2dvi}
21347 @iflatex
21348 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
21349 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
21350 @end iflatex
21351 to get what you hold in your hands now.
21352
21353 The following conventions have been used:
21354
21355 @enumerate
21356
21357 @item
21358 This is a @samp{string}
21359
21360 @item
21361 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
21362
21363 @item
21364 This is a @file{file}
21365
21366 @item
21367 This is a @code{symbol}
21368
21369 @end enumerate
21370
21371 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
21372 mean:
21373
21374 @lisp
21375 (setq flargnoze "yes")
21376 @end lisp
21377
21378 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
21379
21380 @lisp
21381 (setq flumphel 'yes)
21382 @end lisp
21383
21384 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
21385 ever get them confused.
21386
21387 @iflatex
21388 @c @head
21389 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
21390 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
21391 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
21392 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
21393 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
21394 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
21395 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
21396 @end iflatex
21397
21398 @end iftex
21399
21400
21401 @node On Writing Manuals
21402 @section On Writing Manuals
21403
21404 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
21405 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
21406 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
21407 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
21408 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
21409 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
21410 hand in hand.
21411
21412 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
21413 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
21414 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
21415 started with Gnus.
21416
21417 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
21418 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
21419
21420
21421 @page
21422 @node Terminology
21423 @section Terminology
21424
21425 @cindex terminology
21426 @table @dfn
21427
21428 @item news
21429 @cindex news
21430 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
21431 News is generally fetched from a nearby @sc{nntp} server, and is
21432 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
21433 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
21434 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
21435
21436 @item mail
21437 @cindex mail
21438 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
21439 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
21440 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
21441 not posting, and replying is not following up.
21442
21443 @item reply
21444 @cindex reply
21445 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
21446
21447 @item follow up
21448 @cindex follow up
21449 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
21450 are reading.
21451
21452 @item backend
21453 @cindex backend
21454 Gnus gets fed articles from a number of backends, both news and mail
21455 backends. Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this
21456 is all done by the backends.
21457
21458 @item native
21459 @cindex native
21460 Gnus will always use one method (and backend) as the @dfn{native}, or
21461 default, way of getting news.
21462
21463 @item foreign
21464 @cindex foreign
21465 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
21466 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary backends for getting
21467 news.
21468
21469 @item secondary
21470 @cindex secondary
21471 Secondary backends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
21472 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
21473
21474 @item article
21475 @cindex article
21476 A message that has been posted as news.
21477
21478 @item mail message
21479 @cindex mail message
21480 A message that has been mailed.
21481
21482 @item message
21483 @cindex message
21484 A mail message or news article
21485
21486 @item head
21487 @cindex head
21488 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
21489 put.
21490
21491 @item body
21492 @cindex body
21493 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
21494 body.
21495
21496 @item header
21497 @cindex header
21498 A line from the head of an article.
21499
21500 @item headers
21501 @cindex headers
21502 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
21503 collection of @sc{nov} lines.
21504
21505 @item @sc{nov}
21506 @cindex nov
21507 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the backend for the headers of all
21508 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
21509 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
21510 normal @sc{head} format.
21511
21512 @item level
21513 @cindex levels
21514 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
21515 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
21516 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
21517 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
21518 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
21519 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
21520
21521 @item killed groups
21522 @cindex killed groups
21523 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
21524 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
21525
21526 @item zombie groups
21527 @cindex zombie groups
21528 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
21529
21530 @item active file
21531 @cindex active file
21532 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
21533 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
21534 is rather large, as you might surmise.
21535
21536 @item bogus groups
21537 @cindex bogus groups
21538 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
21539 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
21540 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
21541
21542 @item activating
21543 @cindex activating groups
21544 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
21545 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
21546 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
21547
21548 @item server
21549 @cindex server
21550 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
21551
21552 @item select method
21553 @cindex select method
21554 A structure that specifies the backend, the server and the virtual
21555 server settings.
21556
21557 @item virtual server
21558 @cindex virtual server
21559 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
21560 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
21561 whole is a virtual server.
21562
21563 @item washing
21564 @cindex washing
21565 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
21566 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
21567 original.
21568
21569 @item ephemeral groups
21570 @cindex ephemeral groups
21571 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
21572 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
21573 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
21574
21575 @item solid groups
21576 @cindex solid groups
21577 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
21578 group buffer are solid groups.
21579
21580 @item sparse articles
21581 @cindex sparse articles
21582 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
21583 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
21584
21585 @item threading
21586 @cindex threading
21587 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
21588 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
21589
21590 @item root
21591 @cindex root
21592 @cindex thread root
21593 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
21594 articles in the thread.
21595
21596 @item parent
21597 @cindex parent
21598 An article that has responses.
21599
21600 @item child
21601 @cindex child
21602 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
21603
21604 @item digest
21605 @cindex digest
21606 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
21607 specified by RFC 1153.
21608
21609 @end table
21610
21611
21612 @page
21613 @node Customization
21614 @section Customization
21615 @cindex general customization
21616
21617 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
21618 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
21619 for some quite common situations.
21620
21621 @menu
21622 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
21623 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
21624 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
21625 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
21626 @end menu
21627
21628
21629 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
21630 @subsection Slow/Expensive @sc{nntp} Connection
21631
21632 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
21633 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
21634 Gnus has to get from the @sc{nntp} server.
21635
21636 @table @code
21637
21638 @item gnus-read-active-file
21639 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
21640 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
21641 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
21642 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
21643 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
21644
21645 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
21646 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
21647 the @sc{nntp} server will not be very fast. Not all @sc{nntp} servers
21648 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
21649 @end table
21650
21651
21652 @node Slow Terminal Connection
21653 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
21654
21655 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
21656 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
21657 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
21658
21659 @table @code
21660
21661 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
21662 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
21663 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
21664 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
21665 horizontal and vertical recentering.
21666
21667 @item gnus-visible-headers
21668 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
21669 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
21670 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
21671 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
21672
21673 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
21674 @lisp
21675 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
21676 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
21677 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
21678 @end lisp
21679
21680 @item gnus-use-full-window
21681 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
21682 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
21683 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
21684 want to read them anyway.
21685
21686 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
21687 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
21688 hidden initially.
21689
21690 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
21691 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
21692 lines, which might save some time.
21693 @end table
21694
21695
21696 @node Little Disk Space
21697 @subsection Little Disk Space
21698 @cindex disk space
21699
21700 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
21701 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
21702
21703 @table @code
21704
21705 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
21706 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
21707 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
21708 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21709 default.
21710
21711 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
21712 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
21713 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
21714 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21715 default.
21716
21717 @item gnus-save-killed-list
21718 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
21719 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
21720 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
21721 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
21722
21723 @end table
21724
21725
21726 @node Slow Machine
21727 @subsection Slow Machine
21728 @cindex slow machine
21729
21730 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
21731 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
21732
21733 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
21734 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
21735
21736 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
21737 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
21738 summary buffer faster.
21739
21740
21741 @page
21742 @node Troubleshooting
21743 @section Troubleshooting
21744 @cindex troubleshooting
21745
21746 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
21747 problems, really.
21748
21749 Ahem.
21750
21751 @enumerate
21752
21753 @item
21754 Make sure your computer is switched on.
21755
21756 @item
21757 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
21758 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
21759 Gnus will work.
21760
21761 @item
21762 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
21763 like @samp{Gnus v5.46; nntp 4.0} you have the right files loaded. If,
21764 on the other hand, you get something like @samp{NNTP 3.x} or @samp{nntp
21765 flee}, you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
21766
21767 @item
21768 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a FAQ and a
21769 how-to.
21770
21771 @item
21772 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
21773 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
21774 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
21775 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
21776 something like that.
21777 @end enumerate
21778
21779 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
21780
21781 @cindex bugs
21782 @cindex reporting bugs
21783
21784 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
21785 @findex gnus-bug
21786 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
21787 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
21788 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
21789 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
21790
21791 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
21792 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
21793 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
21794 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
21795 time.
21796
21797 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
21798 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
21799 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
21800 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
21801 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
21802 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
21803
21804 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
21805 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
21806 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
21807 the bug report.
21808
21809 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
21810 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful.
21811
21812 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
21813 @cindex ding mailing list
21814 You can also ask on the ding mailing list---@samp{ding@@gnus.org}.
21815 Write to @samp{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
21816
21817
21818 @page
21819 @node Gnus Reference Guide
21820 @section Gnus Reference Guide
21821
21822 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
21823 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
21824 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
21825 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
21826 it.
21827
21828 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
21829 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
21830 backends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
21831 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
21832 and general methods of operation.
21833
21834 @menu
21835 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
21836 * Backend Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
21837 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
21838 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
21839 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
21840 * Group Info:: The group info format.
21841 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
21842 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
21843 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
21844 @end menu
21845
21846
21847 @node Gnus Utility Functions
21848 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
21849 @cindex Gnus utility functions
21850 @cindex utility functions
21851 @cindex functions
21852 @cindex internal variables
21853
21854 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
21855 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
21856 Below is a list of the most common ones.
21857
21858 @table @code
21859
21860 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
21861 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
21862 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
21863
21864 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
21865 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
21866 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
21867
21868 @item gnus-group-real-name
21869 @findex gnus-group-real-name
21870 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
21871 name.
21872
21873 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
21874 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
21875 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
21876 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
21877
21878 @item gnus-get-info
21879 @findex gnus-get-info
21880 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
21881
21882 @item gnus-group-unread
21883 @findex gnus-group-unread
21884 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
21885 unknown.
21886
21887 @item gnus-active
21888 @findex gnus-active
21889 The active entry for @var{group}.
21890
21891 @item gnus-set-active
21892 @findex gnus-set-active
21893 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
21894
21895 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
21896 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
21897 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
21898 exit.
21899
21900 @item gnus-continuum-version
21901 @findex gnus-continuum-version
21902 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
21903 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
21904 versions.
21905
21906 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
21907 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
21908 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
21909
21910 @item gnus-news-group-p
21911 @findex gnus-news-group-p
21912 Says whether @var{group} came from a news backend.
21913
21914 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
21915 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
21916 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
21917
21918 @item gnus-server-to-method
21919 @findex gnus-server-to-method
21920 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
21921
21922 @item gnus-server-equal
21923 @findex gnus-server-equal
21924 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
21925
21926 @item gnus-group-native-p
21927 @findex gnus-group-native-p
21928 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
21929
21930 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
21931 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
21932 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
21933
21934 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
21935 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
21936 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
21937
21938 @item group-group-find-parameter
21939 @findex group-group-find-parameter
21940 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
21941 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
21942
21943 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
21944 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
21945 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
21946
21947 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
21948 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
21949 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
21950
21951 @item gnus-check-backend-function
21952 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
21953 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the backend
21954 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
21955
21956 @lisp
21957 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
21958 @result{} t
21959 @end lisp
21960
21961 @item gnus-read-method
21962 @findex gnus-read-method
21963 Prompts the user for a select method.
21964
21965 @end table
21966
21967
21968 @node Backend Interface
21969 @subsection Backend Interface
21970
21971 Gnus doesn't know anything about @sc{nntp}, spools, mail or virtual
21972 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
21973 server is a @dfn{backend} and some @dfn{backend variables}. As examples
21974 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
21975 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
21976 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
21977
21978 When Gnus asks for information from a backend---say @code{nntp}---on
21979 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
21980 function parameters. (If not, the backend should use the ``current''
21981 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
21982 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
21983 been opened, the function should fail.
21984
21985 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
21986 name. Take this example:
21987
21988 @lisp
21989 (nntp "odd-one"
21990 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
21991 (nntp-port-number 4324))
21992 @end lisp
21993
21994 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
21995 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
21996
21997 The backends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
21998 The standard backends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
21999 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
22000
22001 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
22002 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
22003 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
22004
22005 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
22006 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
22007 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
22008 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
22009 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
22010 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
22011 return value.
22012
22013 Some backends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} backends, and
22014 some might be said not to be. The latter are backends that generally
22015 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
22016 -- they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
22017 more.
22018
22019 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary backend
22020 @code{nnchoke}.
22021
22022 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
22023
22024 @menu
22025 * Required Backend Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
22026 * Optional Backend Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
22027 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
22028 * Writing New Backends:: Extending old backends.
22029 * Hooking New Backends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
22030 * Mail-like Backends:: Some tips on mail backends.
22031 @end menu
22032
22033
22034 @node Required Backend Functions
22035 @subsubsection Required Backend Functions
22036
22037 @table @code
22038
22039 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
22040
22041 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
22042 @code{Message-ID}s. Current backends do not fully support either---only
22043 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most backends do not support
22044 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
22045
22046 The result data should either be HEADs or NOV lines, and the result
22047 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
22048 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
22049 of HEADs and NOV lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
22050
22051 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching "extra
22052 headers", in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
22053 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
22054 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
22055 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the backend finds it
22056 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
22057 number, do maximum fetches.
22058
22059 Here's an example HEAD:
22060
22061 @example
22062 221 1056 Article retrieved.
22063 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
22064 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
22065 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
22066 Subject: Re: Something very droll
22067 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
22068 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
22069 Lines: 26
22070 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
22071 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
22072 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
22073 .
22074 @end example
22075
22076 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
22077 these in the data buffer.
22078
22079 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
22080
22081 @example
22082 headers = *head
22083 head = error / valid-head
22084 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
22085 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
22086 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
22087 header = <text> eol
22088 @end example
22089
22090 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
22091 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
22092 separated by tabs.
22093
22094 @example
22095 nov-buffer = *nov-line
22096 nov-line = 8*9 [ field <TAB> ] eol
22097 field = <text except TAB>
22098 @end example
22099
22100 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
22101 @pxref{Headers}.
22102
22103
22104 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
22105
22106 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
22107 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
22108
22109 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The backend
22110 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
22111 server. In fact, it should do so.
22112
22113 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
22114 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
22115
22116
22117 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
22118
22119 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
22120 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
22121 reason.
22122
22123 There should be no data returned.
22124
22125
22126 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
22127
22128 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the backend
22129 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that backend
22130 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
22131 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
22132
22133 There should be no data returned.
22134
22135
22136 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
22137
22138 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
22139 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
22140 non-@code{nil} vlue. This function should under no circumstances
22141 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
22142
22143 There should be no data returned.
22144
22145
22146 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
22147
22148 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
22149
22150 There should be no data returned.
22151
22152
22153 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
22154
22155 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
22156 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
22157 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
22158 it would be nice if that were possible.
22159
22160 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
22161 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
22162 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
22163 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
22164 into its article buffer.
22165
22166 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
22167 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
22168 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
22169 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
22170 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
22171 on successful article retrieval.
22172
22173
22174 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
22175
22176 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
22177 making @var{group} the current group.
22178
22179 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
22180 the current group.
22181
22182 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
22183
22184 @example
22185 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
22186 @end example
22187
22188 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
22189 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
22190 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
22191 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
22192 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
22193 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
22194 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
22195 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader.
22196
22197 @example
22198 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
22199 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
22200 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
22201 @end example
22202
22203
22204 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
22205
22206 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
22207 a no-op on most backends.
22208
22209 There should be no data returned.
22210
22211
22212 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
22213
22214 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
22215 @emph{all}.
22216
22217 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
22218
22219 @example
22220 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
22221 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
22222 @end example
22223
22224 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
22225 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag.
22226
22227 @example
22228 active-file = *active-line
22229 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
22230 name = <string>
22231 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
22232 @end example
22233
22234 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
22235 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
22236 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
22237
22238
22239 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
22240
22241 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
22242 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
22243 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
22244 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
22245 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
22246 clear if the posting could not be completed.
22247
22248 There should be no result data from this function.
22249
22250 @end table
22251
22252
22253 @node Optional Backend Functions
22254 @subsubsection Optional Backend Functions
22255
22256 @table @code
22257
22258 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
22259
22260 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
22261 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
22262 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
22263
22264 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
22265 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
22266 former is in the same format as the data from
22267 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
22268 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
22269
22270 @example
22271 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
22272 @end example
22273
22274
22275 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
22276
22277 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the backend for
22278 alterations. This comes in handy if the backend really carries all the
22279 information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
22280 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
22281 should return the (altered) group info.
22282
22283 There should be no result data from this function.
22284
22285
22286 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
22287
22288 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
22289 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
22290 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
22291 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
22292 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
22293 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
22294 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
22295 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
22296
22297 There should be no result data from this function.
22298
22299
22300 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
22301
22302 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
22303 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
22304 @code{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some backends (such as @sc{imap}) however carry
22305 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
22306 propagate the mark information to the server.
22307
22308 ACTION is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
22309
22310 @example
22311 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
22312 @end example
22313
22314 Range is a range of articles you wish to update marks on. Action is
22315 @code{set}, @code{add} or @code{del}, respectively used for removing all
22316 existing marks and setting them as specified, adding (preserving the
22317 marks not mentioned) mark and removing (preserving the marks not
22318 mentioned) marks. Mark is a list of marks; where each mark is a symbol.
22319 Currently used marks are @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply},
22320 @code{expire}, @code{killed}, @code{dormant}, @code{save},
22321 @code{download} and @code{unsend}, but your backend should, if possible,
22322 not limit itself to these.
22323
22324 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
22325 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
22326 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
22327 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
22328
22329 An example action list:
22330
22331 @example
22332 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
22333 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
22334 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
22335 @end example
22336
22337 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
22338 mark on (currently not used for anything).
22339
22340 There should be no result data from this function.
22341
22342 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
22343
22344 If the user tries to set a mark that the backend doesn't like, this
22345 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
22346 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
22347 @var{mark}. If the backend doesn't care, it must return the original
22348 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
22349
22350 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
22351 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
22352 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
22353 expirable.
22354
22355 There should be no result data from this function.
22356
22357
22358 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
22359
22360 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
22361 request that the backend check for incoming articles, in one way or
22362 another. A mail backend will typically read the spool file or query the
22363 POP server when this function is invoked. The @var{group} doesn't have
22364 to be heeded---if the backend decides that it is too much work just
22365 scanning for a single group, it may do a total scan of all groups. It
22366 would be nice, however, to keep things local if that's practical.
22367
22368 There should be no result data from this function.
22369
22370
22371 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
22372
22373 The result data from this function should be a description of
22374 @var{group}.
22375
22376 @example
22377 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
22378 name = <string>
22379 description = <text>
22380 @end example
22381
22382 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
22383
22384 The result data from this function should be the description of all
22385 groups available on the server.
22386
22387 @example
22388 description-buffer = *description-line
22389 @end example
22390
22391
22392 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
22393
22394 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
22395 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date
22396 format. The data should be in the active buffer format.
22397
22398
22399 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
22400
22401 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
22402
22403 There should be no return data.
22404
22405
22406 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
22407
22408 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
22409 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
22410 numbers.) It is left up to the backend to decide how old articles
22411 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
22412 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
22413 they are.
22414
22415 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
22416 able to delete.
22417
22418 There should be no result data returned.
22419
22420
22421 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM
22422 &optional LAST)
22423
22424 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
22425 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
22426
22427 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
22428 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
22429 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
22430 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
22431 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
22432 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
22433
22434 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
22435 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
22436 optimizations.
22437
22438 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
22439 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
22440
22441 There should be no data returned.
22442
22443
22444 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
22445
22446 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
22447 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
22448 this function in short order.
22449
22450 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
22451 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
22452
22453 There should be no data returned.
22454
22455
22456 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
22457
22458 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
22459 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
22460
22461 There should be no data returned.
22462
22463
22464 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
22465
22466 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
22467 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
22468 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
22469
22470 There should be no data returned.
22471
22472
22473 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
22474
22475 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
22476 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
22477
22478 There should be no data returned.
22479
22480 @end table
22481
22482
22483 @node Error Messaging
22484 @subsubsection Error Messaging
22485
22486 @findex nnheader-report
22487 @findex nnheader-get-report
22488 The backends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
22489 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
22490 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the backend
22491 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
22492 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
22493 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
22494
22495 @lisp
22496 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
22497
22498 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
22499 @end lisp
22500
22501 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
22502 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
22503 recently reported message for the backend in question. This function
22504 takes one argument---the server symbol.
22505
22506 Internally, these functions access @var{backend}@code{-status-string},
22507 so the @code{nnchoke} backend will have its error message stored in
22508 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
22509
22510
22511 @node Writing New Backends
22512 @subsubsection Writing New Backends
22513
22514 Many backends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
22515 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
22516 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
22517 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
22518 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
22519 editing articles.
22520
22521 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
22522 backends when writing new backends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
22523 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
22524
22525 All the backends declare their public variables and functions by using a
22526 package called @code{nnoo}.
22527
22528 To inherit functions from other backends (and allow other backends to
22529 inherit functions from the current backend), you should use the
22530 following macros:
22531
22532 @table @code
22533
22534 @item nnoo-declare
22535 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
22536 parameters. For instance:
22537
22538 @lisp
22539 (nnoo-declare nndir
22540 nnml nnmh)
22541 @end lisp
22542
22543 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
22544 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
22545
22546 @item defvoo
22547 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
22548 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
22549 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
22550
22551 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
22552 variables in the parent backends to map the variable to when executing
22553 a function in those backends.
22554
22555 @lisp
22556 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
22557 "Where nndir will look for groups."
22558 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
22559 @end lisp
22560
22561 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
22562 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
22563 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
22564
22565 @item nnoo-define-basics
22566 This macro defines some common functions that almost all backends should
22567 have.
22568
22569 @example
22570 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
22571 @end example
22572
22573 @item deffoo
22574 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
22575 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
22576 function as being public so that other backends can inherit it.
22577
22578 @item nnoo-map-functions
22579 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current backend to
22580 functions from the parent backends.
22581
22582 @example
22583 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
22584 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22585 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
22586 @end example
22587
22588 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
22589 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
22590 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
22591 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
22592
22593 @item nnoo-import
22594 This macro allows importing functions from backends. It should be the
22595 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
22596 haven't already been defined.
22597
22598 @example
22599 (nnoo-import nndir
22600 (nnmh
22601 nnmh-request-list
22602 nnmh-request-newgroups)
22603 (nnml))
22604 @end example
22605
22606 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
22607 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
22608 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
22609 defined now.
22610
22611 @end table
22612
22613 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} backend.
22614
22615 @lisp
22616 ;;; nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus
22617 ;; Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22618
22619 ;;; Code:
22620
22621 (require 'nnheader)
22622 (require 'nnmh)
22623 (require 'nnml)
22624 (require 'nnoo)
22625 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
22626
22627 (nnoo-declare nndir
22628 nnml nnmh)
22629
22630 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
22631 "Where nndir will look for groups."
22632 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
22633
22634 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
22635 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
22636 nnml-nov-is-evil)
22637
22638 (defvoo nndir-current-group "" nil nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
22639 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
22640 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
22641
22642 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
22643 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
22644
22645 ;;; Interface functions.
22646
22647 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
22648
22649 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
22650 (setq nndir-directory
22651 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
22652 server))
22653 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
22654 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
22655 (push `(nndir-current-group
22656 ,(file-name-nondirectory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
22657 defs)
22658 (push `(nndir-top-directory
22659 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
22660 defs)
22661 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
22662
22663 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
22664 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22665 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22666 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
22667 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
22668
22669 (nnoo-import nndir
22670 (nnmh
22671 nnmh-status-message
22672 nnmh-request-list
22673 nnmh-request-newgroups))
22674
22675 (provide 'nndir)
22676 @end lisp
22677
22678
22679 @node Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
22680 @subsubsection Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
22681
22682 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
22683 Having Gnus start using your new backend is rather easy---you just
22684 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
22685 enter the backend into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
22686
22687 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the backend name and
22688 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
22689
22690 Here's an example:
22691
22692 @lisp
22693 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
22694 @end lisp
22695
22696 The abilities can be:
22697
22698 @table @code
22699 @item mail
22700 This is a mailish backend---followups should (probably) go via mail.
22701 @item post
22702 This is a newsish backend---followups should (probably) go via news.
22703 @item post-mail
22704 This backend supports both mail and news.
22705 @item none
22706 This is neither a post nor mail backend---it's something completely
22707 different.
22708 @item respool
22709 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
22710 articles and groups.
22711 @item address
22712 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
22713 true for almost all backends.
22714 @item prompt-address
22715 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
22716 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for backends like
22717 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
22718 @end table
22719
22720
22721 @node Mail-like Backends
22722 @subsubsection Mail-like Backends
22723
22724 One of the things that separate the mail backends from the rest of the
22725 backends is the heavy dependence by the mail backends on common
22726 functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the definition of
22727 @code{nnml-request-scan}:
22728
22729 @lisp
22730 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
22731 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
22732 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
22733 @end lisp
22734
22735 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
22736 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
22737 mail.
22738
22739 This function takes four parameters.
22740
22741 @table @var
22742 @item method
22743 This should be a symbol to designate which backend is responsible for
22744 the call.
22745
22746 @item exit-function
22747 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
22748
22749 @item temp-directory
22750 Where the temporary files should be stored.
22751
22752 @item group
22753 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
22754 performed for one group only.
22755 @end table
22756
22757 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{backend}@code{-save-mail} to
22758 save each article. @var{backend}@code{-active-number} will be called to
22759 find the article number assigned to this article.
22760
22761 The function also uses the following variables:
22762 @var{backend}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
22763 this backend); and @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} and
22764 @var{backend}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
22765 @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
22766 this:
22767
22768 @example
22769 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
22770 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
22771 @end example
22772
22773
22774 @node Score File Syntax
22775 @subsection Score File Syntax
22776
22777 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
22778 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
22779 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
22780
22781 Here's a typical score file:
22782
22783 @lisp
22784 (("summary"
22785 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
22786 ("Gnus"))
22787 ("from"
22788 ("Lars" -1000))
22789 (mark -100))
22790 @end lisp
22791
22792 BNF definition of a score file:
22793
22794 @example
22795 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
22796 element = rule / atom
22797 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
22798 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
22799 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
22800 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
22801 quote = <ascii 34>
22802 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
22803 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
22804 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
22805 date-header = "date"
22806 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22807 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22808 score = "nil" / <integer>
22809 date = "nil" / <natural number>
22810 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
22811 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
22812 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
22813 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
22814 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22815 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22816 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
22817 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22818 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
22819 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
22820 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
22821 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
22822 exclude-files / read-only / touched
22823 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
22824 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
22825 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
22826 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
22827 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
22828 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
22829 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
22830 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
22831 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
22832 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
22833 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
22834 eval = "eval" space <form>
22835 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
22836 @end example
22837
22838 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
22839 discarded.
22840
22841 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
22842 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
22843 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
22844 one looong line, then that's ok.
22845
22846 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
22847 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
22848
22849
22850 @node Headers
22851 @subsection Headers
22852
22853 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
22854 corresponds to the @sc{nov} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
22855 almost suspect that the author looked at the @sc{nov} specification and
22856 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
22857
22858 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
22859 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
22860 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
22861 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
22862 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
22863 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
22864 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
22865
22866 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
22867 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
22868 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
22869 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
22870 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
22871
22872 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
22873 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
22874
22875
22876 @node Ranges
22877 @subsection Ranges
22878
22879 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
22880 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
22881
22882 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
22883 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
22884 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
22885 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
22886
22887 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
22888 sequence.
22889
22890 @example
22891 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
22892 @end example
22893
22894 is transformed into
22895
22896 @example
22897 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
22898 @end example
22899
22900 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
22901 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
22902
22903 @example
22904 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
22905 @end example
22906
22907 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
22908 is slightly tricky:
22909
22910 @example
22911 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
22912 @end example
22913
22914 and
22915
22916 @example
22917 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
22918 @end example
22919
22920 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
22921
22922 @example
22923 (1 2 3 4 5)
22924 @end example
22925
22926 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
22927 also valid:
22928
22929 @example
22930 (1 . 5)
22931 @end example
22932
22933 and is equal to the previous range.
22934
22935 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
22936 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
22937 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
22938 range handling.)
22939
22940 @example
22941 range = simple-range / normal-range
22942 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
22943 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
22944 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
22945 number *[ " " contents ]
22946 @end example
22947
22948 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
22949 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
22950 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
22951 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
22952 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
22953 sequences.)
22954
22955
22956 @node Group Info
22957 @subsection Group Info
22958
22959 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
22960 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
22961 describes the group.
22962
22963 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
22964 second is a more complex one:
22965
22966 @example
22967 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
22968
22969 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
22970 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
22971 (nnml "")
22972 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
22973 @end example
22974
22975 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
22976 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
22977 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
22978 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
22979 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
22980 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
22981 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
22982 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
22983 this section is about.
22984
22985 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
22986 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
22987 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
22988
22989 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
22990
22991 @example
22992 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
22993 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
22994 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22995 group = quote <string> quote
22996 ralevel = rank / level
22997 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
22998 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
22999 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
23000 read = range
23001 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
23002 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
23003 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
23004 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
23005 @end example
23006
23007 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
23008 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
23009 in pseudo-BNF.
23010
23011 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
23012 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
23013
23014 @table @code
23015 @item gnus-info-group
23016 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
23017 @findex gnus-info-group
23018 @findex gnus-info-set-group
23019 Get/set the group name.
23020
23021 @item gnus-info-rank
23022 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
23023 @findex gnus-info-rank
23024 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
23025 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
23026
23027 @item gnus-info-level
23028 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
23029 @findex gnus-info-level
23030 @findex gnus-info-set-level
23031 Get/set the group level.
23032
23033 @item gnus-info-score
23034 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
23035 @findex gnus-info-score
23036 @findex gnus-info-set-score
23037 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
23038
23039 @item gnus-info-read
23040 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
23041 @findex gnus-info-read
23042 @findex gnus-info-set-read
23043 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
23044
23045 @item gnus-info-marks
23046 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
23047 @findex gnus-info-marks
23048 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
23049 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
23050
23051 @item gnus-info-method
23052 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
23053 @findex gnus-info-method
23054 @findex gnus-info-set-method
23055 Get/set the group select method.
23056
23057 @item gnus-info-params
23058 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
23059 @findex gnus-info-params
23060 @findex gnus-info-set-params
23061 Get/set the group parameters.
23062 @end table
23063
23064 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
23065 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
23066
23067 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
23068 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
23069 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
23070 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
23071
23072
23073 @node Extended Interactive
23074 @subsection Extended Interactive
23075 @cindex interactive
23076 @findex gnus-interactive
23077
23078 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
23079 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
23080 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
23081
23082 @lisp
23083 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
23084 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
23085 ...
23086 )
23087 @end lisp
23088
23089 The best thing to do would have been to implement
23090 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
23091 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
23092 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
23093 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
23094 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
23095 @code{interactive}.
23096
23097 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
23098 adds a few more.
23099
23100 @table @samp
23101 @item y
23102 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
23103 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
23104 variable.
23105
23106 @item Y
23107 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
23108 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
23109 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
23110
23111 @item A
23112 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
23113 function.
23114
23115 @item H
23116 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
23117 function.
23118
23119 @item g
23120 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
23121 function.
23122
23123 @end table
23124
23125
23126 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
23127 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
23128 @cindex XEmacs
23129 @cindex Emacsen
23130
23131 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
23132 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
23133 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
23134
23135 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
23136 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
23137 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
23138 Gnus, that's very useful.
23139
23140 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
23141 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
23142 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
23143 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
23144 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
23145 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
23146 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
23147 following function:
23148
23149 @lisp
23150 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
23151 (start-itimer
23152 "gnus-run-at-time"
23153 `(lambda ()
23154 (,function ,@@args))
23155 time repeat))
23156 @end lisp
23157
23158 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
23159 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
23160 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
23161 all over.
23162
23163 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
23164 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
23165 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
23166
23167 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
23168 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
23169 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
23170
23171
23172 @node Various File Formats
23173 @subsection Various File Formats
23174
23175 @menu
23176 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
23177 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
23178 @end menu
23179
23180
23181 @node Active File Format
23182 @subsubsection Active File Format
23183
23184 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
23185 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
23186 in each group.
23187
23188 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
23189
23190 @example
23191 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
23192 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
23193 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
23194 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
23195 no.general 1000 900 y
23196 @end example
23197
23198 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
23199
23200 @example
23201 active = *group-line
23202 group-line = group space high-number space low-number space flag <NEWLINE>
23203 group = <non-white-space string>
23204 space = " "
23205 high-number = <non-negative integer>
23206 low-number = <positive integer>
23207 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
23208 @end example
23209
23210 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
23211 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
23212
23213
23214 @node Newsgroups File Format
23215 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
23216
23217 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
23218 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
23219 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
23220 the user.
23221
23222 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
23223 Here's the definition:
23224
23225 @example
23226 newsgroups = *line
23227 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
23228 group = <non-white-space string>
23229 tab = <TAB>
23230 description = <string>
23231 @end example
23232
23233
23234 @page
23235 @node Emacs for Heathens
23236 @section Emacs for Heathens
23237
23238 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
23239 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
23240 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{M-C-a}'', ``kill the
23241 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
23242 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
23243 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
23244 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
23245 cat instead.
23246
23247 @menu
23248 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
23249 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
23250 @end menu
23251
23252
23253 @node Keystrokes
23254 @subsection Keystrokes
23255
23256 @itemize @bullet
23257 @item
23258 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
23259
23260 @item
23261 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
23262 @end itemize
23263
23264 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
23265 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
23266 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
23267 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
23268 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
23269 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
23270
23271 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
23272 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
23273 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
23274 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
23275 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
23276 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
23277 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
23278
23279 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
23280 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{M-C-m}
23281 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
23282 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
23283 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
23284 ``Press @kbd{M-C-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
23285 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
23286
23287 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
23288 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
23289 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
23290 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
23291 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
23292 it.
23293
23294
23295
23296 @node Emacs Lisp
23297 @subsection Emacs Lisp
23298
23299 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
23300 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
23301 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
23302 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
23303
23304 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
23305 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
23306 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
23307 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
23308 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
23309 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
23310 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
23311 to customize Gnus.
23312
23313 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
23314 write the following:
23315
23316 @lisp
23317 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
23318 @end lisp
23319
23320 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
23321 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
23322 you can go and fill your @code{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
23323 how Gnus works.
23324
23325 If you have put that thing in your @code{.emacs} file, it will be read
23326 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
23327 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
23328 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
23329 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
23330
23331 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
23332 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
23333 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
23334
23335 Some pitfalls:
23336
23337 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
23338 that means:
23339
23340 @lisp
23341 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
23342 @end lisp
23343
23344 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
23345 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
23346
23347 @lisp
23348 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
23349 @end lisp
23350
23351 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
23352 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
23353
23354 @page
23355 @include gnus-faq.texi
23356
23357 @node Index
23358 @chapter Index
23359 @printindex cp
23360
23361 @node Key Index
23362 @chapter Key Index
23363 @printindex ky
23364
23365 @summarycontents
23366 @contents
23367 @bye
23368
23369 @iftex
23370 @iflatex
23371 \end{document}
23372 @end iflatex
23373 @end iftex
23374
23375 @c End: